blob: 9846e8bfeb3f76e898943a3292c575166a521321 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau73dec762021-11-23 15:50:11 +01005 version 2.6
Willy Tarreau0edb9972022-05-27 19:49:31 +02006 2022/05/27
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007
8
9This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
18 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
19 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020020 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
22 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
23 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020024 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025
26
27Summary
28-------
29
301. Quick reminder about HTTP
311.1. The HTTP transaction model
321.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100331.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200341.2.2. The request headers
351.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100361.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200371.3.2. The response headers
38
392. Configuring HAProxy
402.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200412.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200422.3. Environment variables
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100432.4. Conditional blocks
442.5. Time format
452.6. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100553.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200563.9. Rings
William Lallemand0217b7b2020-11-18 10:41:24 +0100573.10. Log forwarding
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020058
594. Proxies
604.1. Proxy keywords matrix
614.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
62
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100635. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200645.1. Bind options
655.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200665.3. Server DNS resolution
675.3.1. Global overview
685.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020069
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100706. Cache
716.1. Limitation
726.2. Setup
736.2.1. Cache section
746.2.2. Proxy section
75
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200767. Using ACLs and fetching samples
777.1. ACL basics
787.1.1. Matching booleans
797.1.2. Matching integers
807.1.3. Matching strings
817.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
827.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
837.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
847.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
857.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200867.3.1. Converters
877.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
887.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
897.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
907.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
917.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200927.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200937.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020094
958. Logging
968.1. Log levels
978.2. Log formats
988.2.1. Default log format
998.2.2. TCP log format
1008.2.3. HTTP log format
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02001018.2.4. HTTPS log format
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +01001028.2.5. Error log format
1038.2.6. Custom log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001048.3. Advanced logging options
1058.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1068.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1078.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1088.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1098.4. Timing events
1108.5. Session state at disconnection
1118.6. Non-printable characters
1128.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1138.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1148.9. Examples of logs
115
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001169. Supported filters
1179.1. Trace
1189.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001199.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001209.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001219.5. fcgi-app
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +01001229.6. OpenTracing
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200123
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012410. FastCGI applications
12510.1. Setup
12610.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12710.1.2. Proxy section
12810.1.3. Example
12910.2. Default parameters
13010.3. Limitations
131
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020013211. Address formats
13311.1. Address family prefixes
13411.2. Socket type prefixes
13511.3. Protocol prefixes
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200136
1371. Quick reminder about HTTP
138----------------------------
139
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100140When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200141fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
142on almost anything found in the contents.
143
144However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
145formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
146correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
147
148
1491.1. The HTTP transaction model
150-------------------------------
151
152The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100153to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100154from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
155connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200156will involve a new connection :
157
158 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
159
160In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
161establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
162by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
163length.
164
165Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
166to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
167however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
168response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
169header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
170
171 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
172
173Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
174power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
175but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200176a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100178Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
180second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
181page :
182
183 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
184
185This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
186latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
187correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
188the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100189server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200190
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100191The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
192time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
193are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
194parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
195carry the stream identifier.
196
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100197By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
198connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
199leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100200start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
201processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
202waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200203
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200204HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100205 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
206 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100207 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100208 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200209 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100210
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100211
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200212
2131.2. HTTP request
214-----------------
215
216First, let's consider this HTTP request :
217
218 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100219 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200220 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
221 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
222 3 User-agent: my small browser
223 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
224 5 Accept: image/png
225
226
2271.2.1. The Request line
228-----------------------
229
230Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
231
232 - a METHOD : GET
233 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
234 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
235
236All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
237which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
238followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
239is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
240desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
241the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
242
243The URI itself can have several forms :
244
245 - A "relative URI" :
246
247 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
248
249 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
250 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
251
252 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
253
254 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
255
256 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
257 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
258 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
259 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
260 must accept this form too.
261
262 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
263 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
264 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100265
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200266 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
267 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
268 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
269 other protocols too.
270
271In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
272mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
273on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
274It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
275specific to the language, framework or application in use.
276
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100277HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100278assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100279
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200280
2811.2.2. The request headers
282--------------------------
283
284The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
285beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
286an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
287Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
288values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
289encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
290the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
291define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
292
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100293Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200294their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100295"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200296as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
297normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
298representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
299HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200300
301The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
302that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
303is one valid form of empty line.
304
305Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
306headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
307about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
308application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
309
310Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000311 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200312 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
313 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
314 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
315
316
3171.3. HTTP response
318------------------
319
320An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
321messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
322
323 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100324 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200325 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
326 2 Content-length: 350
327 3 Content-Type: text/html
328
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200329As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
330codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
331response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100332continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
333the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
334following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
335sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
336(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
337correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
338such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
339state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400340over the same connection and that HAProxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100341if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
342information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200343
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200344
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003451.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200346------------------------
347
348Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
349
350 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
351 - a status code : 200
352 - a reason : OK
353
354The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100355 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
356 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
357 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
358 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
359 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200360
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000361Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100362"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200363found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
364messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
365or "Authentication Required".
366
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100367HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200368
369 Code When / reason
370 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
371 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
372 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
373 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100374 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
375 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200376 400 for an invalid or too large request
377 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
378 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200379 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100380 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100382 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
383 be available again
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400384 500 when HAProxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200385 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400386 501 when HAProxy is unable to satisfy a client request because of an
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +0100387 unsupported feature
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200388 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200389 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200390 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
391 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
392 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
393
394The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3954.2).
396
397
3981.3.2. The response headers
399---------------------------
400
401Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
402the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
403details.
404
405
4062. Configuring HAProxy
407----------------------
408
4092.1. Configuration file format
410------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200411
412HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
413
414 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100415 - the configuration file(s), whose format is described here
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -0700416 - the running process's environment, in case some environment variables are
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100417 explicitly referenced
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200418
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100419The configuration file follows a fairly simple hierarchical format which obey
420a few basic rules:
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100421
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100422 1. a configuration file is an ordered sequence of statements
423
424 2. a statement is a single non-empty line before any unprotected "#" (hash)
425
426 3. a line is a series of tokens or "words" delimited by unprotected spaces or
427 tab characters
428
429 4. the first word or sequence of words of a line is one of the keywords or
430 keyword sequences listed in this document
431
432 5. all other words are all arguments of the first one, some being well-known
433 keywords listed in this document, others being values, references to other
434 parts of the configuration, or expressions
435
436 6. certain keywords delimit a section inside which only a subset of keywords
437 are supported
438
439 7. a section ends at the end of a file or on a special keyword starting a new
440 section
441
442This is all that is needed to know to write a simple but reliable configuration
443generator, but this is not enough to reliably parse any configuration nor to
444figure how to deal with certain corner cases.
445
446First, there are a few consequences of the rules above. Rule 6 and 7 imply that
447the keywords used to define a new section are valid everywhere and cannot have
448a different meaning in a specific section. These keywords are always a single
449word (as opposed to a sequence of words), and traditionally the section that
450follows them is designated using the same name. For example when speaking about
451the "global section", it designates the section of configuration that follows
452the "global" keyword. This usage is used a lot in error messages to help locate
453the parts that need to be addressed.
454
455A number of sections create an internal object or configuration space, which
456requires to be distinguished from other ones. In this case they will take an
457extra word which will set the name of this particular section. For some of them
458the section name is mandatory. For example "frontend foo" will create a new
459section of type "frontend" named "foo". Usually a name is specific to its
460section and two sections of different types may use the same name, but this is
461not recommended as it tends to complexify configuration management.
462
463A direct consequence of rule 7 is that when multiple files are read at once,
464each of them must start with a new section, and the end of each file will end
465a section. A file cannot contain sub-sections nor end an existing section and
466start a new one.
467
468Rule 1 mentioned that ordering matters. Indeed, some keywords create directives
469that can be repeated multiple times to create ordered sequences of rules to be
470applied in a certain order. For example "tcp-request" can be used to alternate
471"accept" and "reject" rules on varying criteria. As such, a configuration file
472processor must always preserve a section's ordering when editing a file. The
473ordering of sections usually does not matter except for the global section
474which must be placed before other sections, but it may be repeated if needed.
475In addition, some automatic identifiers may automatically be assigned to some
476of the created objects (e.g. proxies), and by reordering sections, their
477identifiers will change. These ones appear in the statistics for example. As
478such, the configuration below will assign "foo" ID number 1 and "bar" ID number
4792, which will be swapped if the two sections are reversed:
480
481 listen foo
482 bind :80
483
484 listen bar
485 bind :81
486
487Another important point is that according to rules 2 and 3 above, empty lines,
488spaces, tabs, and comments following and unprotected "#" character are not part
489of the configuration as they are just used as delimiters. This implies that the
490following configurations are strictly equivalent:
491
492 global#this is the global section
493 daemon#daemonize
494 frontend foo
495 mode http # or tcp
496
497and:
498
499 global
500 daemon
501
502 # this is the public web frontend
503 frontend foo
504 mode http
505
506The common practice is to align to the left only the keyword that initiates a
507new section, and indent (i.e. prepend a tab character or a few spaces) all
508other keywords so that it's instantly visible that they belong to the same
509section (as done in the second example above). Placing comments before a new
510section helps the reader decide if it's the desired one. Leaving a blank line
511at the end of a section also visually helps spotting the end when editing it.
512
513Tabs are very convenient for indent but they do not copy-paste well. If spaces
514are used instead, it is recommended to avoid placing too many (2 to 4) so that
515editing in field doesn't become a burden with limited editors that do not
516support automatic indent.
517
518In the early days it used to be common to see arguments split at fixed tab
519positions because most keywords would not take more than two arguments. With
520modern versions featuring complex expressions this practice does not stand
521anymore, and is not recommended.
522
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200523
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02005242.2. Quoting and escaping
525-------------------------
526
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100527In modern configurations, some arguments require the use of some characters
528that were previously considered as pure delimiters. In order to make this
529possible, HAProxy supports character escaping by prepending a backslash ('\')
530in front of the character to be escaped, weak quoting within double quotes
531('"') and strong quoting within single quotes ("'").
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200532
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100533This is pretty similar to what is done in a number of programming languages and
534very close to what is commonly encountered in Bourne shell. The principle is
535the following: while the configuration parser cuts the lines into words, it
536also takes care of quotes and backslashes to decide whether a character is a
537delimiter or is the raw representation of this character within the current
538word. The escape character is then removed, the quotes are removed, and the
539remaining word is used as-is as a keyword or argument for example.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200540
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100541If a backslash is needed in a word, it must either be escaped using itself
542(i.e. double backslash) or be strongly quoted.
543
544Escaping outside quotes is achieved by preceding a special character by a
545backslash ('\'):
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200546
547 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
548 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
549 \\ to use a backslash
550 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
551 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
552
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100553In addition, a few non-printable characters may be emitted using their usual
554C-language representation:
555
556 \n to insert a line feed (LF, character \x0a or ASCII 10 decimal)
557 \r to insert a carriage return (CR, character \x0d or ASCII 13 decimal)
558 \t to insert a tab (character \x09 or ASCII 9 decimal)
559 \xNN to insert character having ASCII code hex NN (e.g \x0a for LF).
560
561Weak quoting is achieved by surrounding double quotes ("") around the character
562or sequence of characters to protect. Weak quoting prevents the interpretation
563of:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200564
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100565 space or tab as a word separator
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200566 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
567 # hash as a comment start
568
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100569Weak quoting permits the interpretation of environment variables (which are not
570evaluated outside of quotes) by preceding them with a dollar sign ('$'). If a
571dollar character is needed inside double quotes, it must be escaped using a
572backslash.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200573
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100574Strong quoting is achieved by surrounding single quotes ('') around the
575character or sequence of characters to protect. Inside single quotes, nothing
576is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regular expressions.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200577
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100578As a result, here is the matrix indicating how special characters can be
579entered in different contexts (unprintable characters are replaced with their
580name within angle brackets). Note that some characters that may only be
581represented escaped have no possible representation inside single quotes,
582hence the '-' there:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200583
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100584 Character | Unquoted | Weakly quoted | Strongly quoted
585 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
586 <TAB> | \<TAB>, \x09 | "<TAB>", "\<TAB>", "\x09" | '<TAB>'
587 <LF> | \n, \x0a | "\n", "\x0a" | -
588 <CR> | \r, \x0d | "\r", "\x0d" | -
589 <SPC> | \<SPC>, \x20 | "<SPC>", "\<SPC>", "\x20" | '<SPC>'
590 " | \", \x22 | "\"", "\x22" | '"'
591 # | \#, \x23 | "#", "\#", "\x23" | '#'
592 $ | $, \$, \x24 | "\$", "\x24" | '$'
593 ' | \', \x27 | "'", "\'", "\x27" | -
594 \ | \\, \x5c | "\\", "\x5c" | '\'
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200595
596 Example:
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100597 # those are all strictly equivalent:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200598 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
599 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
600 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
601 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
602 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
603
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100604There is one particular case where a second level of quoting or escaping may be
605necessary. Some keywords take arguments within parenthesis, sometimes delimited
606by commas. These arguments are commonly integers or predefined words, but when
607they are arbitrary strings, it may be required to perform a separate level of
608escaping to disambiguate the characters that belong to the argument from the
609characters that are used to delimit the arguments themselves. A pretty common
610case is the "regsub" converter. It takes a regular expression in argument, and
611if a closing parenthesis is needed inside, this one will require to have its
612own quotes.
613
614The keyword argument parser is exactly the same as the top-level one regarding
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600615quotes, except that the \#, \$, and \xNN escapes are not processed. But what is
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500616not always obvious is that the delimiters used inside must first be escaped or
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100617quoted so that they are not resolved at the top level.
618
619Let's take this example making use of the "regsub" converter which takes 3
620arguments, one regular expression, one replacement string and one set of flags:
621
622 # replace all occurrences of "foo" with "blah" in the path:
623 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(foo,blah,g)]
624
625Here no special quoting was necessary. But if now we want to replace either
626"foo" or "bar" with "blah", we'll need the regular expression "(foo|bar)". We
627cannot write:
628
629 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
630
631because we would like the string to cut like this:
632
633 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
634 |---------|----|-|
635 arg1 _/ / /
636 arg2 __________/ /
637 arg3 ______________/
638
639but actually what is passed is a string between the opening and closing
640parenthesis then garbage:
641
642 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
643 |--------|--------|
644 arg1=(foo|bar _/ /
645 trailing garbage _________/
646
647The obvious solution here seems to be that the closing parenthesis needs to be
648quoted, but alone this will not work, because as mentioned above, quotes are
649processed by the top-level parser which will resolve them before processing
650this word:
651
652 http-request set-path %[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
653 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
654 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
655
656So we didn't change anything for the argument parser at the second level which
657still sees a truncated regular expression as the only argument, and garbage at
658the end of the string. By escaping the quotes they will be passed unmodified to
659the second level:
660
661 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(\"(foo|bar)\",blah,g)]
662 ------------ -------- ------------------------------------
663 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
664 |---------||----|-|
665 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
666 arg2=blah ___________/ /
667 arg3=g _______________/
668
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500669Another approach consists in using single quotes outside the whole string and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100670double quotes inside (so that the double quotes are not stripped again):
671
672 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]'
673 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
674 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
675 |---------||----|-|
676 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
677 arg2 ___________/ /
678 arg3 _______________/
679
680When using regular expressions, it can happen that the dollar ('$') character
681appears in the expression or that a backslash ('\') is used in the replacement
682string. In this case these ones will also be processed inside the double quotes
683thus single quotes are preferred (or double escaping). Example:
684
685 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]'
686 ------------ -------- -----------------------------------------
687 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]
688 |-------------| |-----||-|
689 arg1=(here)(/|$) _/ / /
690 arg2=my/\1 ________________/ /
691 arg3 ______________________/
692
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400693Remember that backslashes are not escape characters within single quotes and
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600694that the whole word above is already protected against them using the single
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100695quotes. Conversely, if double quotes had been used around the whole expression,
696single the dollar character and the backslashes would have been resolved at top
697level, breaking the argument contents at the second level.
698
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600699Unfortunately, since single quotes can't be escaped inside of strong quoting,
700if you need to include single quotes in your argument, you will need to escape
701or quote them twice. There are a few ways to do this:
702
703 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str("\\'foo\\'")
704 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str(\"\'foo\'\")
705 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str(\\\'foo\\\')
706
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100707When in doubt, simply do not use quotes anywhere, and start to place single or
708double quotes around arguments that require a comma or a closing parenthesis,
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600709and think about escaping these quotes using a backslash if the string contains
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100710a dollar or a backslash. Again, this is pretty similar to what is used under
711a Bourne shell when double-escaping a command passed to "eval". For API writers
712the best is probably to place escaped quotes around each and every argument,
713regardless of their contents. Users will probably find that using single quotes
714around the whole expression and double quotes around each argument provides
715more readable configurations.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200716
717
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007182.3. Environment variables
719--------------------------
720
721HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
722interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
723configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
724optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
725shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
Amaury Denoyellefa41cb62020-10-01 14:32:35 +0200726underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
727list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
728arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
Willy Tarreauec347b12021-11-18 17:42:50 +0100729before the closing brace. It is also possible to specify a default value to
730use when the variable is not set, by appending that value after a dash '-'
731next to the variable name. Note that the default value only replaces non
732existing variables, not empty ones.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200733
734 Example:
735
736 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
737
Willy Tarreauec347b12021-11-18 17:42:50 +0100738 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG-127.0.0.1}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200739
740 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
741
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200742Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
743file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200744
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200745* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
746 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
747
748* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
749 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
750 directory.
751
752* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
753
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500754* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200755 processes, separated by semicolons.
756
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500757* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200758 CLI, separated by semicolons.
759
Willy Tarreaua46f1af2021-05-06 10:25:11 +0200760In addition, some pseudo-variables are internally resolved and may be used as
761regular variables. Pseudo-variables always start with a dot ('.'), and are the
762only ones where the dot is permitted. The current list of pseudo-variables is:
763
764* .FILE: the name of the configuration file currently being parsed.
765
766* .LINE: the line number of the configuration file currently being parsed,
767 starting at one.
768
769* .SECTION: the name of the section currently being parsed, or its type if the
770 section doesn't have a name (e.g. "global"), or an empty string before the
771 first section.
772
773These variables are resolved at the location where they are parsed. For example
774if a ".LINE" variable is used in a "log-format" directive located in a defaults
775section, its line number will be resolved before parsing and compiling the
776"log-format" directive, so this same line number will be reused by subsequent
777proxies.
778
779This way it is possible to emit information to help locate a rule in variables,
780logs, error statuses, health checks, header values, or even to use line numbers
781to name some config objects like servers for example.
782
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200783See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200784
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100785
7862.4. Conditional blocks
787-----------------------
788
789It may sometimes be convenient to be able to conditionally enable or disable
790some arbitrary parts of the configuration, for example to enable/disable SSL or
791ciphers, enable or disable some pre-production listeners without modifying the
792configuration, or adjust the configuration's syntax to support two distinct
793versions of HAProxy during a migration.. HAProxy brings a set of nestable
794preprocessor-like directives which allow to integrate or ignore some blocks of
795text. These directives must be placed on their own line and they act on the
796lines that follow them. Two of them support an expression, the other ones only
797switch to an alternate block or end a current level. The 4 following directives
798are defined to form conditional blocks:
799
800 - .if <condition>
801 - .elif <condition>
802 - .else
803 - .endif
804
805The ".if" directive nests a new level, ".elif" stays at the same level, ".else"
806as well, and ".endif" closes a level. Each ".if" must be terminated by a
807matching ".endif". The ".elif" may only be placed after ".if" or ".elif", and
808there is no limit to the number of ".elif" that may be chained. There may be
809only one ".else" per ".if" and it must always be after the ".if" or the last
810".elif" of a block.
811
812Comments may be placed on the same line if needed after a '#', they will be
813ignored. The directives are tokenized like other configuration directives, and
814as such it is possible to use environment variables in conditions.
815
Maximilian Maderfc0cceb2021-06-06 00:50:22 +0200816Conditions can also be evaluated on startup with the -cc parameter.
817See "3. Starting HAProxy" in the management doc.
818
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200819The conditions are either an empty string (which then returns false), or an
820expression made of any combination of:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100821
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100822 - the integer zero ('0'), always returns "false"
823 - a non-nul integer (e.g. '1'), always returns "true".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200824 - a predicate optionally followed by argument(s) in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau316ea7e2021-07-16 14:56:59 +0200825 - a condition placed between a pair of parenthesis '(' and ')'
Kunal Gangakhedkard0bacde2021-08-17 11:55:45 +0530826 - an exclamation mark ('!') preceding any of the non-empty elements above,
827 and which will negate its status.
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200828 - expressions combined with a logical AND ('&&'), which will be evaluated
829 from left to right until one returns false
830 - expressions combined with a logical OR ('||'), which will be evaluated
831 from right to left until one returns true
832
833Note that like in other languages, the AND operator has precedence over the OR
834operator, so that "A && B || C && D" evalues as "(A && B) || (C && D)".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200835
836The list of currently supported predicates is the following:
837
838 - defined(<name>) : returns true if an environment variable <name>
839 exists, regardless of its contents
840
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200841 - feature(<name>) : returns true if feature <name> is listed as present
842 in the features list reported by "haproxy -vv"
843 (which means a <name> appears after a '+')
844
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200845 - streq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings are equal
846 - strneq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings differ
847
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200848 - version_atleast(<ver>): returns true if the current haproxy version is
849 at least as recent as <ver> otherwise false. The
850 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
851 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
852
853 - version_before(<ver>) : returns true if the current haproxy version is
854 strictly older than <ver> otherwise false. The
855 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
856 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
857
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200858Example:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100859
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200860 .if defined(HAPROXY_MWORKER)
861 listen mwcli_px
862 bind :1111
863 ...
864 .endif
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100865
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200866 .if strneq("$SSL_ONLY",yes)
867 bind :80
868 .endif
869
870 .if streq("$WITH_SSL",yes)
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200871 .if feature(OPENSSL)
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200872 bind :443 ssl crt ...
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200873 .endif
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200874 .endif
875
Willy Tarreau316ea7e2021-07-16 14:56:59 +0200876 .if feature(OPENSSL) && (streq("$WITH_SSL",yes) || streq("$SSL_ONLY",yes))
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200877 bind :443 ssl crt ...
878 .endif
879
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200880 .if version_atleast(2.4-dev19)
881 profiling.memory on
882 .endif
883
Willy Tarreauca56d3d2021-07-16 13:56:54 +0200884 .if !feature(OPENSSL)
885 .alert "SSL support is mandatory"
886 .endif
887
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200888Four other directives are provided to report some status:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100889
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200890 - .diag "message" : emit this message only when in diagnostic mode (-dD)
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100891 - .notice "message" : emit this message at level NOTICE
892 - .warning "message" : emit this message at level WARNING
893 - .alert "message" : emit this message at level ALERT
894
895Messages emitted at level WARNING may cause the process to fail to start if the
896"strict-mode" is enabled. Messages emitted at level ALERT will always cause a
897fatal error. These can be used to detect some inappropriate conditions and
898provide advice to the user.
899
900Example:
901
902 .if "${A}"
903 .if "${B}"
904 .notice "A=1, B=1"
905 .elif "${C}"
906 .notice "A=1, B=0, C=1"
907 .elif "${D}"
908 .warning "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=1"
909 .else
910 .alert "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=0"
911 .endif
912 .else
913 .notice "A=0"
914 .endif
915
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200916 .diag "WTA/2021-05-07: replace 'redirect' with 'return' after switch to 2.4"
917 http-request redirect location /goaway if ABUSE
918
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100919
9202.5. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200921----------------
922
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100923Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100924values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
925otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
926numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
927for every keyword. Supported units are :
928
929 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
930 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
931 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
932 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
933 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
934 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
935
936
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +01009372.6. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200938-------------
939
940 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
941 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
942 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
943 global
944 daemon
945 maxconn 256
946
947 defaults
948 mode http
949 timeout connect 5000ms
950 timeout client 50000ms
951 timeout server 50000ms
952
953 frontend http-in
954 bind *:80
955 default_backend servers
956
957 backend servers
958 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
959
960
961 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
962 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
963 global
964 daemon
965 maxconn 256
966
967 defaults
968 mode http
969 timeout connect 5000ms
970 timeout client 50000ms
971 timeout server 50000ms
972
973 listen http-in
974 bind *:80
975 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
976
977
978Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
979
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100980 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200981
982
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009833. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200984--------------------
985
986Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
987are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
988of them have command-line equivalents.
989
990The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
991
992 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200993 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200994 - chroot
Frédéric Lécaille372508c2022-05-06 08:53:16 +0200995 - cluster-secret
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200996 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200997 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200998 - daemon
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +0200999 - default-path
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001000 - description
1001 - deviceatlas-json-file
1002 - deviceatlas-log-level
1003 - deviceatlas-separator
1004 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +02001005 - expose-experimental-directives
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001006 - external-check
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02001007 - fd-hard-limit
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001008 - gid
Willy Tarreau10080712021-09-07 10:49:45 +02001009 - grace
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001010 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +01001011 - hard-stop-after
William Lallemandcfabb352022-05-12 10:51:15 +02001012 - httpclient.resolvers.id
1013 - httpclient.resolvers.prefer
1014 - httpclient.ssl.ca-file
1015 - httpclient.ssl.verify
Christopher Faulet0f9c0f52022-05-13 09:20:13 +02001016 - h1-accept-payload-with-any-method
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001017 - h1-case-adjust
1018 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001019 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001020 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001021 - issuers-chain-path
Amaury Denoyellebefeae82021-07-09 17:14:30 +02001022 - h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001023 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001024 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001025 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001026 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001027 - lua-load
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001028 - lua-load-per-thread
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001029 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001030 - mworker-max-reloads
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001031 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001032 - node
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001033 - numa-cpu-mapping
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001034 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001035 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001036 - presetenv
1037 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001038 - uid
1039 - ulimit-n
1040 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001041 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001042 - set-var
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001043 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001044 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001045 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001046 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001047 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001048 - ssl-default-bind-options
1049 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001050 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001051 - ssl-default-server-options
1052 - ssl-dh-param-file
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone8097652022-05-16 16:24:32 +02001053 - ssl-propquery
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1746a382022-05-16 16:24:33 +02001054 - ssl-provider
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonccc03552022-05-17 15:18:37 +02001055 - ssl-provider-path
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001056 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001057 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001058 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001059 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001060 - 51degrees-data-file
1061 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +02001062 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001063 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001064 - wurfl-data-file
1065 - wurfl-information-list
1066 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001067 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001068 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001069
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001070 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +01001071 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001072 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001073 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001074 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001075 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001076 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001077 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001078 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001079 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001080 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001081 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreauc4e56dc2022-03-08 10:41:40 +01001082 - no-memory-trimming
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001083 - noepoll
1084 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001085 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001086 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001087 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001088 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001089 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001090 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001091 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001092 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001093 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001094 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001095 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001096 - tune.buffers.limit
1097 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001098 - tune.bufsize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001099 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02001100 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001101 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001102 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001103 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001104 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001105 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001106 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02001107 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001108 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001109 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001110 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001111 - tune.lua.session-timeout
1112 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001113 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001114 - tune.maxaccept
1115 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001116 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001117 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001118 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +02001119 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
1120 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Amaury Denoyelle97e84c62022-04-19 18:26:55 +02001121 - tune.quic.conn-buf-limit
Frédéric Lécaille1d96d6e2022-05-23 16:38:14 +02001122 - tune.quic.frontend.max-idle-timeout
Frédéric Lécaille26740982022-05-23 17:28:01 +02001123 - tune.quic.frontend.max-streams-bidi
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +02001124 - tune.quic.retry-threshold
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001125 - tune.rcvbuf.client
1126 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001127 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001128 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02001129 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001130 - tune.sndbuf.client
1131 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001132 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Thomas Prückl10243932022-04-27 13:04:54 +02001133 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1134 - tune.ssl.hard-maxrecord
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02001135 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001136 - tune.ssl.lifetime
1137 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001138 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001139 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +02001140 - tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size
1141 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size (deprecated)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001142 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001143 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001144 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
1145 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
1146 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001147 - tune.zlib.memlevel
1148 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001149
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001150 * Debugging
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001151 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02001152 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001153
1154
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011553.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001156------------------------------------
1157
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001158ca-base <dir>
1159 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +01001160 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
1161 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
1162 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001163
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001164chroot <jail dir>
1165 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
1166 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
1167 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
1168 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
1169 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001170 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001171
Frédéric Lécaille372508c2022-05-06 08:53:16 +02001172cluster-secret <secret>
1173 Define an ASCII string secret shared between several nodes belonging to the
1174 same cluster. It could be used for different usages. It is at least used to
1175 derive stateless reset tokens for all the QUIC connections instantiated by
Frédéric Lécaillead20a562022-05-16 16:51:41 +02001176 this process. This is also the case to derive secrets used to encrypt Retry
1177 tokens. If you do not set this parameter, the stateless reset and Retry QUIC
1178 features will be both silently disabled.
Frédéric Lécaille372508c2022-05-06 08:53:16 +02001179
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonb5d968d2022-04-08 18:04:18 +02001180close-spread-time <time>
1181 Define a time window during which idle connections and active connections
1182 closing is spread in case of soft-stop. After a SIGUSR1 is received and the
1183 grace period is over (if any), the idle connections will all be closed at
1184 once if this option is not set, and active HTTP or HTTP2 connections will be
1185 ended after the next request is received, either by appending a "Connection:
1186 close" line to the HTTP response, or by sending a GOAWAY frame in case of
1187 HTTP2. When this option is set, connection closing will be spread over this
1188 set <time>.
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4d7fdc62022-04-26 15:17:18 +02001189 If the close-spread-time is set to "infinite", active connection closing
1190 during a soft-stop will be disabled. The "Connection: close" header will not
1191 be added to HTTP responses (or GOAWAY for HTTP2) anymore and idle connections
1192 will only be closed once their timeout is reached (based on the various
1193 timeouts set in the configuration).
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonb5d968d2022-04-08 18:04:18 +02001194
1195 Arguments :
1196 <time> is a time window (by default in milliseconds) during which
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4d7fdc62022-04-26 15:17:18 +02001197 connection closing will be spread during a soft-stop operation, or
1198 "infinite" if active connection closing should be disabled.
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonb5d968d2022-04-08 18:04:18 +02001199
1200 It is recommended to set this setting to a value lower than the one used in
1201 the "hard-stop-after" option if this one is used, so that all connections
1202 have a chance to gracefully close before the process stops.
1203
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4d7fdc62022-04-26 15:17:18 +02001204 See also: grace, hard-stop-after, idle-close-on-response
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonb5d968d2022-04-08 18:04:18 +02001205
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001206cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001207 On some operating systems, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001208 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
1209 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
1210 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
1211 set. These sets have the format
1212
1213 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
1214
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001215 <number> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
1216 word size. Any process IDs above 1 and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001217 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001218 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all thraeds at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +01001219 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
1220 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Amaury Denoyelle982fb532021-04-21 18:39:58 +02001221 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number starting at 0 for the first
1222 CPU or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Outside of
1223 Linux and BSDs, there may be a limitation on the maximum CPU index to either
1224 31 or 63. Multiple CPU numbers or ranges may be specified, and the processes
1225 or threads will be allowed to bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple
1226 "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace
1227 the previous ones when they overlap. A thread will be bound on the
1228 intersection of its mapping and the one of the process on which it is
1229 attached. If the intersection is null, no specific binding will be set for
1230 the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +01001231
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001232 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
1233 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
1234 on the machine's word size.
1235
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001236 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001237 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing threads and
1238 CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same size. No matter the
1239 declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from the lowest to the
1240 highest bound. Having both a process and a thread range with the "auto:"
1241 prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one must be
1242 a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001243
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001244 Note that process ranges are supported for historical reasons. Nowadays, a
1245 lone number designates a process and must be 1, and specifying a thread range
1246 or number requires to prepend "1/" in front of it. Finally, "1" is strictly
1247 equivalent to "1/all" and designates all threads on the process.
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001248
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001249 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001250 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
1251 # first 4 CPUs
1252
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001253 cpu-map 1/1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1/1-64 0-63"
1254 # or "cpu-map 1/1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001255 # word size.
1256
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001257 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
1258 # and so on.
1259 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
1260 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
1261 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
1262
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001263 # bind each thread to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
1264 cpu-map auto:1/all 0-63
1265 cpu-map auto:1/even 0-31
1266 cpu-map auto:1/odd 32-63
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001267
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001268 # invalid cpu-map because thread and CPU sets have different sizes.
1269 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0 # invalid
1270 cpu-map auto:1/1 0-3 # invalid
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001271
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001272crt-base <dir>
1273 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +01001274 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
1275 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001276
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001277daemon
1278 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
1279 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +01001280 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
1281 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001282
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001283default-path { current | config | parent | origin <path> }
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001284 By default HAProxy loads all files designated by a relative path from the
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001285 location the process is started in. In some circumstances it might be
1286 desirable to force all relative paths to start from a different location
1287 just as if the process was started from such locations. This is what this
1288 directive is made for. Technically it will perform a temporary chdir() to
1289 the designated location while processing each configuration file, and will
1290 return to the original directory after processing each file. It takes an
1291 argument indicating the policy to use when loading files whose path does
1292 not start with a slash ('/'):
1293 - "current" indicates that all relative files are to be loaded from the
1294 directory the process is started in ; this is the default.
1295
1296 - "config" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1297 directory containing the configuration file. More specifically, if the
1298 configuration file contains a slash ('/'), the longest part up to the
1299 last slash is used as the directory to change to, otherwise the current
1300 directory is used. This mode is convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles,
1301 certificates and Lua scripts together as relocatable packages. When
1302 multiple configuration files are loaded, the directory is updated for
1303 each of them.
1304
1305 - "parent" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1306 parent of the directory containing the configuration file. More
1307 specifically, if the configuration file contains a slash ('/'), ".."
1308 is appended to the longest part up to the last slash is used as the
1309 directory to change to, otherwise the directory is "..". This mode is
1310 convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles, certificates and Lua scripts
1311 together as relocatable packages, but where each part is located in a
1312 different subdirectory (e.g. "config/", "certs/", "maps/", ...).
1313
1314 - "origin" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1315 designated (mandatory) path. This may be used to ease management of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001316 different HAProxy instances running in parallel on a system, where each
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001317 instance uses a different prefix but where the rest of the sections are
1318 made easily relocatable.
1319
1320 Each "default-path" directive instantly replaces any previous one and will
1321 possibly result in switching to a different directory. While this should
1322 always result in the desired behavior, it is really not a good practice to
1323 use multiple default-path directives, and if used, the policy ought to remain
1324 consistent across all configuration files.
1325
1326 Warning: some configuration elements such as maps or certificates are
1327 uniquely identified by their configured path. By using a relocatable layout,
1328 it becomes possible for several of them to end up with the same unique name,
1329 making it difficult to update them at run time, especially when multiple
1330 configuration files are loaded from different directories. It is essential to
1331 observe a strict collision-free file naming scheme before adopting relative
1332 paths. A robust approach could consist in prefixing all files names with
1333 their respective site name, or in doing so at the directory level.
1334
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001335deviceatlas-json-file <path>
1336 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001337 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001338
1339deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001340 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001341 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
1342
1343deviceatlas-separator <char>
1344 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
1345 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
1346
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +01001347deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001348 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
1349 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
1350 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +01001351
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +02001352expose-experimental-directives
1353 This statement must appear before using directives tagged as experimental or
1354 the config file will be rejected.
1355
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001356external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001357 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
1358 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001359 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
1360 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
1361 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
1362 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
1363 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001364
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02001365fd-hard-limit <number>
1366 Sets an upper bound to the maximum number of file descriptors that the
1367 process will use, regardless of system limits. While "ulimit-n" and "maxconn"
1368 may be used to enforce a value, when they are not set, the process will be
1369 limited to the hard limit of the RLIMIT_NOFILE setting as reported by
1370 "ulimit -n -H". But some modern operating systems are now allowing extremely
1371 large values here (in the order of 1 billion), which will consume way too
1372 much RAM for regular usage. The fd-hard-limit setting is provided to enforce
1373 a possibly lower bound to this limit. This means that it will always respect
1374 the system-imposed limits when they are below <number> but the specified
1375 value will be used if system-imposed limits are higher. In the example below,
1376 no other setting is specified and the maxconn value will automatically adapt
1377 to the lower of "fd-hard-limit" and the system-imposed limit:
1378
1379 global
1380 # use as many FDs as possible but no more than 50000
1381 fd-hard-limit 50000
1382
1383 See also: ulimit-n, maxconn
1384
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001385gid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001386 Changes the process's group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001387 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1388 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001389 Note that if HAProxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +01001390 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001391 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001392
Willy Tarreau10080712021-09-07 10:49:45 +02001393grace <time>
1394 Defines a delay between SIGUSR1 and real soft-stop.
1395
1396 Arguments :
1397 <time> is an extra delay (by default in milliseconds) after receipt of the
1398 SIGUSR1 signal that will be waited for before proceeding with the
1399 soft-stop operation.
1400
1401 This is used for compatibility with legacy environments where the haproxy
1402 process needs to be stopped but some external components need to detect the
1403 status before listeners are unbound. The principle is that the internal
1404 "stopping" variable (which is reported by the "stopping" sample fetch
1405 function) will be turned to true, but listeners will continue to accept
1406 connections undisturbed, until the delay expires, after what the regular
1407 soft-stop will proceed. This must not be used with processes that are
1408 reloaded, or this will prevent the old process from unbinding, and may
1409 prevent the new one from starting, or simply cause trouble.
1410
1411 Example:
1412
1413 global
1414 grace 10s
1415
1416 # Returns 200 OK until stopping is set via SIGUSR1
1417 frontend ext-check
1418 bind :9999
1419 monitor-uri /ext-check
1420 monitor fail if { stopping }
1421
1422 Please note that a more flexible and durable approach would instead consist
1423 for an orchestration system in setting a global variable from the CLI, use
1424 that variable to respond to external checks, then after a delay send the
1425 SIGUSR1 signal.
1426
1427 Example:
1428
1429 # Returns 200 OK until proc.stopping is set to non-zero. May be done
1430 # from HTTP using set-var(proc.stopping) or from the CLI using:
1431 # > set var proc.stopping int(1)
1432 frontend ext-check
1433 bind :9999
1434 monitor-uri /ext-check
1435 monitor fail if { var(proc.stopping) -m int gt 0 }
1436
1437 See also: hard-stop-after, monitor
1438
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +01001439group <group name>
1440 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
1441 See also "gid" and "user".
1442
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +01001443hard-stop-after <time>
1444 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
1445
1446 Arguments :
1447 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
1448 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
1449 SIGUSR1 signal.
1450
1451 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
1452 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
1453 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
1454
1455 Example:
1456 global
1457 hard-stop-after 30s
1458
Willy Tarreau10080712021-09-07 10:49:45 +02001459 See also: grace
1460
Christopher Faulet0f9c0f52022-05-13 09:20:13 +02001461h1-accept-payload-with-any-method
1462 Does not reject HTTP/1.0 GET/HEAD/DELETE requests with a payload.
1463
1464 While It is explicitly allowed in HTTP/1.1, HTTP/1.0 is not clear on this
1465 point and some old servers don't expect any payload and never look for body
1466 length (via Content-Length or Transfer-Encoding headers). It means that some
1467 intermediaries may properly handle the payload for HTTP/1.0 GET/HEAD/DELETE
1468 requests, while some others may totally ignore it. That may lead to security
1469 issues because a request smuggling attack is possible. Thus, by default,
1470 HAProxy rejects HTTP/1.0 GET/HEAD/DELETE requests with a payload.
1471
1472 However, it may be an issue with some old clients. In this case, this global
1473 option may be set.
1474
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001475h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
1476 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
1477 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
1478 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
1479 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001480 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001481 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
1482 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
1483 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
1484 specified in a proxy.
1485
1486 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
1487 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
1488 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
1489 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
1490 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
1491 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
1492 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
1493
1494 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
1495 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
1496 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
1497 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
1498 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
1499
1500 Example:
1501 global
1502 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
1503
1504 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1505 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1506
1507h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
1508 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
1509 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
1510 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
1511 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
1512 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
1513 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
1514 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
1515 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
1516
1517 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
1518 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
1519 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
1520
1521 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1522 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1523
William Lallemandde1803f2022-05-04 18:14:25 +02001524httpclient.ssl.ca-file <cafile>
1525 This option defines the ca-file which should be used to verify the server
1526 certificate. It takes the same parameters as the "ca-file" option on the
1527 server line.
1528
1529 By default and when this option is not used, the value is
1530 "@system-ca" which tries to load the CA of the system. If it fails the SSL
1531 will be disabled for the httpclient.
1532
1533 However, when this option is explicitly enabled it will trigger a
1534 configuration error if it fails.
1535
1536httpclient.ssl.verify [none|required]
1537 Works the same way as the verify option on server lines. If specified to 'none',
1538 servers certificates are not verified. Default option is "required".
1539
1540 By default and when this option is not used, the value is
1541 "required". If it fails the SSL will be disabled for the httpclient.
1542
1543 However, when this option is explicitly enabled it will trigger a
1544 configuration error if it fails.
1545
1546httpclient.resolvers.id <resolvers id>
1547 This option defines the resolvers section with which the httpclient will try
1548 to resolve.
1549
1550 Default option is the "default" resolvers ID. By default, if this option is
1551 not used, it will simply disable the resolving if the section is not found.
1552
1553 However, when this option is explicitly enabled it will trigger a
1554 configuration error if it fails to load.
1555
1556httpclient.resolvers.prefer <ipv4|ipv6>
1557 This option allows to chose which family of IP you want when resolving,
1558 which is convenient when IPv6 is not available on your network. Default
1559 option is "ipv6".
1560
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001561insecure-fork-wanted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001562 By default HAProxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001563 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
1564 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
1565 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
1566 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
1567 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
1568 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
1569 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001570 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within HAProxy itself
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001571 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
1572 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
1573 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
1574 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
1575 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
1576 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
1577 disable it.
1578
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001579insecure-setuid-wanted
1580 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
1581 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
1582 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
1583 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001584 aware of the risks. In a situation where HAProxy would need to call external
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001585 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001586 HAProxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001587 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
1588 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001589 escalation in such a situation. This is what HAProxy does by default. In case
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001590 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
1591 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
1592 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
1593 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
1594
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001595issuers-chain-path <dir>
1596 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
1597 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
1598 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001599 intermediate certificate), HAProxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001600 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
1601 "issuers-chain-path".
1602 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
1603 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
1604 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
1605 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
1606 will share the chain in memory.
1607
Amaury Denoyellebefeae82021-07-09 17:14:30 +02001608h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
1609 This disables the announcement of the support for h2 websockets to clients.
1610 This can be use to overcome clients which have issues when implementing the
1611 relatively fresh RFC8441, such as Firefox 88. To allow clients to
1612 automatically downgrade to http/1.1 for the websocket tunnel, specify h2
1613 support on the bind line using "alpn" without an explicit "proto" keyword. If
1614 this statement was previously activated, this can be disabled by prefixing
1615 the keyword with "no'.
1616
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001617localpeer <name>
1618 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
1619 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
1620 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
1621 the configuration parsing.
1622
1623 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
1624 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
1625
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01001626log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001627 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +01001628 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001629 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001630 configured with "log global".
1631
1632 <address> can be one of:
1633
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001634 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001635 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1636 port).
1637
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01001638 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
1639 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1640 port).
1641
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001642 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001643 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1644 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001645 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001646
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001647 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1648 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1649 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1650 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1651 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1652 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1653 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1654 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1655 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1656 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001657 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow HAProxy down
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001658 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1659 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1660 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001661 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1662 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001663
1664 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1665 "fd@2", see above.
1666
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001667 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1668 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1669 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1670 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1671 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1672
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001673 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1674 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001675
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001676 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1677 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1678 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1679 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1680 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1681 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1682 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1683 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1684 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1685 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001686 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1687 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001688
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001689 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1690 one of the following :
1691
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01001692 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
1693 field is stripped. This is the default.
1694 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
1695 rfc3164.
1696
1697 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001698 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1699
1700 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1701 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1702
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001703 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1704 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1705 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1706 designed to be used with a local log server.
1707
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001708 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1709 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1710 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1711 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1712 logger consumes.
1713
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001714 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1715 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1716 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1717 used with a local log server.
1718
1719 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1720 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1721 designed to be used with a local log server.
1722
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001723 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1724 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1725 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1726 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1727
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001728 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1729 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1730 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1731 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1732 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1733
1734 <sample_size>
1735 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1736 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1737 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1738 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1739 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1740
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001741 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001742
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001743 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1744 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1745 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1746
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001747 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1748 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1749 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1750 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001751
1752 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001753 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1754 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1755 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1756 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1757 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1758 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001759
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001760 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001761
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001762log-send-hostname [<string>]
1763 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1764 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1765 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1766 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1767 the logs.
1768
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001769log-tag <string>
1770 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1771 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1772 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001773 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001774
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001775lua-load <file>
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001776 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file in the shared context
1777 that is visible to all threads. Any variable set in such a context is visible
1778 from any thread. This is the easiest and recommended way to load Lua programs
1779 but it will not scale well if a lot of Lua calls are performed, as only one
1780 thread may be running on the global state at a time. A program loaded this
1781 way will always see 0 in the "core.thread" variable. This directive can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001782 used multiple times.
1783
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001784lua-load-per-thread <file>
1785 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file into each started thread.
1786 Any global variable has a thread-local visibility so that each thread could
1787 see a different value. As such it is strongly recommended not to use global
1788 variables in programs loaded this way. An independent copy is loaded and
1789 initialized for each thread, everything is done sequentially and in the
1790 thread's numeric order from 1 to nbthread. If some operations need to be
1791 performed only once, the program should check the "core.thread" variable to
1792 figure what thread is being initialized. Programs loaded this way will run
1793 concurrently on all threads and will be highly scalable. This is the
1794 recommended way to load simple functions that register sample-fetches,
1795 converters, actions or services once it is certain the program doesn't depend
1796 on global variables. For the sake of simplicity, the directive is available
1797 even if only one thread is used and even if threads are disabled (in which
1798 case it will be equivalent to lua-load). This directive can be used multiple
1799 times.
1800
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001801lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1802 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1803 variable.
1804 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1805 to "path".
1806
1807 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1808 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1809 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1810 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1811 will be checked earlier.
1812
1813 As an example by specifying the following path:
1814
1815 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1816 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1817
1818 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1819 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1820 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1821 paths if that does not exist either.
1822
1823 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1824 documentation.
1825
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001826master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001827 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1828 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1829 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001830 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001831 or daemon mode.
1832
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001833 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1834 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1835 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1836 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1837 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001838
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001839 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001840
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001841mworker-max-reloads <number>
1842 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001843 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001844 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1845 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1846 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1847
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001848nbthread <number>
1849 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02001850 makes HAProxy run on <number> threads. "nbthread" also works when HAProxy is
1851 started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity, the default
1852 "nbthread" value is automatically set to the number of CPUs the process is
1853 bound to upon startup. This means that the thread count can easily be
1854 adjusted from the calling process using commands like "taskset" or "cpuset".
1855 Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default value is reported in the
1856 output of "haproxy -vv".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001857
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001858numa-cpu-mapping
Amaury Denoyelleb09f4472021-12-15 09:48:39 +01001859 If running on a NUMA-aware platform, HAProxy inspects on startup the CPU
1860 topology of the machine. If a multi-socket machine is detected, the affinity
1861 is automatically calculated to run on the CPUs of a single node. This is done
1862 in order to not suffer from the performance penalties caused by the
1863 inter-socket bus latency. However, if the applied binding is non optimal on a
1864 particular architecture, it can be disabled with the statement 'no
1865 numa-cpu-mapping'. This automatic binding is also not applied if a nbthread
1866 statement is present in the configuration, or the affinity of the process is
1867 already specified, for example via the 'cpu-map' directive or the taskset
1868 utility.
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001869
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001870pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09001871 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
1872 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
1873 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
1874 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001875
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001876pp2-never-send-local
1877 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
1878 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
1879 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
1880 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
1881 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
1882 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
1883 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
1884 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
1885 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
1886 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
1887 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
1888
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001889presetenv <name> <value>
1890 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1891 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1892 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1893 and "unsetenv".
1894
1895resetenv [<name> ...]
1896 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1897 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1898 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1899 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1900 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1901 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1902 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1903 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1904
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001905stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001906 Deprecated. Before threads were supported, this was used to force some stats
1907 instances on certain processes only. The default and only accepted value is
1908 "1" (along with "all" and "odd" which alias it). Do not use this setting.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001909
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001910server-state-base <directory>
1911 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001912 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1913 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001914
1915server-state-file <file>
1916 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1917 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1918 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1919 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1920 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1921 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1922 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1923 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001924 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1925 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001926
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001927set-var <var-name> <expr>
1928 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the result of the evaluation
1929 of the sample expression <expr>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
1930 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
1931 'set-var' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is evaluated
1932 at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly set. The
1933 sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression are only
Willy Tarreau753d4db2021-09-03 09:02:47 +02001934 those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'. It is
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001935 possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These variables
1936 will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
1937
1938 Example:
1939 global
1940 set-var proc.current_state str(primary)
1941 set-var proc.prio int(100)
1942 set-var proc.threshold int(200),sub(proc.prio)
1943
Willy Tarreau753d4db2021-09-03 09:02:47 +02001944set-var-fmt <var-name> <fmt>
1945 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the string resulting from the
1946 evaluation of the log-format <fmt>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
1947 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
1948 'set-var-fmt' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is
1949 evaluated at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly
1950 set. The sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression
1951 are only those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'.
1952 It is possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These
1953 variables will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
1954 Please see section 8.2.4 for details on the log-format syntax.
1955
1956 Example:
1957 global
1958 set-var-fmt proc.current_state "primary"
1959 set-var-fmt proc.bootid "%pid|%t"
1960
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001961setenv <name> <value>
1962 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1963 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1964 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1965 and "unsetenv".
1966
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001967set-dumpable
1968 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001969 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1970 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1971 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1972 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1973 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1974 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1975 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1976 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1977 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1978 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1979 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1980 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1981 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1982 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1983 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001984 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the "haproxy" process and verify that it
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001985 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001986
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001987ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1988 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1989 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001990 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001991 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001992 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1993 information and recommendations see e.g.
1994 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1995 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1996 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1997 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001998
1999ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
2000 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
2001 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
2002 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
2003 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
2004 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00002005 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
2006 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
2007 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02002008 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01002009
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02002010ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
2011 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2012 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
2013 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
2014 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
2015 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
2016
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01002017ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
2018 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2019 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
2020 keyword to see available options.
2021
2022 Example:
2023 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02002024 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01002025
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01002026ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
2027 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
2028 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00002029 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02002030 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00002031 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
2032 information and recommendations see e.g.
2033 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
2034 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
2035 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
2036 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
2037 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02002038
2039ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
2040 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
2041 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
2042 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
2043 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
2044 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00002045 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
2046 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
2047 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
2048 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01002049
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01002050ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
2051 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2052 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
2053 keyword to see available options.
2054
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002055ssl-dh-param-file <file>
2056 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2057 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
2058 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002059 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002060 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02002061 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1d6338e2022-04-12 11:31:55 +02002062 directly in the certificate file, DHE ciphers will not be used, unless
2063 tune.ssl.default-dh-param is set. In this latter case, pre-defined DH
2064 parameters of the specified size will be used. Custom parameters are known to
2065 be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002066 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
2067 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
2068 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
2069
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone8097652022-05-16 16:24:32 +02002070ssl-propquery <query>
2071 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and when
2072 OpenSSL's version is at least 3.0. It allows to define a default property
2073 string used when fetching algorithms in providers. It behave the same way as
2074 the openssl propquery option and it follows the same syntax (described in
2075 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man3.0/man7/property.html). For instance, if you
2076 have two providers loaded, the foo one and the default one, the propquery
2077 "?provider=foo" allows to pick the algorithm implementations provided by the
2078 foo provider by default, and to fallback on the default provider's one if it
2079 was not found.
2080
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1746a382022-05-16 16:24:33 +02002081ssl-provider <name>
2082 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and when
2083 OpenSSL's version is at least 3.0. It allows to load a provider during init.
2084 If loading is successful, any capabilities provided by the loaded provider
2085 might be used by HAProxy. Multiple 'ssl-provider' options can be specified in
2086 a configuration file. The providers will be loaded in their order of
2087 appearance.
2088 Please note that loading a provider explicitely prevents OpenSSL from loading
2089 the 'default' provider automatically. OpenSSL also allows to define the
2090 providers that should be loaded directly in its configuration file
2091 (openssl.cnf for instance) so it is not necessary to use this 'ssl-provider'
2092 option to load providers. The "show ssl providers" CLI command can be used to
2093 show all the providers that were successfully loaded.
2094 The default search path of OpenSSL provider can be found in the output of the
2095 "openssl version -a" command. If the provider is in another directory, you
2096 can set the OPENSSL_MODULES environment variable, which takes the directory
2097 where your provider can be found.
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonccc03552022-05-17 15:18:37 +02002098 See also "ssl-propquery" and "ssl-provider-path".
2099
2100ssl-provider-path <path>
2101 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and when
2102 OpenSSL's version is at least 3.0. It allows to specify the search path that
2103 is to be used by OpenSSL for looking for providers. It behaves the same way
2104 as the OPENSSL_MODULES environment variable. It will be used for any
2105 following 'ssl-provider' option or until a new 'ssl-provider-path' is
2106 defined.
2107 See also "ssl-provider".
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1746a382022-05-16 16:24:33 +02002108
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02002109ssl-load-extra-del-ext
2110 This setting allows to configure the way HAProxy does the lookup for the
2111 extra SSL files. By default HAProxy adds a new extension to the filename.
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02002112 (ex: with "foobar.crt" load "foobar.crt.key"). With this option enabled,
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02002113 HAProxy removes the extension before adding the new one (ex: with
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02002114 "foobar.crt" load "foobar.key").
2115
2116 Your crt file must have a ".crt" extension for this option to work.
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02002117
2118 This option is not compatible with bundle extensions (.ecdsa, .rsa. .dsa)
2119 and won't try to remove them.
2120
2121 This option is disabled by default. See also "ssl-load-extra-files".
2122
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01002123ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002124 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002125 the loading of the SSL certificates. This option applies to certificates
2126 associated to "bind" lines as well as "server" lines but some of the extra
2127 files will not have any functional impact for "server" line certificates.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002128
2129 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
2130 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
2131 optimize the startup time.
2132
2133 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
2134 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
2135 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
2136
2137 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01002138 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002139
2140 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002141 will try to load a "cert bundle". Certificate bundles are only managed on the
2142 frontend side and will not work for backend certificates.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002143
2144 Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
2145 certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
2146 store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
2147 required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
2148 backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002149 bind configuration.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002150
2151 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002152 HAProxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002153 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
2154 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
2155 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
2156 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
2157 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002158 this bundle into HAProxy, specify the base name only:
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002159
2160 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
2161
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002162 Note that the suffix is not given to HAProxy; this tells HAProxy to look for
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002163 a cert bundle.
2164
2165 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
2166 separately in several "crt".
2167
2168 The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
2169 since files are loading separately.
2170
2171 On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
2172 required to commit them.
2173
William Dauchy57dd6f12020-10-06 15:22:37 +02002174 OCSP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002175 as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002176
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002177 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword. If provided for
2178 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
2179 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002180
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002181 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword. If provided for
2182 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
2183 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002184
2185 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002186 not provided in the PEM file. If provided for a backend certificate, it will
2187 be loaded but will not have any functional impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002188
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01002189 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
2190 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
2191
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002192 The default behavior is "all".
2193
2194 Example:
2195 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
2196 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
2197 ssl-load-extra-files none
2198
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002199 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options and section 5.2 about server
2200 options.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002201
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01002202ssl-server-verify [none|required]
2203 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
2204 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
2205 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
2206
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002207ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002208 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002209 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
2210 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
2211 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
2212 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
2213 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
2214 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02002215 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002216
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02002217stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
2218 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
2219 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
2220 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02002221 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02002222 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02002223
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02002224 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
2225 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
2226 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002227
2228stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
2229 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
2230 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01002231 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002232
2233stats maxconn <connections>
2234 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
2235 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
2236
Willy Tarreaud04bc3a2021-09-27 13:55:10 +02002237thread-group <group> [<thread-range>...]
2238 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
2239 enumerates the list of threads that will compose thread group <group>.
2240 Thread numbers and group numbers start at 1. Thread ranges are defined either
2241 using a single thread number at once, or by specifying the lower and upper
2242 bounds delimited by a dash '-' (e.g. "1-16"). Unassigned threads will be
2243 automatically assigned to unassigned thread groups, and thread groups
2244 defined with this directive will never receive more threads than those
2245 defined. Defining the same group multiple times overrides previous
2246 definitions with the new one. See also "nbthread" and "thread-groups".
2247
Willy Tarreauc33b9692021-09-22 12:07:23 +02002248thread-groups <number>
2249 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
2250 makes HAProxy split its threads into <number> independent groups. At the
2251 moment, the limit is 1 and is also the default value. See also "nbthread".
2252
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002253uid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07002254 Changes the process's user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002255 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
2256 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
2257 one. See also "gid" and "user".
2258
2259ulimit-n <number>
2260 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
2261 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02002262 option. If the intent is only to limit the number of file descriptors, better
2263 use "fd-hard-limit" instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002264
Amaury Denoyelle414a6122021-08-06 10:25:32 +02002265 Note that the dynamic servers are not taken into account in this automatic
2266 resource calculation. If using a large number of them, it may be needed to
2267 manually specify this value.
2268
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02002269 See also: fd-hard-limit, maxconn
2270
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002271unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
2272 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
2273
2274 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
2275 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
2276 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
2277 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
2278 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002279 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before HAProxy chroots
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002280 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
2281 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
2282 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
2283 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
2284
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002285unsetenv [<name> ...]
2286 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
2287 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
2288 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
2289 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
2290 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
2291 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
2292 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
2293
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002294user <user name>
2295 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2296 See also "uid" and "group".
2297
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02002298node <name>
2299 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
2300
2301 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
2302 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
2303 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
2304 traffic.
2305
2306description <text>
2307 Add a text that describes the instance.
2308
2309 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
2310 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
2311 "<" and ">" characters.
2312
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100231351degrees-data-file <file path>
2314 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002315 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002316
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002317 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002318 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2319
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000232051degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002321 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
2322 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
2323 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
2324
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002325 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002326 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2327
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200232851degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002329 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
2330 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
2331
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002332 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02002333 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2334
233551degrees-cache-size <number>
2336 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
2337 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
2338 By default, this cache is disabled.
2339
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002340 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002341 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2342
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002343wurfl-data-file <file path>
2344 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
2345 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
2346
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002347 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002348 with USE_WURFL=1.
2349
2350wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
2351 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
2352 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
2353 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
2354
2355 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
2356
2357 Valid WURFL properties are:
2358 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
2359
2360 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
2361 device.
2362
2363 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
2364 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
2365
2366 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
2367 particular web request.
2368
2369 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
2370 used Libwurfl API version.
2371
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002372 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
2373 wurfl.xml and its full path.
2374
2375 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
2376 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
2377
2378 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
2379
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002380 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002381 with USE_WURFL=1.
2382
2383wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
2384 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
2385 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
2386
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002387 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002388 with USE_WURFL=1.
2389
2390wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
2391 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
2392 thus before the chroot.
2393
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002394 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002395 with USE_WURFL=1.
2396
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02002397wurfl-cache-size <size>
2398 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
2399 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002400 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02002401 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002402
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002403 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002404 with USE_WURFL=1.
2405
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01002406strict-limits
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002407 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. HAProxy tries to set the
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01002408 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
2409 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002410 HAProxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01002411 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01002412
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020024133.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002414-----------------------
2415
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01002416busy-polling
2417 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
2418 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
2419 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
2420 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
2421 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
2422 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
2423 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
2424 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
2425 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
2426 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
2427 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
2428 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
2429 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
2430 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
2431 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
2432 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
2433 "poll" pollers.
2434
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01002435 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
2436 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
2437 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
2438
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002439max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002440 By default, HAProxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002441 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
2442 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
2443 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
2444 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
2445 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
2446 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
2447 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
2448
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002449maxconn <number>
2450 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
2451 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
2452 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02002453 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
2454 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
2455 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
2456 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01002457 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
2458 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
2459 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
2460 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
2461 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02002462 also be automatic). In any case, the fd-hard-limit applies if set.
2463
2464 See also: fd-hard-limit, ulimit-n
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002465
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02002466maxconnrate <number>
2467 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
2468 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2469 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2470 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2471 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2472 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2473 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2474 fairness.
2475
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002476maxcomprate <number>
2477 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002478 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002479 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
2480 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
2481 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002482 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002483 default value.
2484
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01002485maxcompcpuusage <number>
2486 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
2487 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
2488 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02002489 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by HAProxy. A
2490 value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting a lower
2491 value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole process down
2492 and from introducing high latencies.
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01002493
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002494maxpipes <number>
2495 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
2496 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
2497 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
2498 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
2499 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
2500 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
2501
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02002502maxsessrate <number>
2503 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
2504 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2505 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2506 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2507 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2508 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2509 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2510 fairness.
2511
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002512maxsslconn <number>
2513 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
2514 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
2515 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
2516 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
2517 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
2518 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
2519 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002520 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
2521 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
2522 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
2523 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002524 when there is a memory limit, HAProxy will automatically adjust these values
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002525 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
2526 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002527
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02002528maxsslrate <number>
2529 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
2530 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
2531 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
2532 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
2533 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
2534 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
2535 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
2536 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
2537 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
2538 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
2539
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01002540maxzlibmem <number>
2541 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
2542 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
2543 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01002544 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
2545 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
2546 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
2547
Willy Tarreauc4e56dc2022-03-08 10:41:40 +01002548no-memory-trimming
2549 Disables memory trimming ("malloc_trim") at a few moments where attempts are
2550 made to reclaim lots of memory (on memory shortage or on reload). Trimming
2551 memory forces the system's allocator to scan all unused areas and to release
2552 them. This is generally seen as nice action to leave more available memory to
2553 a new process while the old one is unlikely to make significant use of it.
2554 But some systems dealing with tens to hundreds of thousands of concurrent
2555 connections may experience a lot of memory fragmentation, that may render
2556 this release operation extremely long. During this time, no more traffic
2557 passes through the process, new connections are not accepted anymore, some
2558 health checks may even fail, and the watchdog may even trigger and kill the
2559 unresponsive process, leaving a huge core dump. If this ever happens, then it
2560 is suggested to use this option to disable trimming and stop trying to be
2561 nice with the new process. Note that advanced memory allocators usually do
2562 not suffer from such a problem.
2563
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002564noepoll
2565 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
2566 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01002567 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002568
2569nokqueue
2570 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
2571 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
2572 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
2573
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002574noevports
2575 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
2576 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
2577 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
2578 also "nopoll".
2579
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002580nopoll
2581 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
2582 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002583 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002584 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
2585 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002586
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002587nosplice
2588 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002589 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002590 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002591 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002592 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
2593 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
2594 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
2595 "option splice-response".
2596
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002597nogetaddrinfo
2598 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
2599 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
2600
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00002601noreuseport
2602 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
2603 command line argument "-dR".
2604
Willy Tarreauca3afc22021-05-05 18:33:19 +02002605profiling.memory { on | off }
2606 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-function memory profiling. This will
2607 keep usage statistics of malloc/calloc/realloc/free calls anywhere in the
2608 process (including libraries) which will be reported on the CLI using the
2609 "show profiling" command. This is essentially meant to be used when an
2610 abnormal memory usage is observed that cannot be explained by the pools and
2611 other info are required. The performance hit will typically be around 1%,
2612 maybe a bit more on highly threaded machines, so it is normally suitable for
2613 use in production. The same may be achieved at run time on the CLI using the
2614 "set profiling memory" command, please consult the management manual.
2615
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002616profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
2617 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
2618 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
2619 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
2620 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002621 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002622 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
2623 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
2624 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
2625 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
2626
2627 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
2628 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
2629 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
2630 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
2631 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01002632 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
2633 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
2634 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
2635 CLI.
2636
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002637spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09002638 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
2639 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
2640 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
2641 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
2642 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
2643 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002644
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002645ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002646 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002647 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002648 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002649 unsupported engine will prevent HAProxy from starting. Note that many engines
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002650 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
2651 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
2652 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002653 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
2654 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002655 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
2656 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
2657 openssl configuration file uses:
2658 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
2659
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002660ssl-mode-async
2661 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02002662 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002663 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
2664 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002665 HAProxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002666 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002667 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002668
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002669tune.buffers.limit <number>
2670 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
2671 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
2672 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
2673 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
2674 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002675 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002676 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
2677 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
2678 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
2679 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
2680 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
2681 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
2682 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
2683 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002684 advised to do so by an HAProxy core developer.
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002685
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002686tune.buffers.reserve <number>
2687 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
2688 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
2689 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002690 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at HAProxy core developers.
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002691
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002692tune.bufsize <number>
2693 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
2694 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
2695 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
2696 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
2697 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
2698 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
2699 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01002700 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
2701 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002702 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), HAProxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04002703 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002704 than this size, HAProxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01002705 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
2706 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002707
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01002708tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
2709 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
2710 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
2711 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
2712 this value. The default value is 1.
2713
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002714tune.fail-alloc
Willy Tarreauf4b79c42022-02-23 15:20:53 +01002715 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC or started with "-dMfail", gives the
2716 percentage of chances an allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no
2717 failure) and 100 (no success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory
2718 failures are handled gracefully.
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002719
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02002720tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2721 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
2722 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
2723 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
2724 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
2725 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
2726
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02002727tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
2728 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
2729 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
2730 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
2731 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
2732 change it.
2733
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002734tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
2735 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002736 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from HAProxy. This setting
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002737 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002738 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
2739 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
2740 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
2741 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
2742 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
2743
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002744tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
2745 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
2746 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
2747 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
2748 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
2749 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002750 client may create as many streams as allocatable by HAProxy. It is highly
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002751 recommended not to change this value.
2752
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002753tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002754 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that HAProxy announces it is willing to
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002755 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002756 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, HAProxy will not announce support
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002757 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
2758 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
2759 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
2760 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
2761
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002762tune.http.cookielen <number>
2763 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
2764 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
2765 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
2766 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
2767 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
2768 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
2769 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
2770 to change this value.
2771
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002772tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002773 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
2774 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002775 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002776 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002777 configuration directives too.
2778 The default value is 1024.
2779
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002780tune.http.maxhdr <number>
2781 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
2782 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
2783 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
2784 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
2785 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
2786 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02002787 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
2788 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
2789 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002790
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002791tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
2792 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
2793 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
2794 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
2795 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
2796 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
2797 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +01002798 this option to "off". The default is on. It is strongly recommended against
2799 disabling this option without setting a conservative value on "pool-low-conn"
2800 for all servers relying on connection reuse to achieve a high performance
2801 level, otherwise connections might be closed very often as the thread count
2802 increases.
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002803
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002804tune.idletimer <timeout>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002805 Sets the duration after which HAProxy will consider that an empty buffer is
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002806 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
2807 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
2808 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
2809 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002810 means that HAProxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002811 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002812 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002813 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
2814
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01002815tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
2816 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
2817 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
2818 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
2819 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
2820 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
2821 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
2822 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
2823 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
2824 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
2825
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002826tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
2827 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01002828 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002829 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
2830 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002831 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002832 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
2833 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
2834
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01002835tune.lua.maxmem
2836 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
2837 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
2838 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
2839 memory.
2840
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002841tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
2842 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002843 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2844 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002845 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002846
2847tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
2848 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
2849 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
2850 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
2851 check servers.
2852
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002853tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2854 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2855 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2856 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002857 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002858
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002859tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002860 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2861 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
Willy Tarreau66161322021-02-19 15:50:27 +01002862 used to give better performance at high connection rates, though this is not
2863 the case anymore with the multi-queue. This value applies individually to
2864 each listener, so that the number of processes a listener is bound to is
2865 taken into account. This value defaults to 4 which showed best results. If a
2866 significantly higher value was inherited from an ancient config, it might be
2867 worth removing it as it will both increase performance and lower response
2868 time. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice the number of processes
2869 the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1 completely disables the
2870 limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002871
2872tune.maxpollevents <number>
2873 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2874 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2875 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2876 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2877 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2878
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002879tune.maxrewrite <number>
2880 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2881 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2882 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2883 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2884 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2885 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2886 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2887 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2888 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2889 bufsize.
2890
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002891tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2892 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2893 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2894 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2895 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2896 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2897 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2898 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2899 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2900 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002901 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2902 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002903 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2904 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2905 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2906 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2907 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2908 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2909 setting this parameter to 0.
2910
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002911tune.pipesize <number>
2912 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2913 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2914 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2915 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2916 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2917 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2918
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002919tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2920 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002921 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002922 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2923 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2924 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2925 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002926 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002927
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002928tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2929 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002930 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002931 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2932 default is 20.
2933
Amaury Denoyelle97e84c62022-04-19 18:26:55 +02002934tune.quic.conn-buf-limit <number>
2935 Warning: QUIC support in HAProxy is currently experimental. Configuration may
2936 change without deprecation in the future.
2937
2938 This settings defines the maximum number of buffers allocated for a QUIC
2939 connection on data emission. By default, it is set to 30. QUIC buffers are
2940 drained on ACK reception. This setting has a direct impact on the throughput
2941 and memory consumption and can be adjusted according to an estimated round
2942 time-trip.
2943
Frédéric Lécaille1d96d6e2022-05-23 16:38:14 +02002944tune.quic.frontend.max-idle-timeout <timeout>
2945 Warning: QUIC support in HAProxy is currently experimental. Configuration may
2946 change without deprecation in the future.
2947
2948 Sets the QUIC max_idle_timeout transport parameters in milliseconds for
2949 frontends which determines the period of time after which a connection silently
2950 closes if it has remained inactive during an effective period of time deduced
2951 from the two max_idle_timeout values announced by the two endpoints:
2952 - the minimum of the two values if both are not null,
2953 - the maximum if only one of them is not null,
2954 - if both values are null, this feature is disabled.
2955
2956 The default value is 30000.
2957
Frédéric Lécaille26740982022-05-23 17:28:01 +02002958tune.quic.frontend.max-streams-bidi <number>
2959 Warning: QUIC support in HAProxy is currently experimental. Configuration may
2960 change without deprecation in the future.
2961
2962 Sets the QUIC initial_max_streams_bidi transport parameter for frontends.
2963 This is the initial maximum number of bidirectional streams the remote peer
2964 will be authorized to open. This determines the number of concurrent client
2965 requests.
2966
2967 The default value is 100.
2968
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +02002969tune.quic.retry-threshold <number>
2970 Warning: QUIC support in HAProxy is currently experimental. Configuration may
2971 change without deprecation in the future.
2972
2973 Dynamically enables the Retry feature for all the configured QUIC listeners
2974 as soon as this number of opening connections is reached. By opening connection
2975 we mean a connection the handshake of which has not already successfully
2976 completed or failed. To be functional this setting needs a cluster secret to
2977 be set, if not it will be silently ignored (see "cluster-secret" setting).
2978 This setting will be also silenty ignored if the use of QUIC Retry was forced
2979 (see "quic-force-retry").
2980
2981 The default value is 100.
2982
2983 See https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc9000.html#section-8.1.2 for more
2984 information about QUIC retry.
2985
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002986tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2987tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2988 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2989 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2990 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002991 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002992 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002993 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2994 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2995
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002996tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002997 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002998 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2999 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
3000 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
3001 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
3002
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02003003tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003004 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Willy Tarreau060a7612021-03-10 11:06:26 +01003005 tasks. The default value depends on the number of threads but sits between 35
3006 and 280, which tend to show the highest request rates and lowest latencies.
3007 Increasing it may incur latency when dealing with I/Os, making it too small
3008 can incur extra overhead. Higher thread counts benefit from lower values.
3009 When experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
3010 tune.sched.low-latency and possibly tune.fd.edge-triggered to limit the
3011 maximum latency to the lowest possible.
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02003012
3013tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
3014 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003015 HAProxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02003016 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
3017 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
3018 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
3019 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
3020 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
3021 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
3022 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02003023
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01003024tune.sndbuf.client <number>
3025tune.sndbuf.server <number>
3026 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
3027 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
3028 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003029 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003030 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01003031 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
3032 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
3033 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
3034 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003035 notifying HAProxy again.
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01003036
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01003037tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01003038 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
William Dauchy9a4bbfe2021-02-12 15:58:46 +01003039 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate. An
3040 encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks depending
3041 on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately 200 bytes of
3042 memory (based on `sizeof(struct sh_ssl_sess_hdr) + SHSESS_BLOCK_MIN_SIZE`
3043 calculation used for `shctx_init` function). The default value may be forced
3044 at build time, otherwise defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most
3045 idle entries are purged and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence
3046 of such a purge, hence the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring
3047 that all users keep their session as long as possible. All entries are
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02003048 pre-allocated upon startup. Setting this value to 0 disables the SSL session
3049 cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01003050
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02003051tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02003052 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02003053 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
3054 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
3055 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
3056 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
3057 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
3058
Thomas Prückl10243932022-04-27 13:04:54 +02003059tune.ssl.hard-maxrecord <number>
3060 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at any time. Default
3061 value 0 means there is no limit. In contrast to tune.ssl.maxrecord this
3062 settings will not be adjusted dynamically. Smaller records may decrease
3063 throughput, but may be required when dealing with low-footprint clients.
3064
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02003065tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
3066 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
3067 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
3068 performances. This is disabled by default.
3069
3070 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
3071 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
3072
3073 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
3074
3075 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
3076
3077 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
3078
3079 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
3080 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
3081 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
3082
3083 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
3084 converted.
3085
3086 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
3087 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
3088 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
3089 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
3090 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
3091 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
3092 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02003093 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
3094 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02003095
3096 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
3097
3098 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
3099 only need this line:
3100
3101 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
3102
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01003103tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
3104 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003105 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01003106 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
3107 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
3108 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
3109 being used for too long.
3110
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01003111tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
Thomas Prückl10243932022-04-27 13:04:54 +02003112 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at the beginning of
3113 the data transfer. Default value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS,
3114 the client can decipher the data only once it has received a full record.
3115 With large records, it means that clients might have to download up to 16kB
3116 of data before starting to process them. Limiting the value can improve page
3117 load times on browsers located over high latency or low bandwidth networks.
3118 It is suggested to find optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments
3119 (generally 1448 bytes over Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when
3120 timestamps are disabled), keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead.
3121 Typical values of 1419 and 2859 gave good results during tests. Use
3122 "strace -e trace=write" to find the best value. HAProxy will automatically
3123 switch to this setting after an idle stream has been detected (see
3124 tune.idletimer above). See also tune.ssl.hard-maxrecord.
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01003125
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02003126tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
3127 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
3128 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
3129 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
3130 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1d6338e2022-04-12 11:31:55 +02003131 this maximum value. Only 1024 or higher values are allowed. Higher values
3132 will increase the CPU load, and values greater than 1024 bits are not
3133 supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not used if static
3134 Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly in the certificate
3135 file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
3136 If there is neither a default-dh-param nor a ssl-dh-param-file defined, and
3137 if the server's PEM file of a given frontend does not specify its own DH
3138 parameters, then DHE ciphers will be unavailable for this frontend.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02003139
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02003140tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
3141 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
3142 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
3143 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
3144 1000 entries.
3145
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +02003146tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size <number>
3147tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number> (deprecated)
Marcin Deranek769fd2e2021-07-12 14:16:55 +02003148 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client hello cipher
3149 list, extensions list, elliptic curves list and elliptic curve point
3150 formats. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled,
3151 otherwise a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01003152
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003153tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01003154tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003155tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
3156tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
3157tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01003158 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
3159 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
3160 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
3161 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
3162 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
3163 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
3164 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
3165 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003166
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003167 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
3168 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
3169 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
3170 all available space is consumed.
3171 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
3172 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
3173 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003174
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01003175tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
3176 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003177 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01003178 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003179 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01003180 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
3181
3182tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
3183 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
3184 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003185 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
3186 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003187
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020031883.3. Debugging
3189--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003190
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003191quiet
3192 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
3193 line argument "-q".
3194
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02003195zero-warning
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003196 When this option is set, HAProxy will refuse to start if any warning was
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02003197 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
3198 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
3199 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
3200 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
3201 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
3202
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003203
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010032043.4. Userlists
3205--------------
3206It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
3207http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
3208it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
3209
3210userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003211 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003212 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
3213
3214group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003215 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003216 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
3217 proceeded by "users" keyword.
3218
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003219user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
3220 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003221 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
3222 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01003223 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
3224 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
3225 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
3226 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003227
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01003228 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
3229 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
3230 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
3231 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
3232 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
3233 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
3234 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003235 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in HAProxy's
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01003236 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003237
3238 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003239 userlist L1
3240 group G1 users tiger,scott
3241 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003242
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003243 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
3244 user scott insecure-password elgato
3245 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003246
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003247 userlist L2
3248 group G1
3249 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003250
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003251 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
3252 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
3253 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003254
3255 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003256
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003257
32583.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003259----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02003260It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003261several HAProxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02003262instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
Willy Tarreaudb2ab822021-10-08 17:53:12 +02003263values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. As an exception, the data
3264type "conn_cur" is never learned from peers, as it is supposed to reflect local
3265values. Earlier versions used to synchronize it and to cause negative values in
3266active-active setups, and always-growing values upon reloads or active-passive
3267switches because the local value would reflect more connections than locally
3268present. This information, however, is pushed so that monitoring systems can
3269watch it.
3270
3271Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
3272known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
3273the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
3274process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
3275during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
3276tables.
3277
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02003278Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
3279that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
3280each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003281
3282peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003283 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003284 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
3285
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003286bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
3287 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
3288 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
3289
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02003290disabled
3291 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
3292 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
3293 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
3294
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003295default-bind [param*]
3296 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
3297
3298default-server [param*]
3299 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
3300
3301 Arguments:
3302 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3303 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3304 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3305 details.
3306
3307
3308 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
3309
Emeric Brun620761f2021-09-29 10:29:52 +02003310enabled
3311 This re-enables a peers section which was previously disabled via the
3312 "disabled" keyword.
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02003313
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003314log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01003315 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3316 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
3317 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
3318 more details.
3319
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003320peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003321 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
3322 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003323 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003324 HAProxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003325 Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
3326 remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
3327 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003328
3329 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
3330 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
3331
3332 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003333 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
3334 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
3335 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003336
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003337 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
3338 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003339
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003340 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
3341 "server" keyword explanation below).
3342
3343server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003344 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003345 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
3346 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
Aleksandar Lazic332258a2022-03-30 00:11:40 +02003347 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003348 of this "peers" section).
3349 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
3350
3351
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003352 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003353 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003354 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003355 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
3356 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
3357 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003358
3359 backend mybackend
3360 mode tcp
3361 balance roundrobin
3362 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
3363 stick on src
3364
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003365 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3366 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003367
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003368 Example:
3369 peers mypeers
3370 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
3371 default-server ssl verify none
3372 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
3373 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003374
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003375
3376table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
3377 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
3378
3379 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
3380 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003381 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003382 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
3383 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
3384 "stick-table" keyword).
3385
3386 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
3387 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
3388 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
3389 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
3390 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
3391 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
3392 of the stick-table name as follows:
3393
3394 peers mypeers
3395 peer A ...
3396 peer B ...
3397 table t1 ...
3398
3399 frontend fe1
3400 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
3401
3402 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
3403 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
3404
3405 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
3406 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
3407 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
3408 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
3409 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
3410 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
3411 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
3412
3413 peers mypeers
3414 peer A ...
3415 peer B ...
3416 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
3417
3418 backend t1
3419 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
3420
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003421 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003422 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
3423 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
3424
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090034253.6. Mailers
3426------------
3427It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
3428If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
3429in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
3430
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02003431mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003432 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
3433 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
3434
3435mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
3436 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
3437
3438 Example:
3439 mailers mymailers
3440 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
3441 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
3442
3443 backend mybackend
3444 mode tcp
3445 balance roundrobin
3446
3447 email-alert mailers mymailers
3448 email-alert from test1@horms.org
3449 email-alert to test2@horms.org
3450
3451 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3452 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
3453
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01003454timeout mail <time>
3455 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
3456 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
3457 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
3458 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
3459
3460 Example:
3461 mailers mymailers
3462 timeout mail 20s
3463 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003464
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020034653.7. Programs
3466-------------
3467In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
3468master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
3469managed the same way as the workers.
3470
3471During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
3472sequence as a worker:
3473
3474 - the master is re-executed
3475 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
3476 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
3477 instance of the program
3478
3479During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
3480
3481program <name>
3482 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
3483 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
3484 the management guide).
3485
3486command <command> [arguments*]
3487 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
3488 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
3489 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
3490 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
3491
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08003492user <user name>
3493 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
3494 See also "group".
3495
3496group <group name>
3497 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
3498 See also "user".
3499
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02003500option start-on-reload
3501no option start-on-reload
3502 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
3503 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
3504 program section.
3505
3506
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010035073.8. HTTP-errors
3508----------------
3509
3510It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
3511imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
3512several places and can be fully or partially imported.
3513
3514http-errors <name>
3515 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
3516 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
3517
3518errorfile <code> <file>
3519 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
3520
3521 Arguments :
3522 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02003523 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01003524 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003525
3526 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
3527 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
3528 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
3529 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3530 before any chroot is performed.
3531
3532 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
3533
3534 Example:
3535 http-errors website-1
3536 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
3537 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
3538 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3539
3540 http-errors website-2
3541 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
3542 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
3543 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3544
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020035453.9. Rings
3546----------
3547
3548It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
3549servers or traces.
3550
3551ring <ringname>
3552 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
3553
3554description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003555 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003556 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
3557
3558format <format>
3559 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
3560
3561 Arguments:
3562 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
3563 one of the following :
3564
3565 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
3566 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
3567 designed to be used with a local log server.
3568
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003569 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
3570 field is stripped. This is the default.
3571 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
3572 rfc3164.
3573
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003574 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
3575 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3576 used in containers or during development, where the severity
3577 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
3578 is the default.
3579
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003580 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003581 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
3582
3583 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
3584 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
3585
3586 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3587 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
3588 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
3589 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
3590 logger consumes.
3591
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02003592 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
3593 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
3594 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
3595 with a local log server.
3596
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003597 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3598 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
3599 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3600 used with a local log server.
3601
3602maxlen <length>
3603 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
3604 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
3605 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
3606
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003607server <name> <address> [param*]
3608 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
3609 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
3610 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
3611 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
3612 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
3613 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
3614 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
3615 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
3616 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003617 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
3618 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003619
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003620size <size>
3621 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
3622 set to BUFSIZE.
3623
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003624timeout connect <timeout>
3625 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3626
3627 Arguments :
3628 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3629 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3630 as explained at the top of this document.
3631
3632timeout server <timeout>
3633 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
3634
3635 Arguments :
3636 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3637 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3638 as explained at the top of this document.
3639
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003640 Example:
3641 global
3642 log ring@myring local7
3643
3644 ring myring
3645 description "My local buffer"
3646 format rfc3164
3647 maxlen 1200
3648 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003649 timeout connect 5s
3650 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003651 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003652
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020036533.10. Log forwarding
3654-------------------
3655
3656It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003657HAProxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003658
3659log-forward <name>
3660 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
3661
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003662backlog <conns>
3663 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3664 on connections accept.
3665
3666bind <addr> [param*]
3667 Used to configure a stream log listener to receive messages to forward.
Emeric Brunda46c1c2020-10-08 08:39:02 +02003668 This supports the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph including
3669 those about ssl but some statements such as "alpn" may be irrelevant for
3670 syslog protocol over TCP.
3671 Those listeners support both "Octet Counting" and "Non-Transparent-Framing"
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003672 modes as defined in rfc-6587.
3673
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02003674dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003675 Used to configure a datagram log listener to receive messages to forward.
3676 Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a port. This supports
3677 for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph among which
3678 "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02003679 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003680
3681log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003682log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003683 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3684 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
3685 documentation.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003686 If no format specified, HAProxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003687 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
3688 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
3689 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003690 exists in output format, HAProxy will use the local date.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003691
3692 Example:
3693 global
3694 log stderr format iso local7
3695
3696 ring myring
3697 description "My local buffer"
3698 format rfc5424
3699 maxlen 1200
3700 size 32764
3701 timeout connect 5s
3702 timeout server 10s
3703 # syslog tcp server
3704 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
3705
3706 log-forward sylog-loadb
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003707 dgram-bind 127.0.0.1:1514
3708 bind 127.0.0.1:1514
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003709 # all messages on stderr
3710 log global
3711 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
3712 log ring@myring local0
3713 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
3714 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
3715 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
3716 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
3717 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003718
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003719maxconn <conns>
3720 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a log forwarder.
3721 10 is the default.
3722
3723timeout client <timeout>
3724 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3725
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020037264. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003727----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003728
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003729Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003730 - defaults [<name>] [ from <defaults_name> ]
3731 - frontend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3732 - backend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3733 - listen <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003734
3735A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
3736connections.
3737
3738A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
3739to forward incoming connections.
3740
3741A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
3742parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
3743
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003744A "defaults" section resets all settings to the documented ones and presets new
3745ones for use by subsequent sections. All of "frontend", "backend" and "listen"
3746sections always take their initial settings from a defaults section, by default
3747the latest one that appears before the newly created section. It is possible to
3748explicitly designate a specific "defaults" section to load the initial settings
3749from by indicating its name on the section line after the optional keyword
3750"from". While "defaults" section do not impose a name, this use is encouraged
3751for better readability. It is also the only way to designate a specific section
3752to use instead of the default previous one. Since "defaults" section names are
3753optional, by default a very permissive check is applied on their name and these
3754are even permitted to overlap. However if a "defaults" section is referenced by
3755any other section, its name must comply with the syntax imposed on all proxy
3756names, and this name must be unique among the defaults sections. Please note
3757that regardless of what is currently permitted, it is recommended to avoid
3758duplicate section names in general and to respect the same syntax as for proxy
Christopher Fauletb4054202021-10-12 18:57:43 +02003759names. This rule might be enforced in a future version. In addition, a warning
3760is emitted if a defaults section is explicitly used by a proxy while it is also
3761implicitly used by another one because it is the last one defined. It is highly
3762encouraged to not mix both usages by always using explicit references or by
3763adding a last common defaults section reserved for all implicit uses.
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003764
3765Note that it is even possible for a defaults section to take its initial
3766settings from another one, and as such, inherit settings across multiple levels
3767of defaults sections. This can be convenient to establish certain configuration
3768profiles to carry groups of default settings (e.g. TCP vs HTTP or short vs long
3769timeouts) but can quickly become confusing to follow.
3770
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003771All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
3772'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
3773case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
3774
3775Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
3776logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
3777proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
3778However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
3779name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
3780
3781Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
3782and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003783bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003784protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
3785modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
3786arbitrary criteria.
3787
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003788In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
3789a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01003790the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003791
3792 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
3793 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
3794 between responses and new requests.
3795
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003796 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
3797 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
3798 client-facing connection remains open.
3799
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003800 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
3801 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003802
3803The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
3804frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
3805following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003806weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003807
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003808 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003809
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003810 | KAL | SCL | CLO
3811 ----+-----+-----+----
3812 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
3813 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003814 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
3815 ----+-----+-----+----
3816 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003817
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003818It is possible to chain a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. It is pointless if
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003819only HTTP traffic is handled. But it may be used to handle several protocols
3820within the same frontend. In this case, the client's connection is first handled
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003821as a raw tcp connection before being upgraded to HTTP. Before the upgrade, the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003822content processings are performend on raw data. Once upgraded, data is parsed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003823and stored using an internal representation called HTX and it is no longer
3824possible to rely on raw representation. There is no way to go back.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003825
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003826There are two kind of upgrades, in-place upgrades and destructive upgrades. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003827first ones involves a TCP to HTTP/1 upgrade. In HTTP/1, the request
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003828processings are serialized, thus the applicative stream can be preserved. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003829second one involves a TCP to HTTP/2 upgrade. Because it is a multiplexed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003830protocol, the applicative stream cannot be associated to any HTTP/2 stream and
3831is destroyed. New applicative streams are then created when HAProxy receives
3832new HTTP/2 streams at the lower level, in the H2 multiplexer. It is important
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003833to understand this difference because that drastically changes the way to
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003834process data. When an HTTP/1 upgrade is performed, the content processings
3835already performed on raw data are neither lost nor reexecuted while for an
3836HTTP/2 upgrade, applicative streams are distinct and all frontend rules are
3837evaluated systematically on each one. And as said, the first stream, the TCP
3838one, is destroyed, but only after the frontend rules were evaluated.
3839
3840There is another importnat point to understand when HTTP processings are
3841performed from a TCP proxy. While HAProxy is able to parse HTTP/1 in-fly from
3842tcp-request content rules, it is not possible for HTTP/2. Only the HTTP/2
3843preface can be parsed. This is a huge limitation regarding the HTTP content
3844analysis in TCP. Concretely it is only possible to know if received data are
3845HTTP. For instance, it is not possible to choose a backend based on the Host
3846header value while it is trivial in HTTP/1. Hopefully, there is a solution to
3847mitigate this drawback.
3848
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003849There are two ways to perform an HTTP upgrade. The first one, the historical
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003850method, is to select an HTTP backend. The upgrade happens when the backend is
3851set. Thus, for in-place upgrades, only the backend configuration is considered
3852in the HTTP data processing. For destructive upgrades, the applicative stream
3853is destroyed, thus its processing is stopped. With this method, possibilities
3854to choose a backend with an HTTP/2 connection are really limited, as mentioned
3855above, and a bit useless because the stream is destroyed. The second method is
3856to upgrade during the tcp-request content rules evaluation, thanks to the
3857"switch-mode http" action. In this case, the upgrade is performed in the
3858frontend context and it is possible to define HTTP directives in this
3859frontend. For in-place upgrades, it offers all the power of the HTTP analysis
3860as soon as possible. It is not that far from an HTTP frontend. For destructive
3861upgrades, it does not change anything except it is useless to choose a backend
3862on limited information. It is of course the recommended method. Thus, testing
3863the request protocol from the tcp-request content rules to perform an HTTP
3864upgrade is enough. All the remaining HTTP manipulation may be moved to the
3865frontend http-request ruleset. But keep in mind that tcp-request content rules
3866remains evaluated on each streams, that can't be changed.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003867
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020038684.1. Proxy keywords matrix
3869--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003870
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003871The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
3872limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
3873they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
3874limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003875marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003876option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02003877and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
3878with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02003879specified in a previous "defaults" section. Keywords supported in defaults
3880sections marked with "(!)" are only supported in named defaults sections, not
3881anonymous ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003882
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003883
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003884 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
3885------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02003886acl X (!) X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003887backlog X X X -
3888balance X - X X
3889bind - X X -
3890bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003891capture cookie - X X -
3892capture request header - X X -
3893capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003894clitcpka-cnt X X X -
3895clitcpka-idle X X X -
3896clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003897compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003898cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003899declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003900default-server X - X X
3901default_backend X X X -
3902description - X X X
3903disabled X X X X
3904dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003905email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003906email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003907email-alert mailers X X X X
3908email-alert myhostname X X X X
3909email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003910enabled X X X X
3911errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003912errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003913errorloc X X X X
3914errorloc302 X X X X
3915-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3916errorloc303 X X X X
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02003917error-log-format X X X -
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003918force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003919filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003920fullconn X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003921hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02003922http-after-response X (!) X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003923http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003924http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003925http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003926http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02003927http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02003928http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003929http-check set-var X - X X
3930http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02003931http-error X X X X
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02003932http-request X (!) X X X
3933http-response X (!) X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02003934http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02003935http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003936id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003937ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003938load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003939log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003940log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02003941log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01003942log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003943max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003944maxconn X X X -
3945mode X X X X
3946monitor fail - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003947monitor-uri X X X -
3948option abortonclose (*) X - X X
3949option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
3950option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
3951option allbackups (*) X - X X
3952option checkcache (*) X - X X
3953option clitcpka (*) X X X -
3954option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02003955option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003956option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
3957option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003958-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3959option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02003960option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
3961option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02003962option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02003963option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003964option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003965option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02003966option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Christopher Faulet18c13d32022-05-16 11:43:10 +02003967option http-restrict-req-hdr-names X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003968option http-server-close (*) X X X X
3969option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
3970option httpchk X - X X
3971option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01003972option httplog X X X -
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02003973option httpslog X X X -
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003974option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003975option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003976option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003977option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
3978option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
3979option logasap (*) X X X -
3980option mysql-check X - X X
3981option nolinger (*) X X X X
3982option originalto X X X X
3983option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02003984option pgsql-check X - X X
3985option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003986option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003987option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003988option smtpchk X - X X
3989option socket-stats (*) X X X -
3990option splice-auto (*) X X X X
3991option splice-request (*) X X X X
3992option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01003993option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003994option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
3995option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
3996-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01003997option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003998option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
3999option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
4000option tcpka X X X X
4001option tcplog X X X X
4002option transparent (*) X - X X
William Dauchya9dd9012022-01-05 22:53:24 +01004003option idle-close-on-response (*) X X X -
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09004004external-check command X - X X
4005external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004006persist rdp-cookie X - X X
4007rate-limit sessions X X X -
4008redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004009-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004010retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02004011retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004012server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004013server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02004014server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004015source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004016srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
4017srvtcpka-idle X - X X
4018srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02004019stats admin - X X X
4020stats auth X X X X
4021stats enable X X X X
4022stats hide-version X X X X
4023stats http-request - X X X
4024stats realm X X X X
4025stats refresh X X X X
4026stats scope X X X X
4027stats show-desc X X X X
4028stats show-legends X X X X
4029stats show-node X X X X
4030stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004031-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
4032stick match - - X X
4033stick on - - X X
4034stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02004035stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01004036stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004037tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02004038tcp-check connect X - X X
4039tcp-check expect X - X X
4040tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02004041tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02004042tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02004043tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02004044tcp-check set-var X - X X
4045tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004046tcp-request connection X (!) X X -
4047tcp-request content X (!) X X X
4048tcp-request inspect-delay X (!) X X X
4049tcp-request session X (!) X X -
4050tcp-response content X (!) - X X
4051tcp-response inspect-delay X (!) - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004052timeout check X - X X
4053timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02004054timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004055timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004056timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
4057timeout http-request X X X X
4058timeout queue X - X X
4059timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02004060timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004061timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02004062timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004063transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01004064unique-id-format X X X -
4065unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004066use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02004067use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02004068use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004069------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
4070 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004071
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004072
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020040734.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
4074---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004075
4076This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
4077
4078
4079acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
4080 Declare or complete an access list.
4081 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004082 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
4083
4084 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
4085 ones. ACLs defined in a defaults section are not visible from other sections
4086 using it.
4087
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004088 Example:
4089 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
4090 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
4091 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
4092
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004093 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004094
4095
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01004096backlog <conns>
4097 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
4098 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4099 yes | yes | yes | no
4100 Arguments :
4101 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
4102 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004103 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01004104
4105 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
4106 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
4107 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
4108 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
4109 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
4110 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
4111 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
4112 backlog parameter.
4113
4114 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
4115 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
4116 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
4117
4118 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
4119
4120
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004121balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02004122balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004123 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
4124 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4125 yes | no | yes | yes
4126 Arguments :
4127 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
4128 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
4129 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
4130 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
4131
4132 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
4133 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
4134 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
4135 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02004136 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08004137 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02004138 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
4139 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
4140 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
4141 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
4142 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
4143 it, so that you don't worry.
4144
4145 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
4146 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
4147 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
4148 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
4149 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
4150 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
4151 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
4152 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004153
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01004154 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
4155 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
4156 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
4157 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
4158 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
4159 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
4160 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
Willy Tarreau8c855f62020-10-22 17:41:45 +02004161 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance. It will
4162 also consider the number of queued connections in addition to
4163 the established ones in order to minimize queuing.
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01004164
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01004165 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004166 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01004167 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
4168 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02004169 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01004170 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
4171 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
4172 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
4173 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
4174 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02004175 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
4176 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
4177 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
4178 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
4179 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
4180 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01004181
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004182 hash Takes a regular sample expression in argument. The expression
4183 is evaluated for each request and hashed according to the
4184 configured hash-type. The result of the hash is divided by
4185 the total weight of the running servers to designate which
4186 server will receive the request. This can be used in place of
4187 "source", "uri", "hdr()", "url_param()", "rdp-cookie" to make
4188 use of a converter, refine the evaluation, or be used to
4189 extract data from local variables for example. When the data
4190 is not available, round robin will apply. This algorithm is
4191 static by default, which means that changing a server's
4192 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
4193 changed using "hash-type".
4194
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004195 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
4196 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
4197 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
4198 address will always reach the same server as long as no
4199 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
4200 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
4201 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
4202 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004203 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004204 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004205 static by default, which means that changing a server's
4206 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004207 changed using "hash-type". See also the "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004208
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01004209 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
4210 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
4211 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
4212 the running servers. The result designates which server will
4213 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
4214 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
4215 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
4216 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
4217 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
4218 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
4219 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
4220 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004221
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01004222 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02004223 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
4224 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
4225 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
4226 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
4227 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
4228 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
4229 URIs start with a leading "/".
4230
4231 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
4232 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
4233 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
4234 evaluation stops when either is reached.
4235
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02004236 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
4237 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
4238 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004239 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash. See also the
4240 "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02004241
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004242 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004243 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
4244
4245 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004246 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
4247 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02004248 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
4249 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
4250 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
4251 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004252 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02004253 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
4254 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004255
4256 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
4257 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
4258 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
4259 server will receive the request.
4260
4261 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
4262 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
4263 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
4264 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
4265 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004266 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
4267 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004268 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type". See also
4269 the "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004270
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004271 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
4272 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
4273 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
4274 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
4275 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01004276
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004277 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01004278 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
4279 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
4280 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
4281
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004282 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
4283 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004284 but this can be changed using "hash-type". See also the
4285 "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004286
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01004287 random
4288 random(<draws>)
4289 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004290 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
4291 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
4292 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
4293 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01004294 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
4295 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
4296 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
4297 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
4298 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
4299 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
4300 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
4301 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
4302 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
4303 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
4304 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
4305 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
4306 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
4307 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
4308 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
4309 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
4310 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
4311 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
4312 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
4313 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004314
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004315 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02004316 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004317 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
4318 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +01004319 with the equivalent ACL 'req.rdp_cookie()' function, the name
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004320 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
4321 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
4322 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004323 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004324 used instead.
4325
4326 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
4327 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
4328 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +01004329 a 'req.rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004330
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004331 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
4332 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004333 but this can be changed using "hash-type". See also the
4334 "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004335
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004336 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02004337 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
4338 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004339
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01004340 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
4341 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
4342 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004343
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02004344 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05004345 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02004346 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
4347 NTLM relies on.
4348
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004349 Examples :
4350 balance roundrobin
4351 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004352 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01004353 balance hdr(User-Agent)
4354 balance hdr(host)
4355 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004356 balance hash req.cookie(clientid)
4357 balance hash var(req.client_id)
4358 balance hash req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1),ipmask(24)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004359
4360 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
4361 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
4362
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004363 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004364 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
4365 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
4366 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02004367 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004368
4369 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
4370 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
4371 defaults to 16 kB.
4372
4373 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
4374 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
4375
4376 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
4377 Round Robin.
4378
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00004379 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004380 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
4381 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
4382 actually appeared in the first chunk).
4383
4384 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
4385
4386 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004387 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004388 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
4389 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
4390 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004391
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +02004392 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004393
4394
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004395bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
4396bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004397 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
4398 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4399 no | yes | yes | no
4400 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004401 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
4402 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
4403 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
4404 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01004405 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004406 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
4407 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
4408 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
4409 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
4410 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
4411 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004412 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004413 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
4414 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004415 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004416 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4417 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004418 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004419 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4420 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004421 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02004422 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01004423 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
4424 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
4425 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02004426 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
4427 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
4428 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
4429 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004430 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4431 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
4432 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004433
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004434 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
4435 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004436 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
4437 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
4438 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004439 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
4440 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
4441 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
4442 the range.
4443
4444 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
4445 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
4446 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
4447 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
4448 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
4449 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
4450 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004451 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004452 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004453
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004454 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004455 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004456 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
4457 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
4458 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
4459 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
4460 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
4461 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
4462
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004463 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
4464 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
4465 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
4466 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004467
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004468 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
4469 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
4470 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
4471 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
4472 in a frontend.
4473
4474 Example :
4475 listen http_proxy
4476 bind :80,:443
4477 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004478 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004479
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004480 listen http_https_proxy
4481 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02004482 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004483
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004484 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
4485 bind ipv6@:80
4486 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
4487 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
4488
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004489 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004490 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004491
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02004492 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
4493 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
4494 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
4495 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
4496 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
4497
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004498 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004499 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004500
4501
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004502bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004503 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4504 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004505
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02004506 Deprecated. Before threads were supported, this was used to force some
4507 frontends on certain processes only, or to adjust backends so that they
4508 could match the frontends that used them. The default and only accepted
4509 value is "1" (along with "all" and "odd" which alias it). Do not use this
4510 setting. Threads can still be bound per-socket using the "process" bind
4511 keyword.
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01004512
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02004513 See also : "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004514
4515
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004516capture cookie <name> len <length>
4517 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
4518 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4519 no | yes | yes | no
4520 Arguments :
4521 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
4522 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
4523 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
4524 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004525 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004526
4527 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
4528 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
4529 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
4530 right if it exceeds <length>.
4531
4532 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
4533 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
4534 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
4535 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
4536
4537 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
4538 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
4539 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
4540
4541 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
4542 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
4543 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01004544 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
4545 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
4546 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004547
4548 Example:
4549 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
4550
4551 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004552 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004553
4554
4555capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004556 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004557 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4558 no | yes | yes | no
4559 Arguments :
4560 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004561 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004562 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
4563 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4564 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4565
4566 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4567 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4568 it exceeds <length>.
4569
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004570 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004571 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
4572 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004573 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
4574 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
4575 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
4576 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004577 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004578 environments to find where the request came from.
4579
4580 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
4581 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
4582 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
4583 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004584
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004585 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
4586 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4587 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4588 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4589 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004590
4591 Example:
4592 capture request header Host len 15
4593 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01004594 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004595
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004596 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004597 about logging.
4598
4599
4600capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004601 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004602 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4603 no | yes | yes | no
4604 Arguments :
4605 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004606 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004607 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
4608 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4609 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4610
4611 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4612 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4613 it exceeds <length>.
4614
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004615 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004616 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
4617 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
4618 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004619 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
4620 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
4621 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
4622 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004623
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004624 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
4625 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4626 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4627 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4628 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004629
4630 Example:
4631 capture response header Content-length len 9
4632 capture response header Location len 15
4633
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004634 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004635 about logging.
4636
4637
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004638clitcpka-cnt <count>
4639 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
4640 the connection on the client side.
4641 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4642 yes | yes | yes | no
4643 Arguments :
4644 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
4645
4646 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
4647 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004648 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4649 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004650
4651 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
4652
4653
4654clitcpka-idle <timeout>
4655 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
4656 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
4657 client side.
4658 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4659 yes | yes | yes | no
4660 Arguments :
4661 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
4662 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
4663 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
4664 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
4665
4666 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
4667 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004668 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4669 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004670
4671 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
4672
4673
4674clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
4675 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
4676 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4677 yes | yes | yes | no
4678 Arguments :
4679 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
4680 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
4681 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
4682 document.
4683
4684 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
4685 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004686 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4687 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004688
4689 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
4690
4691
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004692compression algo <algorithm> ...
4693compression type <mime type> ...
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004694 Enable HTTP compression.
4695 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4696 yes | yes | yes | yes
4697 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004698 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
4699 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004700
4701 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004702 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
4703 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
4704 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004705
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004706 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004707 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004708
4709 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
4710 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
4711 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
4712 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
4713 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004714 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004715
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004716 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
4717 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
4718 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
4719 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
4720 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
4721 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
4722 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004723 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004724
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04004725 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004726 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004727 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004728 will be no-op: HAProxy will see the compressed response and will not
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004729 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004730 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, HAProxy will compress the
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004731 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004732
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004733 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004734 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
4735 "Accept-Encoding" header
Julien Pivottoff80c822021-03-29 12:41:40 +02004736 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1 or above
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004737 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004738 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
4739 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
4740 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
4741 "multipart"
4742 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
4743 header
4744 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
4745 and later
4746 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
4747 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004748 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004749
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01004750 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004751
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004752 Examples :
4753 compression algo gzip
4754 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004755
Christopher Faulet44d34bf2021-11-05 12:06:14 +01004756 See also : "compression offload"
4757
4758compression offload
4759 Makes HAProxy work as a compression offloader only.
4760 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4761 no | yes | yes | yes
4762
4763 The "offload" setting makes HAProxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
4764 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
4765 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
4766 will be done on the single point where HAProxy is located. However in some
4767 deployment scenarios, HAProxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
4768 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
4769 In that case HAProxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
4770 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
4771 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
4772 so that prevents HAProxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
4773 then be used for such scenarios.
4774
4775 If this setting is used in a defaults section, a warning is emitted and the
4776 option is ignored.
4777
4778 See also : "compression type", "compression algo"
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004779
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004780cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004781 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
4782 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004783 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004784 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
4785 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4786 yes | no | yes | yes
4787 Arguments :
4788 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
4789 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
4790 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
4791 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
4792 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
4793 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004794 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004795 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
4796 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
4797
4798 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004799 server and that HAProxy will have to modify its value to set the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004800 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
4801 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
4802 headers is left to the application. The application can then
4803 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004804 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
4805 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004806 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004807 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
4808 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004809
4810 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004811 be inserted by HAProxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004812
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004813 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004814 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02004815 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004816 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004817 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
4818 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
4819 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
4820 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
4821 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
4822 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
4823 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004824
4825 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
4826 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
4827 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
4828 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
4829 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
4830 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
4831 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
4832 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
4833 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004834 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004835 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
4836 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
4837 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004838
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004839 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
4840 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
4841 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004842 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
4843 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
4844 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
4845 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004846 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
4847 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
4848 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004849
4850 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
4851 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
4852 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
4853 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
4854 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
4855 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
4856 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
4857 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
4858 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
4859
4860 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
4861 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
4862 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
4863 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
4864 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
4865 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
4866 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
4867 persistence cookie in the cache.
4868 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
4869
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004870 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
4871 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004872 case, if a cookie is found in the response, HAProxy will leave it
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004873 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
4874 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004875 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004876 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
4877 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
4878 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
4879 they logout.
4880
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004881 httponly This option tells HAProxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004882 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
4883 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
4884 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
4885
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004886 secure This option tells HAProxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004887 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
4888 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
4889 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
4890 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
4891 this attribute.
4892
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004893 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004894 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01004895 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
4896 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
4897 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
4898 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
4899 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
4900 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004901
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004902 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
4903 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
4904 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
4905 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
4906 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
4907 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
4908 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
4909 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004910 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004911 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
4912 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
4913 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
4914 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
4915 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
4916 the site.
4917
4918 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
4919 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
4920 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
4921 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
4922 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
4923 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
4924 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
4925 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
4926 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
4927 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
4928 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
4929 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
4930 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004931 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004932 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
4933 redispatch after some absolute delay.
4934
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004935 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
4936 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
4937 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
4938 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
4939 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
4940 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
4941
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004942 attr This option tells HAProxy to add an extra attribute when a
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004943 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
4944 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
4945 repeated.
4946
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004947 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
4948 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
4949 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
4950 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004951
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004952 Examples :
4953 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
4954 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
4955 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004956 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004957
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004958 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004959
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004960
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004961declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
4962 Declares a capture slot.
4963 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4964 no | yes | yes | no
4965 Arguments:
4966 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
4967
4968 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
4969 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
4970 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
4971 for use in the response.
4972
4973 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02004974 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004975 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
4976
4977
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004978default-server [param*]
4979 Change default options for a server in a backend
4980 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4981 yes | no | yes | yes
4982 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004983 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
4984 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
4985 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
4986 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004987
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004988 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004989 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
4990
4991 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004992
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004993
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004994default_backend <backend>
4995 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
4996 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4997 yes | yes | yes | no
4998 Arguments :
4999 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
5000
5001 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
5002 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
5003 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
5004 will catch all undetermined requests.
5005
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005006 Example :
5007
5008 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
5009 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
5010 default_backend dynamic
5011
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02005012 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005013
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005014
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02005015description <string>
5016 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
5017 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5018 no | yes | yes | yes
5019 Arguments : string
5020
5021 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
5022 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
5023 it describes.
5024 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
5025
5026
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005027disabled
5028 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
5029 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5030 yes | yes | yes | yes
5031 Arguments : none
5032
5033 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
5034 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
5035 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
5036 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
5037 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
5038 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
5039 keyword in a "defaults" section.
5040
5041 See also : "enabled"
5042
5043
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02005044dispatch <address>:<port>
5045 Set a default server address
5046 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5047 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005048 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02005049
5050 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
5051 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
5052 during start-up.
5053
5054 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
5055 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
5056 possible with normal servers.
5057
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02005058 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02005059 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
5060 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
5061 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
5062 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
5063
5064 See also : "server"
5065
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01005066
5067dynamic-cookie-key <string>
5068 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
5069 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5070 yes | no | yes | yes
5071 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
5072
5073 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005074 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01005075 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
5076 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005077 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01005078 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02005079
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005080enabled
5081 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
5082 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5083 yes | yes | yes | yes
5084 Arguments : none
5085
5086 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
5087 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
5088
5089 See also : "disabled"
5090
5091
5092errorfile <code> <file>
5093 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
5094 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5095 yes | yes | yes | yes
5096 Arguments :
5097 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005098 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005099 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005100
5101 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005102 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005103 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01005104 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
5105 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005106
5107 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
5108 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
5109 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
5110
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005111 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
5112
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02005113 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
5114 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
5115 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
5116 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
5117 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
5118 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
5119 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
5120 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
5121 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01005122
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005123 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5124 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5125 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005126 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005127 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
5128
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005129 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005130
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01005131 Example :
5132 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01005133 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01005134 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
5135 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
5136
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005137
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01005138errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
5139 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
5140 section.
5141 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5142 yes | yes | yes | yes
5143 Arguments :
5144 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
5145
5146 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005147 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005148 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503,
5149 and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01005150
5151 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
5152 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
5153 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
5154 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
5155 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005156 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01005157 hand using "errorfile" directives.
5158
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005159 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
5160 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01005161
5162 Example :
5163 errorfiles generic
5164 errorfiles site-1 403 404
5165
5166
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005167errorloc <code> <url>
5168errorloc302 <code> <url>
5169 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
5170 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5171 yes | yes | yes | yes
5172 Arguments :
5173 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005174 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005175 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005176
5177 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
5178 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
5179 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
5180 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005181 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005182
5183 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
5184 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
5185 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
5186
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005187 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
5188
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005189 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
5190 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
5191 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
5192 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01005193 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005194 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
5195 request.
5196
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005197 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005198
5199
5200errorloc303 <code> <url>
5201 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
5202 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5203 yes | yes | yes | yes
5204 Arguments :
5205 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005206 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005207 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005208
5209 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
5210 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
5211 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
5212 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005213 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005214
5215 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
5216 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
5217 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
5218
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005219 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
5220
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005221 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
5222 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
5223 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
5224 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005225 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005226
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005227 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005228
5229
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005230email-alert from <emailaddr>
5231 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005232 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005233 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5234 yes | yes | yes | yes
5235
5236 Arguments :
5237
5238 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
5239
5240 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
5241 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5242
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005243 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02005244 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
5245 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005246
5247
5248email-alert level <level>
5249 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
5250 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
5251 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5252 yes | yes | yes | yes
5253
5254 Arguments :
5255
5256 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
5257 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5258 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
5259
5260 By default level is alert
5261
5262 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
5263 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
5264 for the proxy.
5265
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09005266 Alerts are sent when :
5267
5268 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
5269 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
5270 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
5271 is notice or lower
5272 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
5273 and a health check status update occurs
5274
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005275 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
5276 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005277 section 3.6 about mailers.
5278
5279
5280email-alert mailers <mailersect>
5281 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
5282 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5283 yes | yes | yes | yes
5284
5285 Arguments :
5286
5287 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
5288
5289 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
5290 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5291
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005292 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
5293 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005294
5295
5296email-alert myhostname <hostname>
5297 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
5298 mailers.
5299 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5300 yes | yes | yes | yes
5301
5302 Arguments :
5303
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01005304 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005305
5306 By default the systems hostname is used.
5307
5308 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
5309 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
5310 for the proxy.
5311
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005312 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
5313 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005314
5315
5316email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005317 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005318 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
5319 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5320 yes | yes | yes | yes
5321
5322 Arguments :
5323
5324 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
5325
5326 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
5327 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5328
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005329 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005330 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
5331
5332
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02005333error-log-format <string>
5334 Specifies the log format string to use in case of connection error on the frontend side.
5335 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5336 yes | yes | yes | no
5337
5338 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for logs
5339 containing information related to errors, timeouts, retries redispatches or
5340 HTTP status code 5xx. This format will in short be used for every log line
5341 that would be concerned by the "log-separate-errors" option, including
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +01005342 connection errors described in section 8.2.5.
5343
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02005344 If the directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will
5345 use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
5346 string in depth.
5347
5348 "error-log-format" directive overrides previous "error-log-format"
5349 directives.
5350
5351
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005352force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5353 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
5354 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005355 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005356
5357 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
5358 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
5359 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
5360 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
5361 marked down for maintenance operations.
5362
5363 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5364 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
5365 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
5366 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
5367 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
5368 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
5369 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
5370 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
5371 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
5372
5373 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5374 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
5375 is used.
5376
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005377 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02005378 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005379
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005380
5381filter <name> [param*]
5382 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
5383 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5384 no | yes | yes | yes
5385 Arguments :
5386 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
5387 referenced in section 9.
5388
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005389 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005390 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005391 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
5392 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005393
5394 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
5395 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
5396
5397 Example:
5398 listen
5399 bind *:80
5400
5401 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
5402 filter compression
5403 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
5404
5405 compression algo gzip
5406 compression offload
5407
5408 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5409
5410 See also : section 9.
5411
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005412
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005413fullconn <conns>
5414 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
5415 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5416 yes | no | yes | yes
5417 Arguments :
5418 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
5419 servers use the maximal number of connections.
5420
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005421 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005422 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005423 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005424 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
5425 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
5426 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
5427 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
5428 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005429 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005430
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005431 Since it's hard to get this value right, HAProxy automatically sets it to
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005432 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01005433 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
5434 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
5435 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005436
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005437 Example :
5438 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
5439 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
5440 # connections.
5441 backend dynamic
5442 fullconn 10000
5443 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5444 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5445
5446 See also : "maxconn", "server"
5447
5448
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005449hash-balance-factor <factor>
5450 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
5451 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5452 yes | no | no | yes
5453 Arguments :
5454 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
5455 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01005456 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005457
5458 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
5459 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
5460 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
5461 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
5462 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
5463 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
5464 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
5465
5466 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
5467 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
5468 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
5469 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
5470 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
5471
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02005472 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
5473 consistent hashing mechanism.
5474
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005475 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
5476
5477
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005478hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005479 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
5480 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5481 yes | no | yes | yes
5482 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005483 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
5484 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005485
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005486 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
5487 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
5488 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
5489 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
5490 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
5491 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
5492 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
5493 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
5494 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
5495 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01005496
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005497 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
5498 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
5499 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
5500 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
5501 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
5502 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
5503 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
5504 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
5505 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
5506 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
5507 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
5508 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
5509 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005510 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
5511 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005512
5513 <function> is the hash function to be used :
5514
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005515 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005516 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
5517 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
5518 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005519 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
5520 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
5521 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005522
5523 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
5524 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005525 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
5526 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
5527 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
5528 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
5529
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005530 wt6 this function was designed for HAProxy while testing other
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01005531 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
5532 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
5533 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
5534 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
5535 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
5536 parameter.
5537
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01005538 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
5539 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
5540 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
5541 used on strings.
5542
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005543 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
5544
5545 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
5546 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
5547 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
5548 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
5549 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
5550 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
5551 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
5552 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
5553 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
5554 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
5555 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
5556 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005557
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005558 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
5559 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
5560 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005561
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005562 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005563
5564
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005565http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5566 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
5567 ones).
5568
5569 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02005570 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005571
5572 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
5573 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
5574 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5575 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5576 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5577 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5578
5579 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
5580 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
5581 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
5582
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005583 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
5584 supported:
5585 - add-header <name> <fmt>
5586 - allow
Christopher Fauletba8f0632021-12-06 08:43:22 +01005587 - capture <sample> id <id>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005588 - del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ]
5589 - replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5590 - replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5591 - set-header <name> <fmt>
5592 - set-status <status> [reason <str>]
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01005593 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
5594 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005595 - strict-mode { on | off }
5596 - unset-var(<var-name>)
5597
5598 The supported actions are described below.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005599
5600 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
5601 instance.
5602
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02005603 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
5604 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
5605 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
5606 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
5607 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
5608 a defaults section defining such rules.
5609
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005610 Note: Errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are handled by the
5611 multiplexer at a lower level, before any http analysis. Thus no
5612 http-after-response ruleset is evaluated on these errors.
5613
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005614 Example:
5615 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
5616 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
5617 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
5618
5619http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5620
5621 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005622 value is defined by <fmt>. Please refer to "http-request add-header" for a
5623 complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005624
Christopher Fauletba8f0632021-12-06 08:43:22 +01005625http-after-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5626
5627 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
5628 converts it to a string. Please refer to "http-response capture" for a
5629 complete description.
5630
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005631http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5632
5633 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
Christopher Faulet27025602021-11-09 17:58:12 +01005634 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005635
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005636http-after-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005637
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005638 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. Please
5639 refer to "http-request del-header" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005640
5641http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5642 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5643
5644 This works like "http-response replace-header".
5645
5646 Example:
5647 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
5648
5649 # applied to:
5650 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5651
5652 # outputs:
5653 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5654
5655 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
5656
5657http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5658 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5659
5660 This works like "http-response replace-value".
5661
5662 Example:
5663 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
5664
5665 # applied to:
5666 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
5667
5668 # outputs:
5669 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
5670
5671http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5672
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005673 This does the same as "http-after-response add-header" except that the header
5674 name is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
5675 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
5676 external users.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005677
5678http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5679 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5680
5681 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
Ilya Shipitsina4d09e72021-11-20 23:11:12 +05005682 between 100 and 999. Please refer to "http-response set-status" for a complete
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005683 description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005684
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01005685http-after-response set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5686http-after-response set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02005687
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005688 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5689 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
5690 for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005691
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005692http-after-response strict-mode { on | off } [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005693
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005694 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following
5695 rules. Please refer to "http-request strict-mode" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005696
5697http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5698
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005699 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-request set-var" for details
5700 about <var-name>.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005701
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005702
5703http-check comment <string>
5704 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
5705 it fails.
5706 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5707 yes | no | yes | yes
5708
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005709 Arguments :
5710 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
5711 rule fails.
5712
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005713 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
5714 user-friendly error reporting.
5715
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005716 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005717 "http-check expect".
5718
5719
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005720http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
5721 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005722 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005723 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
5724 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5725 yes | no | yes | yes
5726
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005727 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005728 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5729
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005730 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005731 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005732
5733 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
5734 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
5735 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
5736 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
5737
5738 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
5739
5740 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
5741
5742 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
5743
5744 ssl opens a ciphered connection
5745
5746 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
5747
5748 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
5749 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
5750 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
5751 is used.
5752
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005753 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
5754 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
5755 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
5756 haproxy -vv.
5757
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005758 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
5759
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005760 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
5761 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
5762 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
5763 different ports or with different servers.
5764
5765 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
5766 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
5767 the port with a "http-check connect".
5768
5769 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
5770 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
5771 do.
5772
5773 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
5774 unset-var or comment rules.
5775
5776 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005777 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
5778 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
5779 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
5780 option httpchk
5781
5782 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005783 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005784 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005785 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005786 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005787 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005788
5789 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
5790
5791 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005792
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005793
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005794http-check disable-on-404
5795 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
5796 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005797 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005798 Arguments : none
5799
5800 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
5801 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
5802 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
5803 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
5804 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
5805 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
5806 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
5807 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005808 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
5809 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
Christopher Fauletfa8b89a2020-11-20 18:54:13 +01005810 responses will still be considered as soft-stop. Note also that a stopped
5811 server will stay stopped even if it replies 404s. This option is only
5812 evaluated for running servers.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005813
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005814 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005815
5816
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005817http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005818 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
5819 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
5820 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005821 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005822 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02005823 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005824
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005825 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005826 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5827
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005828 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
5829 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
5830 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
5831 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
5832 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
5833 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
5834 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
5835 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
5836 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
5837 result is always conclusive.
5838
5839 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5840 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
5841 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005842 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
5843 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005844 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5845 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005846 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
5847 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
5848 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005849
5850 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5851 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005852 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
5853 supported :
5854 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5855 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005856 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
5857 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
5858 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
5859 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
5860 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005861
5862 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5863 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005864 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
5865 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
5866 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
5867 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005868 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
5869
5870 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5871 informational message reported in logs if the expect
5872 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
5873 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
5874
5875 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5876 informational message reported in logs if an error
5877 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
5878 log-format string.
5879
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005880 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005881 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
5882 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005883 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
5884 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
5885 details on the supported keywords.
5886
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005887 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
5888 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
5889 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
5890 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005891
5892 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
5893 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
5894 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
5895 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
5896 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
5897
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005898 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
5899 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
5900 codes. A health check response will be considered as
5901 valid if the response's status code matches any status
5902 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
5903 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5904 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005905
5906 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005907 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005908 response's status code matches the expression. If the
5909 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5910 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
5911 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
5912
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005913 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5914 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005915 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
5916 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
5917 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
5918 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
5919 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
5920 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
5921 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
5922 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005923 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
5924 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
5925 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
5926 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
5927 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
5928 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
5929 insensitive on the header names.
5930
5931 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5932 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
5933 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
5934 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
5935 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
5936 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005937
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005938 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005939 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005940 response's body contains this exact string. If the
5941 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5942 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
5943 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
5944 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005945 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005946 trace).
5947
5948 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005949 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005950 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
5951 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5952 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
5953 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
5954 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005955 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005956
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02005957 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
5958 A health check response will be considered valid if the
5959 response's body contains the string resulting of the
5960 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
5961 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5962 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
5963
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005964 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01005965 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005966 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
5967 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
5968 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
5969 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
5970 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
5971 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
5972
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005973 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
5974 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
5975 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
5976 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
5977 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01005978
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005979 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
5980 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
5981
5982 Examples :
5983 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005984 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005985
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005986 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
5987 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
5988
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005989 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005990 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005991
5992 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005993 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005994
5995 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005996 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005997
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005998 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005999 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006000
6001
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02006002http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02006003 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
6004 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006005 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
6006 health checks.
6007 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6008 yes | no | yes | yes
6009 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006010 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
6011
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006012 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
6013 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
6014 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
6015 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
6016 to invent non-standard ones.
6017
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02006018 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
6019 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
6020 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
6021 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
6022
6023 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
6024 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
6025 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
6026 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006027
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02006028 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006029 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006030 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006031 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
6032 to add it.
6033
6034 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
6035 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
6036 to the log-format rules.
6037
6038 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
6039 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
6040 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006041
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02006042 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
6043 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
6044 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
6045 request.
6046
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006047 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
6048 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
6049 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02006050 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
6051 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
6052 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
6053 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01006054 deprecated.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006055
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006056 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01006057 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, unless a Connection
6058 header has already already been configured via a hdr entry.
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02006059
6060 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
6061 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
6062 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
6063 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
6064 configured request authority.
6065
6066 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
6067 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006068
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006069 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006070
6071
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006072http-check send-state
6073 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
6074 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6075 yes | no | yes | yes
6076 Arguments : none
6077
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006078 When this option is set, HAProxy will systematically send a special header
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006079 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006080 how they are seen by HAProxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
6081 manipulated without access to HAProxy and the operator needs to know whether
6082 HAProxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006083
6084 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
6085 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
6086 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
6087 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
6088 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08006089 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
6090 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
6091 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
6092
6093 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
6094 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
6095 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
6096
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006097 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
6098 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
6099 checked in multiple backends.
6100
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006101 - a variable "node" containing the name of the HAProxy node, as set in the
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006102 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
6103
6104 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
6105 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
6106 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
6107 one fails.
6108
6109 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
6110 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
6111 connections on all servers of the same backend.
6112
6113 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
6114 server's queue.
6115
6116 Example of a header received by the application server :
6117 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
6118 scur=13/22; qcur=0
6119
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006120 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
6121 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006122
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006123
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01006124http-check set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
6125http-check set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006126 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006127 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6128 yes | no | yes | yes
6129
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006130 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006131 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6132 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
6133 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
6134 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
6135 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
6136 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6137 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
6138 and '-'.
6139
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01006140 <cond> A set of conditions that must all be true for the variable to
6141 actually be set (such as "ifnotempty", "ifgt" ...). See the
Ilya Shipitsin5e87bcf2021-12-25 11:45:52 +05006142 set-var converter's description for a full list of possible
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01006143 conditions.
6144
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006145 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
6146
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02006147 <fmt> This is the value expressed using log-format rules (see Custom
6148 Log Format in section 8.2.4).
6149
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006150 Examples :
6151 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02006152 http-check set-var-fmt(check.port) "name=%H"
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006153
6154
6155http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006156 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006157 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6158 yes | no | yes | yes
6159
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006160 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006161 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6162 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
6163 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
6164 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
6165 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
6166 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6167 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
6168 and '-'.
6169
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006170 Examples :
6171 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006172
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006173
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02006174http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
6175 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6176 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6177 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6178 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
6179 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6180 yes | yes | yes | yes
6181 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006182 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02006183 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006184 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006185 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02006186
6187 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
6188 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
6189 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
6190 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
6191
6192 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
6193 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
6194 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
6195 a frontend, the default error message is used.
6196
6197 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
6198 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
6199 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
6200 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
6201 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
6202 chroot is performed.
6203
6204 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
6205 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
6206 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
6207 considered.
6208
6209 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
6210 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
6211 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
6212 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
6213 considered as a raw string.
6214
6215 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
6216 The content-type must always be set as argument to
6217 "content-type".
6218
6219 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
6220 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
6221 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
6222 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
6223 evaluated as a log-format string.
6224
6225 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
6226 payload. The content-type must always be set as
6227 argument to "content-type".
6228
6229 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
6230 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
6231 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
6232 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
6233
6234 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
6235 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
6236 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
6237 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
6238 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
6239 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
6240 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
6241 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
6242
6243 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
6244 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
6245 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
6246
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01006247 Note: 400/408/500 errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are
6248 handled by the multiplexer at a lower level. No custom formatting is
6249 supported at this level. Thus only static error messages, defined with
6250 "errorfile" directive, are supported. However, this limitation only
6251 exists during the request headers parsing or between two transactions.
6252
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02006253 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
6254 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
6255
6256
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006257http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006258 Access control for Layer 7 requests
6259
6260 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02006261 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006262
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006263 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
6264 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
6265 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
6266 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
6267 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006268
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006269 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
6270 supported:
6271 - add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
6272 - add-header <name> <fmt>
6273 - allow
6274 - auth [realm <realm>]
6275 - cache-use <name>
6276 - capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
6277 - del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
6278 - del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ]
6279 - del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt>
6280 - deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] ...
6281 - disable-l7-retry
6282 - do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
6283 - early-hint <name> <fmt>
6284 - normalize-uri <normalizer>
6285 - redirect <rule>
6286 - reject
6287 - replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6288 - replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6289 - replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6290 - replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6291 - replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6292 - return [status <code>] [content-type <type>] ...
6293 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
6294 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
6295 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
6296 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6297 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6298 - set-dst <expr>
6299 - set-dst-port <expr>
6300 - set-header <name> <fmt>
6301 - set-log-level <level>
6302 - set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6303 - set-mark <mark>
6304 - set-method <fmt>
6305 - set-nice <nice>
6306 - set-path <fmt>
6307 - set-pathq <fmt>
6308 - set-priority-class <expr>
6309 - set-priority-offset <expr>
6310 - set-query <fmt>
6311 - set-src <expr>
6312 - set-src-port <expr>
6313 - set-timeout { server | tunnel } { <timeout> | <expr> }
6314 - set-tos <tos>
6315 - set-uri <fmt>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01006316 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
6317 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006318 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
6319 - silent-drop
6320 - strict-mode { on | off }
6321 - tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] ...
6322 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
6323 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
6324 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
6325 - unset-var(<var-name>)
6326 - use-service <service-name>
6327 - wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
6328 - wait-for-handshake
6329 - cache-use <name>
6330
6331 The supported actions are described below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006332
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006333 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006334
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02006335 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
6336 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
6337 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
6338 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
6339 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
6340 a defaults section defining such rules.
6341
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006342 Example:
6343 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
6344 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
6345 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006346
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006347 http-request allow if nagios
6348 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
6349 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
6350 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01006351
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006352 Example:
6353 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
6354 acl add path /addacl
6355 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006356
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006357 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006358
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006359 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
6360 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02006361
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006362 Example:
6363 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
6364 acl setmap path /setmap
6365 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006366
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006367 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006368
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006369 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
6370 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006371
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006372 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
6373 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006374
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006375http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006376
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006377 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6378 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6379 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6380 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
6381 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
6382 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6383 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6384 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006385
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006386http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006387
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006388 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
6389 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
6390 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
6391 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
6392 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
6393 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
6394 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
6395 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006396
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006397http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006398
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006399 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
Christopher Faulet27025602021-11-09 17:58:12 +01006400 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006401
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006402http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006403
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006404 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
6405 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
6406 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
6407 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
6408 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006409
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02006410 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
6411 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
6412 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
6413 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
6414 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
6415 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
6416 instead.
6417
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006418 Example:
6419 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
6420 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006421
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02006422http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006423
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006424 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006425
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006426http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
6427 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006428
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006429 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
6430 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
6431 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
6432 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
6433 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
6434 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
6435 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
6436 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
6437 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006438
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006439 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
6440 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
6441 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01006442 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
6443
6444 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
6445 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
6446 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
6447 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006448
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006449http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006450
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006451 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6452 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6453 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6454 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6455 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6456 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006457
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006458http-request del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02006459
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006460 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
6461 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
6462 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
6463 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
6464 method is used.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02006465
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006466http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006467
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006468 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6469 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6470 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6471 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6472 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6473 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006474
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006475http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6476http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6477 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6478 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6479 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6480 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006481
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006482 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
6483 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6484 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006485 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006486 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6487 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6488 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006489 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006490 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006491
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02006492http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6493 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
6494 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
6495 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
6496
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006497http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
6498 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006499
6500 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
6501 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
6502 pointed by <resolvers>.
6503 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
6504 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
6505 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
6506 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
6507 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
6508 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
6509 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
6510 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
6511 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
6512 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
6513 to 0.0.0.0.
6514
6515 Example:
6516 resolvers mydns
6517 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
6518 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
6519 timeout retry 1s
6520 hold valid 10s
6521 hold nx 3s
6522 hold other 3s
6523 hold obsolete 0s
6524 accepted_payload_size 8192
6525
6526 frontend fe
6527 bind 10.42.0.1:80
6528 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
6529 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
6530
6531 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
6532 # which mean DNS resolution error
6533 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
6534
6535 default_backend be
6536
6537 backend b_503
6538 # dummy backend used to return 503.
6539 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
6540 # 503 error page to end users
6541
6542 backend be
6543 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
6544 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
6545 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
6546 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
6547 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
6548
6549 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
6550 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
6551
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006552http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6553
6554 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
6555 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
6556 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
6557 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01006558 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
6559 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006560
6561 See RFC 8297 for more information.
6562
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006563http-request normalize-uri <normalizer> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006564http-request normalize-uri fragment-encode [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006565http-request normalize-uri fragment-strip [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006566http-request normalize-uri path-merge-slashes [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006567http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dot [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006568http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dotdot [ full ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006569http-request normalize-uri percent-decode-unreserved [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006570http-request normalize-uri percent-to-uppercase [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6571http-request normalize-uri query-sort-by-name [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006572
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006573 Performs normalization of the request's URI.
6574
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006575 URI normalization in HAProxy 2.4 is currently available as an experimental
Amaury Denoyellea9e639a2021-05-06 15:50:12 +02006576 technical preview. As such, it requires the global directive
6577 'expose-experimental-directives' first to be able to invoke it. You should be
6578 prepared that the behavior of normalizers might change to fix possible
6579 issues, possibly breaking proper request processing in your infrastructure.
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006580
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006581 Each normalizer handles a single type of normalization to allow for a
6582 fine-grained selection of the level of normalization that is appropriate for
6583 the supported backend.
6584
6585 As an example the "path-strip-dotdot" normalizer might be useful for a static
6586 fileserver that directly maps the requested URI to the path within the local
6587 filesystem. However it might break routing of an API that expects a specific
6588 number of segments in the path.
6589
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006590 It is important to note that some normalizers might result in unsafe
6591 transformations for broken URIs. It might also be possible that a combination
6592 of normalizers that are safe by themselves results in unsafe transformations
6593 when improperly combined.
6594
6595 As an example the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer might result in
6596 unexpected results when a broken URI includes bare percent characters. One
6597 such a broken URI is "/%%36%36" which would be decoded to "/%66" which in
6598 turn is equivalent to "/f". By specifying the "strict" option requests to
6599 such a broken URI would safely be rejected.
6600
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006601 The following normalizers are available:
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006602
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006603 - fragment-encode: Encodes "#" as "%23".
6604
6605 The "fragment-strip" normalizer should be preferred, unless it is known
6606 that broken clients do not correctly encode '#' within the path component.
6607
6608 Example:
6609 - /#foo -> /%23foo
6610
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006611 - fragment-strip: Removes the URI's "fragment" component.
6612
6613 According to RFC 3986#3.5 the "fragment" component of an URI should not
6614 be sent, but handled by the User Agent after retrieving a resource.
6615
6616 This normalizer should be applied first to ensure that the fragment is
6617 not interpreted as part of the request's path component.
6618
6619 Example:
6620 - /#foo -> /
6621
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006622 - path-strip-dot: Removes "/./" segments within the "path" component
6623 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006624
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006625 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6626 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
6627
Tim Duesterhus7a95f412021-04-21 21:20:33 +02006628 Example:
6629 - /. -> /
6630 - /./bar/ -> /bar/
6631 - /a/./a -> /a/a
6632 - /.well-known/ -> /.well-known/ (no change)
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006633
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006634 - path-strip-dotdot: Normalizes "/../" segments within the "path" component
6635 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
6636
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006637 This merges segments that attempt to access the parent directory with
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006638 their preceding segment.
6639
6640 Empty segments do not receive special treatment. Use the "merge-slashes"
6641 normalizer first if this is undesired.
6642
6643 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6644 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006645
6646 Example:
6647 - /foo/../ -> /
6648 - /foo/../bar/ -> /bar/
6649 - /foo/bar/../ -> /foo/
6650 - /../bar/ -> /../bar/
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006651 - /bar/../../ -> /../
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006652 - /foo//../ -> /foo/
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006653 - /foo/%2E%2E/ -> /foo/%2E%2E/
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006654
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006655 If the "full" option is specified then "../" at the beginning will be
6656 removed as well:
6657
6658 Example:
6659 - /../bar/ -> /bar/
6660 - /bar/../../ -> /
6661
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006662 - path-merge-slashes: Merges adjacent slashes within the "path" component
6663 into a single slash.
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006664
6665 Example:
6666 - // -> /
6667 - /foo//bar -> /foo/bar
6668
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006669 - percent-decode-unreserved: Decodes unreserved percent encoded characters to
6670 their representation as a regular character (RFC 3986#6.2.2.2).
6671
6672 The set of unreserved characters includes all letters, all digits, "-",
6673 ".", "_", and "~".
6674
6675 Example:
6676 - /%61dmin -> /admin
6677 - /foo%3Fbar=baz -> /foo%3Fbar=baz (no change)
6678 - /%%36%36 -> /%66 (unsafe)
6679 - /%ZZ -> /%ZZ
6680
6681 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6682 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6683
6684 Example:
6685 - /%%36%36 -> HTTP 400
6686 - /%ZZ -> HTTP 400
6687
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006688 - percent-to-uppercase: Uppercases letters within percent-encoded sequences
Tim Duesterhusc315efd2021-04-21 21:20:34 +02006689 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.1).
Tim Duesterhusa4071932021-04-15 21:46:02 +02006690
6691 Example:
6692 - /%6f -> /%6F
6693 - /%zz -> /%zz
6694
6695 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6696 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6697
6698 Example:
6699 - /%zz -> HTTP 400
6700
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006701 - query-sort-by-name: Sorts the query string parameters by parameter name.
Tim Duesterhusd7b89be2021-04-15 21:46:01 +02006702 Parameters are assumed to be delimited by '&'. Shorter names sort before
6703 longer names and identical parameter names maintain their relative order.
6704
6705 Example:
6706 - /?c=3&a=1&b=2 -> /?a=1&b=2&c=3
6707 - /?aaa=3&a=1&aa=2 -> /?a=1&aa=2&aaa=3
6708 - /?a=3&b=4&a=1&b=5&a=2 -> /?a=3&a=1&a=2&b=4&b=5
6709
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006710http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006711
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006712 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
6713 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
6714 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
6715 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
6716 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006717
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006718http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006719
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006720 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
6721 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
6722 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
6723 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006724
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006725http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6726 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02006727
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006728 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006729 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
6730 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
6731 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
6732 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
6733 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02006734
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006735 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
6736 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
6737 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
6738 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
6739 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006740
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006741 Example:
6742 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
6743
6744 # applied to:
6745 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6746
6747 # outputs:
6748 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6749
6750 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006751
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006752 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
6753
6754 # applied to:
6755 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006756
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006757 # outputs:
6758 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006759
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006760http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6761 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6762
6763 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
6764 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02006765 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
6766 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
6767 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006768
6769 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6770 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6771 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
6772
6773 Example:
6774 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6775 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
6776
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006777 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
6778 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
6779 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
6780 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
6781
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006782http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6783 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6784
6785 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
6786 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
6787 query-string are replaced.
6788
6789 Example:
6790 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
6791 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
6792
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006793http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6794 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6795
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006796 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
6797 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
6798 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
6799 against.
6800
6801 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6802 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6803 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006804
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006805 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
6806 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
6807 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
6808 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
6809 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
6810 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
6811 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
6812 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
6813 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006814 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
6815 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006816
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006817 Example:
6818 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
6819 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006820
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006821 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6822 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006823
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006824http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6825 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006826
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006827 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
6828 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
6829 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
6830 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006831
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006832 Example:
6833 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006834
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006835 # applied to:
6836 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006837
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006838 # outputs:
6839 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006840
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006841http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6842 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6843 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006844 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006845 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6846
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006847 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006848 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6849 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006850 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006851 be defined. It can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006852 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006853 are followed to create the response :
6854
6855 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6856 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6857 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6858 ignored.
6859
6860 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6861 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006862 status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006863 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
6864 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006865
6866 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6867 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6868 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006869 by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006870 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006871
6872 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6873 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6874 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006875 must be one of the status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006876 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006877 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006878
6879 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6880 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6881 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6882 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6883 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6884 as a raw content.
6885
6886 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6887 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6888 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6889 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6890 considered as a raw string.
6891
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006892 When the response is not based on an errorfile, it is possible to append HTTP
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006893 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6894 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6895 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6896
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006897 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6898 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006899 reserved for the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006900
6901 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6902
6903 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006904 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006905 if { path /ping }
6906
6907 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
6908 if { path /favicon.ico }
6909
6910 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
6911 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
6912 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
6913
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +02006914http-request sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6915
6916 This actions increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
6917 of the array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id>.
6918 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
6919 continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer
6920 between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is no GPC stored
6921 at this index.
6922 This action applies only to the 'gpc' and 'gpc_rate' array data_types (and
6923 not to the legacy 'gpc0', 'gpc1', 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
6924
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006925http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6926http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006927
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006928 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6929 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6930 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006931
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +02006932http-request sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6933 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6934 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT at the index <idx> of the array
6935 associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id> at the value of
6936 <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a boolean.
6937 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
6938 continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer
6939 between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is no GPT stored
6940 at this index.
6941 This action applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not to the
6942 legacy 'gpt0' data-type).
6943
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006944http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6945 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006946
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006947 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6948 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6949 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6950 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006951
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006952http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
6953 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6954
6955 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6956 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6957 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6958 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6959 agent name must be used.
6960
6961 Arguments:
6962 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
6963
6964 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6965 configuration.
6966
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006967http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006968
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006969 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
6970 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
6971 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
6972 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
6973 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006974
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006975 Arguments:
6976 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6977 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006978
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006979 Example:
6980 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
6981 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006982
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006983 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
6984 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006985
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006986http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006987
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006988 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
6989 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
6990 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006991
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006992 Arguments:
6993 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6994 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006995
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006996 Example:
6997 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
6998 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006999
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007000 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
7001 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
7002 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02007003
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007004http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02007005
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007006 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
7007 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
7008 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
7009 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
7010 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02007011
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007012 Example:
7013 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
7014 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
7015 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
7016 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
7017 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
7018 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
7019 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
7020 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
7021 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02007022
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007023http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02007024
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007025 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
7026 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
7027 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
7028 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
7029 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007030
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007031http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
7032 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007033
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007034 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7035 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7036 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
7037 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
7038 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
7039 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
7040 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
7041 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
7042 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007043
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007044http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007045
David Carlierf7f53af2021-06-26 12:04:36 +01007046 This is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK on all packets sent to the client
7047 to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
7048 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter/ipfw and by the
7049 routing table or monitoring the packets through DTrace. It can be expressed
7050 both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x").
7051 This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route (for
7052 example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
David Carlierbae4cb22021-07-03 10:15:15 +01007053 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges, as well on FreeBSD
7054 and OpenBSD.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02007055
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007056http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007057
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007058 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
7059 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
7060 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007061
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007062http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007063
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007064 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
7065 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
7066 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
7067 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
7068 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
7069 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
7070 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
7071 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007072
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007073http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02007074
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007075 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
7076 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
7077 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
7078 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
7079 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
7080 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02007081
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007082 Example :
7083 # prepend the host name before the path
7084 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007085
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02007086http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7087
7088 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
7089 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
7090 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
7091
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007092http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02007093
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007094 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
7095 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
7096 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
7097 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
7098 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007099
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007100http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007101
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007102 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
7103 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
7104 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
7105 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
7106 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
7107 values have higher priority.
7108 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
7109 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
7110 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
7111 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
7112 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007113
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007114http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01007115
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007116 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
7117 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
7118 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
7119 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
7120 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
7121 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
7122 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007123
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007124 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007125
7126 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007127 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
7128 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007129
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007130http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7131 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
7132 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
7133 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02007134 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
7135 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007136
7137 Arguments :
7138 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
7139 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007140
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02007141 See also "option forwardfor".
7142
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007143 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007144 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
7145 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
7146
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02007147 # After the masking this will track connections
7148 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
7149 http-request track-sc0 src
7150
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007151 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
7152 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
7153
7154http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7155
7156 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
7157 expression.
7158
7159 Arguments:
7160 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
7161 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007162
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01007163 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007164 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
7165 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
7166
7167 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
7168 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
7169 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
7170
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02007171http-request set-timeout { server | tunnel } { <timeout> | <expr> }
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01007172 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7173
7174 This action overrides the specified "server" or "tunnel" timeout for the
7175 current stream only. The timeout can be specified in millisecond or with any
7176 other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit as explained at the top of
7177 this document. It is also possible to write an expression which must returns
7178 a number interpreted as a timeout in millisecond.
7179
7180 Note that the server/tunnel timeouts are only relevant on the backend side
7181 and thus this rule is only available for the proxies with backend
7182 capabilities. Also the timeout value must be non-null to obtain the expected
7183 results.
7184
7185 Example:
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02007186 http-request set-timeout tunnel 5s
7187 http-request set-timeout server req.hdr(host),map_int(host.lst)
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01007188
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007189http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7190
7191 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
7192 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
7193 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
7194 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
7195 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
7196 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
7197 information from the request.
7198
7199 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
7200
7201http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7202
7203 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
7204 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
7205 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
7206 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
7207 path and the query string.
7208 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
7209
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01007210http-request set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7211http-request set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007212
7213 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
7214 inline.
7215
7216 Arguments:
7217 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
7218 scope. The scopes allowed are:
7219 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
7220 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
7221 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
7222 (request and response)
7223 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
7224 processing
7225 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
7226 processing
7227 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
7228 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
7229 and '_'.
7230
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01007231 <cond> A set of conditions that must all be true for the variable to
7232 actually be set (such as "ifnotempty", "ifgt" ...). See the
Ilya Shipitsin5e87bcf2021-12-25 11:45:52 +05007233 set-var converter's description for a full list of possible
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01007234 conditions.
7235
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007236 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
7237 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01007238
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02007239 <fmt> This is the value expressed using log-format rules (see Custom
7240 Log Format in section 8.2.4).
7241
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007242 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007243 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02007244 http-request set-var-fmt(txn.from) %[src]:%[src_port]
7245
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007246http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7247
7248 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
7249 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
7250 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
7251 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
7252 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
7253 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
7254 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
7255 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
7256 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
7257 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
7258 action.
7259 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
7260 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
7261 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
7262 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
7263 you fully understand how it works.
7264
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007265http-request strict-mode { on | off } [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007266
7267 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
7268 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
7269 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
7270 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
7271 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007272 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007273 processing.
7274
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01007275 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007276 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
7277 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
7278 rules evaluation.
7279
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007280http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7281http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
7282 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7283 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
7284 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
7285 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007286
7287 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
7288 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
7289 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007290 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
7291 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
7292 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
7293 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
7294 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
7295 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007296 things worse by forcing HAProxy and the front firewall to support insane
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007297 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
7298 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
7299 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007300 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007301 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
7302 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
7303 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
7304 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
7305 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007306
7307http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7308http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7309http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7310
7311 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
7312 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
7313 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
7314 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +02007315 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007316 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
7317 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
7318 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
7319 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
7320 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
7321 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
7322 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
7323
7324 Arguments :
7325 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
7326 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
7327 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
7328 select which table entry to update the counters.
7329
7330 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
7331 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
7332 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
7333 that table until the session ends.
7334
7335 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
7336 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
7337 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
7338 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
7339 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
7340 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
7341 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
7342 useful information.
7343
7344 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
7345 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
7346 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
7347 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
7348 checks that make use of it.
7349
7350http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7351
7352 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007353
7354 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007355 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007356
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01007357http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7358
7359 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
7360 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
7361 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
7362 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
7363 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
7364 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
7365
7366 Arguments :
7367 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
7368
7369 Example:
7370 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
7371
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007372http-request wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7373 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7374
7375 This will delay the processing of the request waiting for the payload for at
7376 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
7377 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
7378 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
7379 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the request
7380 buffer is full. This action may be used as a replacement to "option
7381 http-buffer-request".
7382
7383 Arguments :
7384
7385 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
7386 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
7387
7388 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05007389 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007390 bytes.
7391
7392 Example:
7393 http-request wait-for-body time 1s at-least 1k if METH_POST
7394
7395 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
7396
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007397http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007398
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007399 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
7400 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
7401 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007402
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01007403
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007404http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007405 Access control for Layer 7 responses
7406
7407 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02007408 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007409
7410 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
7411 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
7412 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
7413 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
7414 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
7415 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
7416
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007417 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
7418 supported:
7419 - add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
7420 - add-header <name> <fmt>
7421 - allow
7422 - cache-store <name>
7423 - capture <sample> id <id>
7424 - del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
7425 - del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ]
7426 - del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt>
7427 - deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] ...
7428 - redirect <rule>
7429 - replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7430 - replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7431 - return [status <code>] [content-type <type>] ...
7432 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
7433 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
7434 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
7435 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7436 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7437 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
7438 - set-header <name> <fmt>
7439 - set-log-level <level>
7440 - set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
7441 - set-mark <mark>
7442 - set-nice <nice>
7443 - set-status <status> [reason <str>]
7444 - set-tos <tos>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01007445 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
7446 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007447 - silent-drop
7448 - strict-mode { on | off }
7449 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
7450 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
7451 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
7452 - unset-var(<var-name>)
7453 - wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7454
7455 The supported actions are described below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007456
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007457 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007458
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02007459 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
7460 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
7461 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
7462 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
7463 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
7464 a defaults section defining such rules.
7465
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007466 Example:
7467 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02007468
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007469 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007470
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007471 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
7472 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007473
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007474 Example:
7475 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007476
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007477 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007478
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007479 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
7480 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007481
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007482 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
7483 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007484
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007485http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007486
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007487 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. Please refer to "http-request
7488 add-acl" for a complete description.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007489
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007490http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007491
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007492 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007493 value is defined by <fmt>. Please refer to "http-request add-header" for a
7494 complete description.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007495
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007496http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007497
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007498 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
7499 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007500
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02007501http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007502
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007503 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007504
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007505http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007506
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007507 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
7508 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
7509 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
7510 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
7511 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
7512 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
7513 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007514
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007515 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
7516 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
7517 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
7518 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
7519 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01007520
7521 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
7522 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
7523 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
7524 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007525
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007526http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007527
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007528 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. Please refer to "http-request
7529 del-acl" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02007530
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007531http-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02007532
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007533 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. Please
7534 refer to "http-request del-header" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02007535
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007536http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02007537
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007538 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. Please refer to "http-request
7539 del-map" for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007540
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007541http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7542http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
7543 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7544 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
7545 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
7546 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007547
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007548 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
7549 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
7550 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007551 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007552 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
7553 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
7554 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01007555 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007556 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007557
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007558http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007559
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007560 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
7561 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
7562 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
7563 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
7564 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
7565 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007566
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007567http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7568 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007569
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007570 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
7571 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01007572
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007573 Example:
7574 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02007575
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007576 # applied to:
7577 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007578
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007579 # outputs:
7580 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007581
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007582 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007583
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007584http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7585 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007586
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01007587 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007588 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007589
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007590 Example:
7591 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007592
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007593 # applied to:
7594 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007595
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007596 # outputs:
7597 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007598
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007599http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
7600 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7601 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007602 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007603 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7604
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007605 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a
7606 response. Please refer to "http-request return" for a complete
7607 description. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007608
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +02007609http-response sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007610http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7611http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08007612
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007613 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
7614 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
7615 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
7616 description.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02007617
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +02007618http-response sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007619 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007620http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7621 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007622http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7623 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02007624
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007625 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
7626 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
7627 sc-inc-gpt" and "http-request sc-inc-gpt0" for a complete description.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01007628
Christopher Faulet24e7f352021-08-12 09:32:07 +02007629http-response send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
7630 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02007631
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007632 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. Please
7633 refer to "http-request send-spoe-group" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007634
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007635http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007636
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007637 This does the same as "http-response add-header" except that the header name
7638 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
7639 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
7640 external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007641
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007642http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7643
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007644 This is used to change the log level of the current response. Please refer to
7645 "http-request set-log-level" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007646
7647http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
7648
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007649 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. Please refer to "http-request
7650 set-map" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007651
7652http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7653
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007654 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
7655 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
7656 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007657
7658http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7659
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007660 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. Please
7661 refer to "http-request set-nice" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007662
7663http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
7664 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7665
7666 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
7667 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
7668 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
7669 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007670
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007671 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007672 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
7673 http-response set-status 431
7674 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
7675 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007676
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007677http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007678
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007679 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007680 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
7681 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007682
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01007683http-response set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7684http-response set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007685
7686 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007687 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
7688 for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007689
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007690http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007691
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007692 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
7693 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007694 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
7695 complete description.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007696
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007697http-response strict-mode { on | off } [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007698
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007699 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following
7700 rules. Please refer to "http-request strict-mode" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007701
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007702http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7703http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7704http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007705
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007706 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
7707 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
7708 track-sc2" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007709
7710http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7711
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007712 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-request set-var" for details
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007713 about <var-name>.
7714
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007715http-response wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7716 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7717
7718 This will delay the processing of the response waiting for the payload for at
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007719 most <time> milliseconds. Please refer to "http-request wait-for-body" for a
7720 complete description.
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007721
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02007722
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007723http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
7724 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
7725
7726 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7727 yes | no | yes | yes
7728
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007729 By default, a connection established between HAProxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007730 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
7731 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
7732 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007733
7734 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
7735
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007736 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
7737 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
7738 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
7739 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
7740 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
7741 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
7742 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007743 such an application could be an old HAProxy using cookie
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007744 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
7745 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007746
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007747 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
7748 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
7749 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
7750 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
7751 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
7752 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
7753 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
Amaury Denoyelle27179652020-10-14 18:17:12 +02007754 effects. There is also a special handling for the connections
7755 using protocols subject to Head-of-line blocking (backend with
7756 h2 or fcgi). In this case, when at least one stream is
7757 processed, the used connection is reserved to handle streams
7758 of the same session. When no more streams are processed, the
7759 connection is released and can be reused.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007760
7761 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
7762 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
7763 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
7764 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
7765 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
7766 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
7767 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
7768 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02007769 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007770 downsides of rare connection failures.
7771
7772 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
7773 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
7774 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
7775 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
7776 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
7777 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007778 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007779 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
7780 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
7781 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
7782 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
7783 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
7784
7785 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007786 connection properties and compatibility. Indeed, some properties are specific
7787 and it is not possibly to reuse it blindly. Those are the SSL SNI, source
7788 and destination address and proxy protocol block. A connection is reused only
7789 if it shares the same set of properties with the request.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007790
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007791 Also note that connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying
7792 on the connection) like NTLM are marked private and never shared.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007793
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01007794 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007795
7796 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
7797 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
7798 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
7799
7800 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
7801
7802
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007803http-send-name-header [<header>]
7804 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007805 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7806 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007807 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007808 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
7809
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02007810 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
7811 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
7812 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
7813 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
7814 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
7815 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
7816 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
7817 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
7818 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
7819 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
7820 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
7821 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
7822 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
7823 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
7824 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
7825 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007826
7827 See also : "server"
7828
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007829id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02007830 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
7831 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7832 no | yes | yes | yes
7833 Arguments : none
7834
7835 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
7836 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
7837 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007838
7839
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007840ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
7841 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
7842 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01007843 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007844
7845 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
7846 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
7847 and running).
7848
7849 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
7850 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
7851 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007852 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007853 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
7854
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007855 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
7856 "unless" condition is met.
7857
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007858 Example:
7859 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
7860 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
7861 ignore-persist if url_static
7862
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007863 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
7864
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007865load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
7866 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
7867 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7868 yes | no | yes | yes
7869
7870 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
7871 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
7872 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007873 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007874 to tell HAProxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007875 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
7876 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
7877 over the stats socket and redirect output.
7878
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007879 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007880 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02007881 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007882
7883 Arguments:
7884 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
7885 named "server-state-file".
7886
7887 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
7888 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
7889 name is used as a file name.
7890
7891 none don't load any stat for this backend
7892
7893 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007894 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
7895 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
7896 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007897 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007898 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007899
7900 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
7901 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
7902
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007903 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007904
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007905 global
7906 stats socket /tmp/socket
7907 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007908
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007909 defaults
7910 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007911
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007912 backend bk
7913 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7914 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007915
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007916
7917 Then one can run :
7918
7919 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
7920
7921 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
7922
7923 1
7924 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7925 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7926 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7927
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007928 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007929
7930 global
7931 stats socket /tmp/socket
7932 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
7933
7934 defaults
7935 load-server-state-from-file local
7936
7937 backend bk
7938 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7939 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
7940
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007941
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007942 Then one can run :
7943
7944 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
7945
7946 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
7947
7948 1
7949 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7950 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7951 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7952
7953 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
7954 "show servers state"
7955
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007956
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007957log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01007958log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007959 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007960no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007961 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
7962 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7963 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007964
7965 Prefix :
7966 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
7967 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
7968 prefix does not allow arguments.
7969
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007970 Arguments :
7971 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
7972 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
7973 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
7974 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
7975 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
7976 parameter.
7977
7978 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
7979 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
7980
7981 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
7982 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7983 standard syslog port).
7984
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01007985 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
7986 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7987 standard syslog port).
7988
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007989 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
7990 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
7991 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007992 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007993
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007994 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
7995 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
7996 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
7997 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
7998 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
7999 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
8000 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
8001 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
8002 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
8003 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
8004 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
8005 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008006 significantly slow HAProxy down as non-blocking calls will be
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01008007 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
8008 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
8009 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01008010 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
8011 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01008012
8013 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
8014 and "fd@2", see above.
8015
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02008016 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
8017 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
8018 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
8019 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
8020 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
8021 having the logs instantly available.
8022
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02008023 - An explicit stream address prefix such as "tcp@","tcp6@",
8024 "tcp4@" or "uxst@" will allocate an implicit ring buffer with
8025 a stream forward server targeting the given address.
8026
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01008027 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8028 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01008029
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02008030 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
8031 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
8032 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
8033 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
8034 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
8035 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
8036 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
8037 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
8038 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
8039 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008040 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02008041
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02008042 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
8043 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
8044 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
8045 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
8046 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
8047
8048 <sample_size>
8049 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
8050 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
8051 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
8052 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
8053 (see also <ranges> parameter).
8054
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01008055 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
8056 one of the following :
8057
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01008058 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
8059 field is stripped. This is the default.
8060 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
8061 rfc3164.
8062
8063 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01008064 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
8065
8066 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
8067 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
8068
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02008069 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
8070 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
8071 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
8072 designed to be used with a local log server.
8073
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01008074 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
8075 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
8076 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
8077 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
8078 systemd logger consumes.
8079
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02008080 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
8081 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
8082 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
8083 used with a local log server.
8084
8085 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
8086 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
8087 designed to be used with a local log server.
8088
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01008089 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
8090 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
8091 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
8092 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
8093
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008094 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
8095
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01008096 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
8097 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
8098 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
8099
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01008100 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
8101 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
8102 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
8103 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008104
8105 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
8106 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
8107 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02008108 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
8109 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
8110 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
8111 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
8112 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008113
8114 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
8115
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02008116 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
8117 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
8118 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008119
8120 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
8121 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
8122 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
8123 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
8124
8125 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
8126 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008127
8128 Example :
8129 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01008130 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
8131 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
8132 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02008133 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02008134 log tcp@127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output
8135 # level and send in tcp
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008136 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01008137
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008138
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008139log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01008140 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
8141 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8142 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008143
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01008144 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
8145 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
8146 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
8147 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
8148 string in depth.
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02008149 A specific log-format used only in case of connection error can also be
8150 defined, see the "error-log-format" option.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008151
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02008152 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format",
8153 "option httplog" and "option httpslog" directives.
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008154
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02008155log-format-sd <string>
8156 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
8157 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8158 yes | yes | yes | no
8159
8160 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
8161 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
8162 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
8163 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
8164 which covers the log format string in depth.
8165
8166 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
8167 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
8168
8169 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
8170 log format to "rfc5424".
8171
8172 Example :
8173 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
8174
8175
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01008176log-tag <string>
8177 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
8178 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8179 yes | yes | yes | yes
8180
8181 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
8182 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008183 from the command line, which usually is "HAProxy". Sometimes it can be useful
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01008184 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
8185 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
8186 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
8187 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
8188 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
8189 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008190
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02008191max-keep-alive-queue <value>
8192 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
8193 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8194 yes | no | yes | yes
8195
8196 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
8197 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
8198 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
8199 servers.
8200
8201 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008202 connections at which HAProxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02008203 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
8204 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
8205 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008206 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02008207 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
8208 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
8209 picking a different server.
8210
8211 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
8212 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
8213 even if they have to be queued.
8214
8215 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
8216 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
8217
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01008218max-session-srv-conns <nb>
8219 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
8220 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
8221 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02008222
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008223maxconn <conns>
8224 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
8225 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8226 yes | yes | yes | no
8227 Arguments :
8228 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
8229 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
8230 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
8231 closes.
8232
8233 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008234 very high so that HAProxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008235 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
8236 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01008237 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
8238 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
8239 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
8240 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008241
8242 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
8243 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
8244 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
8245
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01008246 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
8247 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02008248
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008249 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
8250
8251
Willy Tarreau77e0dae2020-10-14 15:44:27 +02008252mode { tcp|http }
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008253 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
8254 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8255 yes | yes | yes | yes
8256 Arguments :
8257 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
8258 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
8259 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
8260 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
8261
8262 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
8263 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
8264 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
8265 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
8266 brings HAProxy most of its value.
8267
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008268 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
8269 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
8270 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008271
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008272 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008273 defaults http_instances
8274 mode http
8275
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008276
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008277monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008278 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008279 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8280 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008281 Arguments :
8282 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
8283 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008284 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008285 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
8286 backend and its backup.
8287
8288 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
8289 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
8290 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
8291 servers in a list of backends.
8292
8293 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
8294 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
8295 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008296 conditions above is met, HAProxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008297 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
8298 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008299 HAProxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02008300 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
8301 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008302
8303 Example:
8304 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008305 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008306 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
8307 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
8308 monitor-uri /site_alive
8309 monitor fail if site_dead
8310
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008311 See also : "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008312
8313
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008314monitor-uri <uri>
8315 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
8316 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8317 yes | yes | yes | no
8318 Arguments :
8319 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
8320 health status instead of forwarding the request.
8321
8322 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
8323 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
8324 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
8325 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
8326 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
8327 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
8328 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
8329 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
8330
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01008331 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008332 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
8333 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
8334 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
8335 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
8336 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
8337 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008338
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01008339 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
8340 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
8341 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
8342 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
8343
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008344 Example :
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008345 # Use /haproxy_test to report HAProxy's status
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008346 frontend www
8347 mode http
8348 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
8349
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008350 See also : "monitor fail"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008351
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008352
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008353option abortonclose
8354no option abortonclose
8355 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
8356 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8357 yes | no | yes | yes
8358 Arguments : none
8359
8360 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
8361 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
8362 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
8363 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008364 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008365 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
8366 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
8367 encountered while delivering the response.
8368
8369 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
8370 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
8371 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
8372 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
8373 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
8374 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008375 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008376 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008377 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008378 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
8379 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
8380 still not served and not pollute the servers.
8381
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008382 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
8383 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008384 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
8385 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
8386 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
8387 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
8388 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
8389 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008390 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008391
8392 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8393 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8394
8395 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
8396
8397
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008398option accept-invalid-http-request
8399no option accept-invalid-http-request
8400 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
8401 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8402 yes | yes | yes | no
8403 Arguments : none
8404
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008405 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008406 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008407 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008408 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8409 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8410 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8411 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8412 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008413 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
8414 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
8415 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
8416 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008417 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008418 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02008419 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
Willy Tarreau1ba30162022-05-24 15:34:26 +02008420 to pass through (no version specified), as well as different protocol names
8421 (e.g. RTSP), and multiple digits for both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008422
8423 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8424 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8425 been confirmed.
8426
8427 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8428 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008429 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
8430 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008431 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8432
8433 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8434 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8435
8436 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
8437 stats socket.
8438
8439
8440option accept-invalid-http-response
8441no option accept-invalid-http-response
8442 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
8443 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8444 yes | no | yes | yes
8445 Arguments : none
8446
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008447 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008448 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008449 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008450 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8451 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8452 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8453 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8454 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008455 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
8456 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
8457 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008458
8459 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8460 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8461 been confirmed.
8462
8463 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8464 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
8465 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
8466 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8467
8468 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8469 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8470
8471 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
8472 stats socket.
8473
8474
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008475option allbackups
8476no option allbackups
8477 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
8478 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8479 yes | no | yes | yes
8480 Arguments : none
8481
8482 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
8483 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
8484 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
8485 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
8486 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
8487 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
8488 order between the backup servers anymore.
8489
8490 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
8491 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
8492
8493 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8494 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8495
8496
8497option checkcache
8498no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08008499 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008500 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8501 yes | no | yes | yes
8502 Arguments : none
8503
8504 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
8505 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008506 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008507 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
8508 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008509 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008510
8511 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008512 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008513 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008514 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
8515 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008516 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008517 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01008518 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
8519 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008520 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01008521 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
8522 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008523 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008524 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
8525 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
8526 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
8527 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
8528 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
8529 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
8530 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
8531 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
8532 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
8533
8534 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008535 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
8536 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
8537 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
8538 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008539
8540 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
8541 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008542 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008543 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008544
8545 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8546 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8547
8548
8549option clitcpka
8550no option clitcpka
8551 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
8552 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8553 yes | yes | yes | no
8554 Arguments : none
8555
8556 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8557 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008558 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008559 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8560
8561 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8562 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8563 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8564 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8565
8566 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8567 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8568 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8569 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8570 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8571
8572 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8573
8574 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8575 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8576 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
8577
8578 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8579 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8580
8581 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
8582
8583
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008584option contstats
8585 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
8586 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8587 yes | yes | yes | no
8588 Arguments : none
8589
8590 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
8591 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
8592 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008593 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from HAProxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01008594 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
8595 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
8596 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
8597 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
8598 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008599
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008600option disable-h2-upgrade
8601no option disable-h2-upgrade
8602 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
8603 connection.
8604 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8605 yes | yes | yes | no
8606 Arguments : none
8607
8608 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
8609 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
8610 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
8611 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +01008612 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be
8613 used to disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only
8614 supported for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to
8615 force the HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind
8616 line. Finally, this option is applied on all bind lines. To disable implicit
8617 HTTP/2 upgrades for a specific bind line, it is possible to use "proto h1".
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008618
8619 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8620 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008621
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008622option dontlog-normal
8623no option dontlog-normal
8624 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
8625 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8626 yes | yes | yes | no
8627 Arguments : none
8628
8629 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
8630 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
8631 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
8632 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
8633 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
8634 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
8635 logged.
8636
8637 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
8638 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
8639 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
8640
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008641 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008642 logging.
8643
8644
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008645option dontlognull
8646no option dontlognull
8647 Enable or disable logging of null connections
8648 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8649 yes | yes | yes | no
8650 Arguments : none
8651
8652 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
8653 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
8654 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
8655 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
8656 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
8657 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008658 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
8659 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
8660 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008661
8662 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008663 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008664 would not be logged.
8665
8666 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8667 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8668
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008669 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-uri", and
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008670 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008671
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008672
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008673option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008674 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
8675 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8676 yes | yes | yes | yes
8677 Arguments :
8678 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8679 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008680 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008681 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008682
8683 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
8684 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
8685 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
8686 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
8687 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
8688 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
8689 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008690 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
8691 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8692 possible that the client has already brought one.
8693
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008694 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008695 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008696 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008697 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008698 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008699 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008700
8701 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8702 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8703 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
8704 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
8705 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
8706 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
Christopher Faulet5d1def62021-02-26 09:19:15 +01008707 private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both supported.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008708
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008709 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
8710 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008711 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching HAProxy
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008712 are under the control of the end-user.
8713
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008714 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008715 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8716 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008717 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
8718 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
8719 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008720
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008721 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008722 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
8723 frontend www
8724 mode http
8725 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
8726
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008727 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
8728 backend www
8729 mode http
8730 option forwardfor header X-Client
8731
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008732 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008733 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008734
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008735
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02008736option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8737no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8738 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
8739 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8740 yes | yes | yes | no
8741 Arguments : none
8742
8743 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8744 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8745 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8746 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8747 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8748 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8749 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8750
8751 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
8752 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
8753 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
8754 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8755 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
8756 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8757 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8758 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
8759 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8760 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8761
8762 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
8763
8764 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8765 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8766
8767 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
8768 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8769
8770
8771option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8772no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8773 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
8774 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8775 yes | no | yes | yes
8776 Arguments : none
8777
8778 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8779 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8780 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8781 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8782 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8783 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8784 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8785
8786 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
8787 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
8788 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
8789 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8790 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
8791 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8792 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8793 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
8794 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8795 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8796
8797 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
8798
8799 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8800 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8801
8802 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
8803 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8804
8805
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008806option http-buffer-request
8807no option http-buffer-request
8808 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
8809 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8810 yes | yes | yes | yes
8811 Arguments : none
8812
8813 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
8814 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
8815 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
8816 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
8817 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
8818 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01008819 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
8820 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
8821 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
8822 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008823
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008824 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request",
8825 "http-request wait-for-body"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008826
8827
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008828option http-ignore-probes
8829no option http-ignore-probes
8830 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
8831 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8832 yes | yes | yes | no
8833 Arguments : none
8834
8835 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
8836 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
8837 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
8838 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
8839 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
8840 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
8841 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
8842 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
8843 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008844 was received over a connection before it was closed;
8845 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008846 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
8847
8848 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
8849 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
8850 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
8851 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
8852 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
8853 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
8854 are often the only way to detect them.
8855
8856 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8857 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8858
8859 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
8860
8861
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008862option http-keep-alive
8863no option http-keep-alive
8864 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
8865 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8866 yes | yes | yes | yes
8867 Arguments : none
8868
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008869 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8870 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008871 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8872 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008873 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
8874 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
8875 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008876
8877 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
8878 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008879 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
8880 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
8881 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
8882 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
8883 situations where this option may be useful :
8884
8885 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008886 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008887
8888 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
8889 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
8890
8891 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
8892 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
8893 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
8894 request.
8895
8896 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
8897 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008898 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
8899 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
8900 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008901
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008902 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8903 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8904 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8905 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
8906 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8907 not set.
8908
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008909 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8910 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
8911 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008912
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008913 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008914 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01008915 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008916
8917
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008918option http-no-delay
8919no option http-no-delay
8920 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
8921 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8922 yes | yes | yes | yes
8923 Arguments : none
8924
8925 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
8926 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
8927 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
8928 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
8929 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
8930 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
8931 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008932 HAProxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008933 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
8934 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
8935 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
8936 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
8937 affected.
8938
8939 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
8940 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
8941 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
8942 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
8943 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
8944 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
8945 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
8946 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
8947 latency environments.
8948
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008949 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
8950
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008951
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008952option http-pretend-keepalive
8953no option http-pretend-keepalive
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008954 Define whether HAProxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008955 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008956 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008957 Arguments : none
8958
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008959 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", HAProxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008960 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
8961 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
8962 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008963 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents HAProxy from
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008964 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
8965 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
8966 consider the response complete.
8967
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008968 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", HAProxy will make the server
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008969 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008970 to the abnormal undesired above. When HAProxy gets the whole response, it
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008971 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008972 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008973 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
8974
8975 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
8976 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
8977 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
8978 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008979 worth noting that when this option is enabled, HAProxy will have slightly
8980 less work to do. So if HAProxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008981 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
8982
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008983 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
8984 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
8985 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
8986 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
8987 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
8988 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008989
8990 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8991 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8992
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008993 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008994 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008995
Christopher Faulet18c13d32022-05-16 11:43:10 +02008996option http-restrict-req-hdr-names { preserve | delete | reject }
8997 Set HAProxy policy about HTTP request header names containing characters
8998 outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset
8999 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9000 yes | yes | yes | yes
9001 Arguments :
9002 preserve disable the filtering. It is the default mode for HTTP proxies
9003 with no FastCGI application configured.
9004
9005 delete remove request headers with a name containing a character
9006 outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset. It is the default mode for
9007 HTTP backends with a configured FastCGI application.
9008
9009 reject reject the request with a 403-Forbidden response if it contains a
9010 header name with a character outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset.
9011
9012 This option may be used to restrict the request header names to alphanumeric
9013 and hyphen characters ([A-Za-z0-9-]). This may be mandatory to interoperate
9014 with non-HTTP compliant servers that fail to handle some characters in header
9015 names. It may also be mandatory for FastCGI applications because all
9016 non-alphanumeric characters in header names are replaced by an underscore
9017 ('_'). Thus, it is easily possible to mix up header names and bypass some
9018 rules. For instance, "X-Forwarded-For" and "X_Forwarded-For" headers are both
9019 converted to "HTTP_X_FORWARDED_FOR" in FastCGI.
9020
9021 Note this option is evaluated per proxy and after the http-request rules
9022 evaluation.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009023
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01009024option http-server-close
9025no option http-server-close
9026 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
9027 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9028 yes | yes | yes | yes
9029 Arguments : none
9030
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009031 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
9032 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
9033 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
9034 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02009035 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
9036 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
9037 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
9038 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
9039 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
9040 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
9041 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
9042 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
9043 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
9044 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
9045 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01009046
9047 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
9048 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
9049 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
9050 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009051 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
9052 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01009053
9054 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
9055 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02009056 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
9057 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
9058 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01009059
9060 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9061 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9062
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009063 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
9064 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01009065
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009066option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01009067no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009068 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
9069 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9070 yes | yes | yes | no
9071 Arguments : none
9072
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00009073 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009074 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
9075 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
9076 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
9077 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
9078 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009079 HAProxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009080
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009081 By setting this option in a frontend, HAProxy can automatically switch to use
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009082 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01009083 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
9084 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
9085 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009086
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01009087 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
9088 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
9089 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
9090 front of an existing proxy.
9091
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009092 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
9093
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009094 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009095
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009096option httpchk
9097option httpchk <uri>
9098option httpchk <method> <uri>
9099option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009100 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009101 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9102 yes | no | yes | yes
9103 Arguments :
9104 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
9105 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
9106 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
9107 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
9108 ones.
9109
9110 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
9111 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
9112 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
9113
9114 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
9115 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
9116 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02009117 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009118
9119 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
9120 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
9121 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
9122 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
9123 the lack of any response.
9124
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02009125 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
9126 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
9127 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
9128 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
9129
9130 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
9131 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
9132 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009133
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02009134 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
9135 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02009136 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04009137 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02009138 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009139
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02009140 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
9141 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
9142 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
9143 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
9144
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009145 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009146 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
9147 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
9148 backend https_relay
9149 mode tcp
9150 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
9151 http-check send hdr Host www
9152 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009153
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09009154 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
9155 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
9156 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009157
9158
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009159option httpclose
9160no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009161 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009162 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9163 yes | yes | yes | yes
9164 Arguments : none
9165
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009166 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
9167 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
9168 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
9169 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02009170 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009171
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009172 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
9173 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05009174 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009175 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
9176 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009177
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009178 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
9179 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
9180 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009181
9182 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
9183 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02009184 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
9185 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
9186 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009187
9188 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9189 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9190
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009191 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009192
9193
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02009194option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009195 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
9196 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01009197 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02009198 Arguments :
9199 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
9200 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
9201 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009202 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02009203 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009204
9205 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9206 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9207 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
9208 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
9209 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
9210 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
9211 ports.
9212
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01009213 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
9214 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02009215
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02009216 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9217
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009218 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009219
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02009220option httpslog
9221 Enable logging of HTTPS request, session state and timers
9222 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9223 yes | yes | yes | no
9224
9225 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9226 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9227 "option httpslog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
9228 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
9229 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
9230 frontend, backend and server name, the SSL certificate verification and SSL
9231 handshake statuses, and of course the source address and ports.
9232
9233 "option httpslog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9234
9235 See also : section 8 about logging.
9236
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009237
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009238option independent-streams
9239no option independent-streams
9240 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02009241 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9242 yes | yes | yes | yes
9243 Arguments : none
9244
9245 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
9246 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
9247 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
9248 receive data or not.
9249
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009250 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02009251 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
9252 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
9253 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
9254 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
9255 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
9256 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
9257 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
9258 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
9259 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
9260 socket buffers.
9261
9262 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
9263 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
9264 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
9265 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
9266 slow lines, so use it with caution.
9267
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009268 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02009269
9270
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02009271option ldap-check
9272 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
9273 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9274 yes | no | yes | yes
9275 Arguments : none
9276
9277 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
9278 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
9279 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
9280 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
9281
9282 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
9283 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
9284
9285 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
9286 configure it.
9287
9288 Example :
9289 option ldap-check
9290
9291 See also : "option httpchk"
9292
9293
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009294option external-check
9295 Use external processes for server health checks
9296 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9297 yes | no | yes | yes
9298
9299 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
9300 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
9301 command".
9302
9303 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
9304
9305 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
9306
9307
William Dauchya9dd9012022-01-05 22:53:24 +01009308option idle-close-on-response
9309no option idle-close-on-response
9310 Avoid closing idle frontend connections if a soft stop is in progress
9311 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9312 yes | yes | yes | no
9313 Arguments : none
9314
9315 By default, idle connections will be closed during a soft stop. In some
9316 environments, a client talking to the proxy may have prepared some idle
9317 connections in order to send requests later. If there is no proper retry on
9318 write errors, this can result in errors while haproxy is reloading. Even
9319 though a proper implementation should retry on connection/write errors, this
9320 option was introduced to support backwards compatibility with haproxy prior
9321 to version 2.4. Indeed before v2.4, haproxy used to wait for a last request
9322 and response to add a "connection: close" header before closing, thus
9323 notifying the client that the connection would not be reusable.
9324
9325 In a real life example, this behavior was seen in AWS using the ALB in front
9326 of a haproxy. The end result was ALB sending 502 during haproxy reloads.
9327
9328 Users are warned that using this option may increase the number of old
9329 processes if connections remain idle for too long. Adjusting the client
9330 timeouts and/or the "hard-stop-after" parameter accordingly might be
9331 needed in case of frequent reloads.
9332
9333 See also: "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout http-request",
9334 "hard-stop-after"
9335
9336
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009337option log-health-checks
9338no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009339 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009340 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9341 yes | no | yes | yes
9342 Arguments : none
9343
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009344 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
9345 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
9346 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009347
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009348 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
9349 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
9350 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
9351 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
9352 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
9353
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009354 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009355 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009356
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009357 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
9358 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
9359 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009360
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009361
9362option log-separate-errors
9363no option log-separate-errors
9364 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
9365 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9366 yes | yes | yes | no
9367 Arguments : none
9368
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009369 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes HAProxy
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009370 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
9371 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
9372 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
9373 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
9374 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
9375 provides very important information.
9376
9377 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
9378 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
9379 error logs.
9380
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009381 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009382 logging.
9383
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009384
9385option logasap
9386no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009387 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009388 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9389 yes | yes | yes | no
9390 Arguments : none
9391
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009392 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
9393 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
9394 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
9395 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
9396
9397 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
9398 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
9399 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
9400 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
9401 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009402 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009403 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
9404 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
9405 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
9406 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009407 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009408
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009409 Examples :
9410 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
9411 mode http
9412 option httplog
9413 option logasap
9414 log 192.168.2.200 local3
9415
9416 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
9417 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
9418 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
9419 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
9420
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009421 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009422 logging.
9423
9424
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009425option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009426 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009427 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9428 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009429 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009430 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
9431 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009432 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
9433 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009434
9435 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
9436 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009437 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009438 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
Daniel Blackd3e7dc42021-07-01 12:09:32 +10009439 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires an unlocked authorised
9440 user without a password. To create a basic limited user in MySQL with
9441 optional resource limits:
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009442
Daniel Blackd3e7dc42021-07-01 12:09:32 +10009443 CREATE USER '<username>'@'<ip_of_haproxy|network_of_haproxy/netmask>'
9444 /*!50701 WITH MAX_QUERIES_PER_HOUR 1 MAX_UPDATES_PER_HOUR 0 */
9445 /*M!100201 MAX_STATEMENT_TIME 0.0001 */;
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009446
9447 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009448 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009449 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
9450 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
9451 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
9452 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
9453 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
9454 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
9455 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
9456
9457 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
9458 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009459
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02009460 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009461
9462 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
9463 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
9464 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9465 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009466 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009467 server to route the client via the machine hosting HAProxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009468
9469 See also: "option httpchk"
9470
9471
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009472option nolinger
9473no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009474 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009475 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9476 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009477 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009478
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009479 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009480 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
9481 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
9482 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
9483 connections.
9484
9485 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
9486 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009487 a TCP RST is emitted, any pending data are truncated, and the session is
9488 instantly purged from the system's tables. The generally visible effect for
9489 a client is that responses are truncated if the close happens with a last
9490 block of data (e.g. on a redirect or error response). On the server side,
9491 it may help release the source ports immediately when forwarding a client
9492 aborts in tunnels. In both cases, TCP resets are emitted and given that
9493 the session is instantly destroyed, there will be no retransmit. On a lossy
9494 network this can increase problems, especially when there is a firewall on
9495 the lossy side, because the firewall might see and process the reset (hence
9496 purge its session) and block any further traffic for this session,, including
9497 retransmits from the other side. So if the other side doesn't receive it,
9498 it will never receive any RST again, and the firewall might log many blocked
9499 packets.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009500
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009501 For all these reasons, it is strongly recommended NOT to use this option,
9502 unless absolutely needed as a last resort. In most situations, using the
9503 "client-fin" or "server-fin" timeouts achieves similar results with a more
9504 reliable behavior. On Linux it's also possible to use the "tcp-ut" bind or
9505 server setting.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009506
9507 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
9508 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009509 for servers. While this option is technically supported in "defaults"
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +05009510 sections, it must really not be used there as it risks to accidentally
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009511 propagate to sections that must no use it and to cause problems there.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009512
9513 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9514 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9515
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009516 See also: "timeout client-fin", "timeout server-fin", "tcp-ut" bind or server
9517 keywords.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009518
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009519option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
9520 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
9521 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9522 yes | yes | yes | yes
9523 Arguments :
9524 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
9525 matching <network>
9526 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
9527 header name.
9528
9529 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
9530 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
9531 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
9532 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
9533 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
9534 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
9535 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
9536 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
9537 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
9538 possible that the client has already brought one.
9539
9540 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
9541 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
9542 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
9543 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
9544 header and requires different one.
9545
9546 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
9547 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
9548 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
Amaury Denoyellef8b42922021-03-04 18:41:14 +01009549 header for a known destination address or network by adding the "except"
9550 keyword followed by the network address. In this case, any destination IP
9551 matching the network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common
9552 uses are with private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both
9553 supported.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009554
9555 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
9556 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
9557 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
9558 both are defined.
9559
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009560 Examples :
9561 # Original Destination address
9562 frontend www
9563 mode http
9564 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
9565
9566 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
9567 backend www
9568 mode http
9569 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
9570
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009571 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009572
9573
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009574option persist
9575no option persist
9576 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
9577 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9578 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009579 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009580
9581 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
9582 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
9583 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
9584 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
9585 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
9586 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
9587 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
9588 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
9589 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
9590 redirected to another valid server.
9591
9592 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9593 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9594
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01009595 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009596
9597
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01009598option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
9599 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
9600 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9601 yes | no | yes | yes
9602 Arguments :
9603 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
9604 PostgreSQL server.
9605
9606 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
9607 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
9608 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
9609 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
9610
9611 See also: "option httpchk"
9612
9613
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009614option prefer-last-server
9615no option prefer-last-server
9616 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
9617 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9618 yes | no | yes | yes
9619 Arguments : none
9620
9621 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009622 request was sent to a server to which HAProxy still holds a connection, it is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009623 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
9624 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009625 we only indicate a preference which HAProxy tries to apply without any form
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009626 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009627 this option is used, HAProxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009628 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
9629 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009630 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009631 HAProxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02009632 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
9633 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
9634 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009635 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
9636 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
9637 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009638
9639 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9640 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9641
9642 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
9643
9644
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009645option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009646option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009647no option redispatch
9648 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
9649 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9650 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009651 Arguments :
9652 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
9653 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
9654 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009655 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009656 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009657 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009658 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
9659 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
9660 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
9661
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009662
9663 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
9664 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
9665 be able to access the service anymore.
9666
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01009667 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
9668 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009669
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02009670 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
9671 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
9672 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
9673 following order:
9674
9675 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
9676
9677 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
9678 list, or
9679
9680 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
9681
9682 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
9683 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
9684
9685 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
9686 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
9687 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
9688 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
9689
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009690 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009691 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
9692 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009693
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009694 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9695 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9696
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02009697 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009698
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009699
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009700option redis-check
9701 Use redis health checks for server testing
9702 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9703 yes | no | yes | yes
9704 Arguments : none
9705
9706 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
9707 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9708 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
9709 find the "+PONG" response message.
9710
9711 Example :
9712 option redis-check
9713
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009714 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009715
9716
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009717option smtpchk
9718option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
9719 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
9720 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9721 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009722 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009723 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02009724 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009725 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
9726
9727 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
9728 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
9729 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
9730
9731 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
9732 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
9733 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
9734 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
9735 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
9736 dead server.
9737
9738 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
9739 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009740 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009741 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
9742
9743 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
9744 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
9745 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9746 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009747 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009748
9749 Example :
9750 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
9751
9752 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
9753
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009754
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02009755option socket-stats
9756no option socket-stats
9757
9758 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
9759 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9760 yes | yes | yes | no
9761
9762 Arguments : none
9763
9764
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009765option splice-auto
9766no option splice-auto
9767 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
9768 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9769 yes | yes | yes | yes
9770 Arguments : none
9771
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009772 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009773 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009774 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009775 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009776 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009777 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
9778 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
9779 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
9780 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9781
9782 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
9783 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
9784 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
9785 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
9786 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
9787 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
9788 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
9789 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
9790 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
9791 keyword.
9792
9793 Example :
9794 option splice-auto
9795
9796 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9797 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9798
9799 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
9800 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9801
9802
9803option splice-request
9804no option splice-request
9805 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
9806 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9807 yes | yes | yes | yes
9808 Arguments : none
9809
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009810 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009811 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009812 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9813 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9814 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9815 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9816
9817 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9818
9819 Example :
9820 option splice-request
9821
9822 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9823 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9824
9825 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
9826 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9827
9828
9829option splice-response
9830no option splice-response
9831 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
9832 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9833 yes | yes | yes | yes
9834 Arguments : none
9835
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009836 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009837 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009838 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9839 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9840 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9841 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9842
9843 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9844
9845 Example :
9846 option splice-response
9847
9848 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9849 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9850
9851 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
9852 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9853
9854
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01009855option spop-check
9856 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
9857 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9858 no | no | no | yes
9859 Arguments : none
9860
9861 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
9862 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9863 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
9864 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
9865
9866 Example :
9867 option spop-check
9868
9869 See also : "option httpchk"
9870
9871
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009872option srvtcpka
9873no option srvtcpka
9874 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
9875 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9876 yes | no | yes | yes
9877 Arguments : none
9878
9879 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9880 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009881 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009882 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9883
9884 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9885 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9886 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9887 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9888
9889 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9890 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9891 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9892 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9893 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9894
9895 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9896
9897 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
9898 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
9899 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
9900
9901 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9902 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9903
9904 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
9905
9906
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009907option ssl-hello-chk
9908 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
9909 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9910 yes | no | yes | yes
9911 Arguments : none
9912
9913 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
9914 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
9915 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
9916 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
9917 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
9918 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
9919 hello message.
9920
9921 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
9922 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
9923 messages, which is appreciable.
9924
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009925 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into HAProxy
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009926 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
9927 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009928
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009929 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
9930
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009931
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009932option tcp-check
9933 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
9934 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9935 yes | no | yes | yes
9936
9937 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
9938 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
9939
9940 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
9941 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
9942 attempt, which remains the default mode.
9943
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009944 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009945 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
9946 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
9947 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
9948 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
9949 only.
9950
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009951 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009952 The connection is opened and HAProxy waits for the server to present some
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009953 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
9954 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
9955 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
9956
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009957 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009958 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
9959 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009960 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009961 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
9962 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
9963 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
9964 the respective protocols.
9965 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009966 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009967
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009968 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009969
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009970 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
9971 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
9972 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
9973 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009974
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009975 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
9976 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
9977 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01009978
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009979
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009980 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009981 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009982 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009983 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009984
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009985 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009986 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009987 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009988
9989 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
9990 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009991 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009992 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009993 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009994 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009995 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009996 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009997 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9998 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009999 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010000 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
10001 tcp-check expect string +OK
10002
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010003 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010004 (send many headers before analyzing)
10005 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010006 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010007 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
10008 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
10009 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
10010 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010011 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010012
10013
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010014 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010015
10016
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +020010017option tcp-smart-accept
10018no option tcp-smart-accept
10019 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
10020 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10021 yes | yes | yes | no
10022 Arguments : none
10023
10024 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
10025 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
10026 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
10027 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
10028 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
10029 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
10030
10031 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
10032 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
10033 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
10034 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
10035
10036 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
10037 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
10038 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010039 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +020010040
10041 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
10042 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
10043 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
10044
10045 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
10046 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
10047 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
10048
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +020010049 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
10050
10051
10052option tcp-smart-connect
10053no option tcp-smart-connect
10054 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
10055 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10056 yes | no | yes | yes
10057 Arguments : none
10058
10059 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
10060 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
10061 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
10062 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
10063 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
10064
10065 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
10066 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
10067 complex.
10068
10069 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
10070 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
10071 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
10072
10073 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10074 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10075
10076 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
10077
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +020010078
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +010010079option tcpka
10080 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
10081 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10082 yes | yes | yes | yes
10083 Arguments : none
10084
10085 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
10086 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010087 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +010010088 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
10089
10090 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
10091 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
10092 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
10093 operating system and its tuning parameters.
10094
10095 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
10096 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
10097 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
10098 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
10099 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
10100
10101 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
10102
10103 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
10104 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
10105 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
10106 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
10107 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
10108 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
10109 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
10110 backends.
10111
10112 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
10113
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010114
10115option tcplog
10116 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
10117 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +010010118 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010119 Arguments : none
10120
10121 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
10122 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
10123 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
10124 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
10125 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
10126 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
10127 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
10128 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
10129
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +020010130 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
10131
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010132 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010133
10134
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010135option transparent
10136no option transparent
10137 Enable client-side transparent proxying
10138 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010010139 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010140 Arguments : none
10141
10142 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
10143 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
10144 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
10145 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
10146 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
10147 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
10148 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
10149 appropriate server.
10150
10151 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
10152 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
10153
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +010010154 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010155 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010156
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +010010157
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090010158external-check command <command>
10159 Executable to run when performing an external-check
10160 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10161 yes | no | yes | yes
10162
10163 Arguments :
10164 <command> is the external command to run
10165
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090010166 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
10167
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +010010168 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090010169
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +010010170 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
10171 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
10172 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
10173 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
10174 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
10175 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090010176
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +010010177 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
10178
10179 Environment variables :
10180 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
10181 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
10182
10183 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
10184
10185 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
10186
10187 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
10188 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
10189 for a UNIX socket).
10190
10191 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
10192
10193 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
10194
10195 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
10196
10197 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
10198
10199 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
10200
10201 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
10202 socket).
10203
Willy Tarreau973cf902022-05-13 15:58:35 +020010204 HAPROXY_SERVER_SSL "0" when SSL is not used, "1" when it is used
10205
10206 HAPROXY_SERVER_PROTO The protocol used by this server, which can be one
10207 of "cli" (the haproxy CLI), "syslog" (syslog TCP
10208 server), "peers" (peers TCP server), "h1" (HTTP/1.x
10209 server), "h2" (HTTP/2 server), or "tcp" (any other
10210 TCP server).
10211
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +010010212 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
10213 the command may be set using "external-check path".
10214
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +020010215 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
10216
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090010217 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
10218 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
10219 failed.
10220
10221 Example :
10222 external-check command /bin/true
10223
10224 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
10225
10226
10227external-check path <path>
10228 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
10229 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10230 yes | no | yes | yes
10231
10232 Arguments :
10233 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
10234
10235 The default path is "".
10236
10237 Example :
10238 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
10239
10240 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
10241 "external-check command"
10242
10243
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010244persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +020010245persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010246 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
10247 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10248 yes | no | yes | yes
10249 Arguments :
10250 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +020010251 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
10252 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010253
10254 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
10255 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010256 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010257 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
10258 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
10259 forwarded to this server.
10260
10261 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
10262 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
10263 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010264 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010265 a single "listen" section.
10266
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +020010267 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
10268 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
10269 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
10270
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010271 Example :
10272 listen tse-farm
10273 bind :3389
10274 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
10275 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10276 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
10277 # apply RDP cookie persistence
10278 persist rdp-cookie
10279 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010280 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010281 balance rdp-cookie
10282 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
10283 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
10284
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010010285 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the "req.rdp_cookie" ACL.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010286
10287
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010288rate-limit sessions <rate>
10289 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
10290 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10291 yes | yes | yes | no
10292 Arguments :
10293 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
10294 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
10295
10296 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
10297 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
10298 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010299 (in system buffers) and HAProxy will not even be aware that sessions are
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010300 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
10301 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
10302
10303 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
10304 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
10305 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
10306 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
10307
10308 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
10309 listen smtp
10310 mode tcp
10311 bind :25
10312 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +020010313 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010314
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +020010315 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
10316 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
10317 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010318
10319 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
10320
10321
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010322redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10323redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10324redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010325 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
10326 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10327 no | yes | yes | yes
10328
10329 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +010010330 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010331
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010332 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010333 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010334 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
10335 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
10336 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010337
10338 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
10339 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
10340 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
10341 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
10342 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010343 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
10344 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
10345 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
10346 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010347
10348 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
10349 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
10350 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
10351 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
10352 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
10353 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010354 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010355 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010356 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
10357 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
10358 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010359
10360 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010010361 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
10362 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
10363 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +020010364 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010010365 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
10366 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
10367 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
10368 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010369
10370 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010371 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010372
10373 - "drop-query"
10374 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
10375 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
10376 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
10377 with a location-type redirect.
10378
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010379 - "append-slash"
10380 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
10381 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
10382 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
10383 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
10384
Willy Tarreaubc1223b2021-09-02 16:54:33 +020010385 - "ignore-empty"
10386 This keyword only has effect when a location is produced using a log
10387 format expression (i.e. when used in http-request or http-response).
10388 It indicates that if the result of the expression is empty, the rule
10389 should silently be skipped. The main use is to allow mass-redirects
10390 of known paths using a simple map.
10391
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010392 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
10393 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
10394 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
10395 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
10396 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
10397 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
10398 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
10399
10400 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
10401 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
10402 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
10403 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
10404 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
10405 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
10406 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010407
10408 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
10409 acl clear dst_port 80
10410 acl secure dst_port 8080
10411 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010412 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010413 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010414 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
10415
10416 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010417 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
10418 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
10419 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010420 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010421
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010422 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
10423 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
10424 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
10425
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010426 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by HAProxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +010010427 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010428
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010429 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +020010430 http-request redirect code 301 location \
10431 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
10432 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010433
Willy Tarreaubc1223b2021-09-02 16:54:33 +020010434 Example: permanently redirect only old URLs to new ones
10435 http-request redirect code 301 location \
10436 %[path,map_str(old-blog-articles.map)] ignore-empty
10437
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010438 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010439
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +010010440
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010441retries <value>
10442 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
10443 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10444 yes | no | yes | yes
10445 Arguments :
10446 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
10447 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
10448 default value is 3.
10449
10450 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
10451 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
10452 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
10453
10454 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010455 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
10456 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010457
10458 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
10459 server even if a cookie references a different server.
10460
10461 See also : "option redispatch"
10462
10463
Lukas Tribusde160082021-12-08 11:33:01 +010010464retry-on [space-delimited list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +020010465 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
10466 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
10467 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010468 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10469 yes | no | yes | yes
10470 Arguments :
Lukas Tribusde160082021-12-08 11:33:01 +010010471 <keywords> is a space-delimited list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each
10472 representing a type of failure event on which an attempt to
10473 retry the request is desired. Please read the notes at the
10474 bottom before changing this setting. The following keywords are
10475 supported :
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010476
10477 none never retry
10478
10479 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
10480 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
10481
10482 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
10483 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
10484 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
10485 request timeout on the server side, poor network
10486 condition, or a server crash or restart while
10487 processing the request.
10488
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +020010489 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
10490 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
10491 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
10492 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
10493 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
10494 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
10495 overflow attack for example).
10496
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010497 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
10498 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
10499 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
10500 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
10501 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
10502 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
10503 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
10504 amplify denial of service attacks.
10505
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +020010506 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
10507 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
10508 considered to be safe to retry.
10509
Julien Pivotto2de240a2020-11-12 11:14:05 +010010510 <status> any HTTP status code among "401" (Unauthorized), "403"
10511 (Forbidden), "404" (Not Found), "408" (Request Timeout),
10512 "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server Error), "501" (Not
10513 Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway), "503" (Service
10514 Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010515
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +020010516 all-retryable-errors
10517 retry request for any error that are considered
10518 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
10519 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
10520 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
10521
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010522 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
10523 not cumulative.
10524
10525 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
10526 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
10527 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
10528 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
10529
10530 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
10531 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
10532 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
10533 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
10534 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
10535 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
10536 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
10537 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
10538 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
10539 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
10540 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
10541 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
10542
10543 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
10544 should not use this directive.
10545
10546 The default is "conn-failure".
10547
Lukas Tribusde160082021-12-08 11:33:01 +010010548 Example:
10549 retry-on 503 504
10550
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010551 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
10552
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010553server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010554 Declare a server in a backend
10555 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10556 no | no | yes | yes
10557 Arguments :
10558 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010559 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010560 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010561
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010562 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
10563 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
10564 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
10565 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010566 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
10567 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010568 intercepted and HAProxy must forward to the original destination
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010569 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
10570 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010571 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
10572 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
10573 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
10574 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
10575 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10576 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10577 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010578 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +020010579 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
10580 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
10581 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
10582 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
10583 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
10584 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010585 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10586 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010010587 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
10588 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010589
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010590 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010591 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
10592 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
10593 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
10594 adding this value to the client's port.
10595
10596 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
10597 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010598 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010599
10600 Examples :
10601 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
10602 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010603 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010604 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
10605 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
10606 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010607
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +020010608 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
10609 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
10610 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
10611 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
10612 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
10613
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010614 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
10615 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010616
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010617server-state-file-name [ { use-backend-name | <file> } ]
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010618 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010619 this backend.
10620 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10621 no | no | yes | yes
10622
10623 It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file" is set to
10624 "local". When <file> is not provided, if "use-backend-name" is used or if
10625 this directive is not set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a
10626 slash '/', then it is considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is
10627 concatenated to the global directive "server-state-base".
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010628
10629 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
10630 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
10631
10632 global
10633 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
10634
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010010635 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010636 load-server-state-from-file
10637
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010638 See also: "server-state-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010639 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010640
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +020010641server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
10642 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
10643 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
10644 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10645 no | no | yes | yes
10646
10647 Arguments:
10648 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
10649
10650 <num | range>
10651 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
10652 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
10653 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
10654 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
10655
10656 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
10657
10658 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
10659
10660 <params*>
10661 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
10662 keyword.
10663
10664 Examples:
10665 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
10666 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
10667 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
10668
10669 # or
10670 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
10671
10672 # would be equivalent to:
10673 server srv1 google.com:80 check
10674 server srv2 google.com:80 check
10675 server srv3 google.com:80 check
10676
10677
10678
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010679source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010680source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010681source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010682 Set the source address for outgoing connections
10683 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10684 yes | no | yes | yes
10685 Arguments :
10686 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
10687 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010688
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010689 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010690 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
10691 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
10692 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
10693 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
10694 supported prefixes are :
10695 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10696 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10697 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010698 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020010699 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10700 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010701
10702 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
10703 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010704 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
10705 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
10706 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010707
10708 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
10709 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
10710 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
10711 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
10712 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
10713 <addr>.
10714
10715 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
10716 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
10717 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
10718 port.
10719
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010720 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
10721 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
10722 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
10723 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +010010724 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010725 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
10726 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
10727 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
10728 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
10729 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
10730 HTTP header.
10731
10732 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
10733 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010734 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010735 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
10736 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10737 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
10738 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
10739 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
10740 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
10741 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
10742
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010743 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
10744 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
10745 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
10746 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
10747 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
10748 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
10749
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010750 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
10751 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
10752 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
10753 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
10754
10755 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
10756 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
10757 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
10758 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
10759 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
10760 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
10761
10762 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
10763 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
10764 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
10765 there are two methods :
10766
10767 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
10768 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
10769 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
10770 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
10771 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
10772 of the client ranges may be used.
10773
10774 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
10775 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
10776 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
10777 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
10778 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
10779 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
10780 same session.
10781
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010782 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
10783 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
10784 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010785 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010786
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +020010787 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
10788
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010789 Examples :
10790 backend private
10791 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
10792 source 192.168.1.200
10793
10794 backend transparent_ssl1
10795 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
10796 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10797
10798 backend transparent_ssl2
10799 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
10800 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
10801 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
10802
10803 backend transparent_ssl3
10804 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
10805 # is more conntrack-friendly.
10806 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10807
10808 backend transparent_smtp
10809 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
10810 # with Tproxy version 4.
10811 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
10812
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010813 backend transparent_http
10814 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
10815 # proxy.
10816 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
10817
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010818 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010819 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
10820
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010821
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010822srvtcpka-cnt <count>
10823 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
10824 the connection on the server side.
10825 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10826 yes | no | yes | yes
10827 Arguments :
10828 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
10829
10830 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
10831 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010832 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10833 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010834
10835 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10836
10837
10838srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
10839 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
10840 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
10841 server side.
10842 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10843 yes | no | yes | yes
10844 Arguments :
10845 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
10846 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
10847 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
10848 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
10849
10850 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
10851 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010852 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10853 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010854
10855 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10856
10857
10858srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
10859 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
10860 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10861 yes | no | yes | yes
10862 Arguments :
10863 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
10864 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
10865 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
10866 document.
10867
10868 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
10869 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010870 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10871 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010872
10873 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
10874
10875
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010876stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
10877 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
10878 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010879 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010880
10881 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
10882 matched.
10883
10884 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
10885 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
10886
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +010010887 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
10888 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
10889 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
10890 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010891
10892 Example :
10893 # statistics admin level only for localhost
10894 backend stats_localhost
10895 stats enable
10896 stats admin if LOCALHOST
10897
10898 Example :
10899 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
10900 backend stats_auth
10901 stats enable
10902 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
10903 stats admin if TRUE
10904
10905 Example :
10906 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
10907 userlist stats-auth
10908 group admin users admin
10909 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
10910 group readonly users haproxy
10911 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
10912
10913 backend stats_auth
10914 stats enable
10915 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
10916 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
10917 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
10918 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
10919
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020010920 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", section 3.4
10921 about userlists and section 7 about ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010922
10923
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010924stats auth <user>:<passwd>
10925 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
10926 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010927 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010928 Arguments :
10929 <user> is a user name to grant access to
10930
10931 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
10932
10933 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
10934 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
10935 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
10936 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
10937 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
10938 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
10939
10940 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
10941 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
10942 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020010943 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010944
10945 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
10946 report using "stats scope".
10947
10948 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10949 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10950 unobvious parameters.
10951
10952 Example :
10953 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10954 backend public_www
10955 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10956 stats enable
10957 stats hide-version
10958 stats scope .
10959 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010960 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010961 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10962 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10963
10964 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10965 backend private_monitoring
10966 stats enable
10967 stats uri /admin?stats
10968 stats refresh 5s
10969
10970 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
10971
10972
10973stats enable
10974 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
10975 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010976 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010977 Arguments : none
10978
10979 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
10980 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
10981 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
10982 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
10983 - stats auth : no authentication
10984 - stats scope : no restriction
10985
10986 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10987 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10988 unobvious parameters.
10989
10990 Example :
10991 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10992 backend public_www
10993 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10994 stats enable
10995 stats hide-version
10996 stats scope .
10997 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010998 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010999 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11000 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11001
11002 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11003 backend private_monitoring
11004 stats enable
11005 stats uri /admin?stats
11006 stats refresh 5s
11007
11008 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
11009
11010
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011011stats hide-version
11012 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020011013 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011014 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011015 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020011016
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011017 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
11018 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
11019 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
11020 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
11021 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
11022 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020011023
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020011024 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11025 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11026 unobvious parameters.
11027
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011028 Example :
11029 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11030 backend public_www
11031 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020011032 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011033 stats hide-version
11034 stats scope .
11035 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011036 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011037 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11038 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020011039
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020011040 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11041 backend private_monitoring
11042 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011043 stats uri /admin?stats
11044 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +010011045
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011046 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020011047
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010011048
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +020011049stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
11050 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
11051 Access control for statistics
11052
11053 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11054 no | no | yes | yes
11055
11056 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
11057 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
11058 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
11059 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
11060 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
11061 should be asked to enter a username and password.
11062
11063 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
11064 instance.
11065
11066 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
11067 about ACL usage.
11068
11069
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011070stats realm <realm>
11071 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
11072 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011073 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011074 Arguments :
11075 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
11076 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
11077 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
11078
11079 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
11080 using a backslash ('\').
11081
11082 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
11083 only related to authentication.
11084
11085 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11086 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11087 unobvious parameters.
11088
11089 Example :
11090 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11091 backend public_www
11092 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11093 stats enable
11094 stats hide-version
11095 stats scope .
11096 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011097 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011098 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11099 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11100
11101 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11102 backend private_monitoring
11103 stats enable
11104 stats uri /admin?stats
11105 stats refresh 5s
11106
11107 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
11108
11109
11110stats refresh <delay>
11111 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
11112 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011113 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011114 Arguments :
11115 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
11116 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
11117 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
11118 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
11119 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
11120 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
11121
11122 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
11123 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
11124 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -050011125 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011126
11127 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11128 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11129 unobvious parameters.
11130
11131 Example :
11132 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11133 backend public_www
11134 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11135 stats enable
11136 stats hide-version
11137 stats scope .
11138 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011139 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011140 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11141 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11142
11143 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11144 backend private_monitoring
11145 stats enable
11146 stats uri /admin?stats
11147 stats refresh 5s
11148
11149 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
11150
11151
11152stats scope { <name> | "." }
11153 Enable statistics and limit access scope
11154 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011155 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011156 Arguments :
11157 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
11158 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
11159 section in which the statement appears.
11160
11161 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
11162 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
11163 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
11164 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
11165 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
11166 exists.
11167
11168 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11169 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11170 unobvious parameters.
11171
11172 Example :
11173 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11174 backend public_www
11175 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11176 stats enable
11177 stats hide-version
11178 stats scope .
11179 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011180 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011181 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11182 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11183
11184 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11185 backend private_monitoring
11186 stats enable
11187 stats uri /admin?stats
11188 stats refresh 5s
11189
11190 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
11191
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011192
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011193stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011194 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
11195 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011196 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011197
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011198 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011199 description from global section is automatically used instead.
11200
11201 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
11202 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
11203
11204 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11205 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011206 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011207
11208 Example :
11209 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11210 backend private_monitoring
11211 stats enable
11212 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
11213 stats uri /admin?stats
11214 stats refresh 5s
11215
11216 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
11217 global section.
11218
11219
11220stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011221 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
11222 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11223 yes | yes | yes | yes
11224 Arguments : none
11225
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011226 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011227 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
11228 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
11229 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
11230 - IP (socket, server)
11231 - cookie (backend, server)
11232
11233 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11234 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011235 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011236
11237 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
11238
11239
Amaury Denoyelle0b70a8a2020-10-05 11:49:45 +020011240stats show-modules
11241 Enable display of extra statistics module on the statistics page
11242 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11243 yes | yes | yes | yes
11244 Arguments : none
11245
11246 New columns are added at the end of the line containing the extra statistics
11247 values as a tooltip.
11248
11249 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11250 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11251 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
11252
11253 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
11254
11255
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011256stats show-node [ <name> ]
11257 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
11258 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011259 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011260 Arguments:
11261 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
11262 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
11263
11264 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
11265 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011266 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011267
11268 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11269 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11270 unobvious parameters.
11271
11272 Example:
11273 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11274 backend private_monitoring
11275 stats enable
11276 stats show-node Europe-1
11277 stats uri /admin?stats
11278 stats refresh 5s
11279
11280 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
11281 section.
11282
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011283
11284stats uri <prefix>
11285 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
11286 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011287 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011288 Arguments :
11289 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
11290 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
11291 query string.
11292
11293 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
11294 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
11295 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
11296 possible to reach it in the application.
11297
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011298 The default URI compiled in HAProxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011299 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011300 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
11301 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
11302 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
11303 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
11304
11305 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
11306 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
11307 an address or a port to statistics only.
11308
11309 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11310 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11311 unobvious parameters.
11312
11313 Example :
11314 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11315 backend public_www
11316 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11317 stats enable
11318 stats hide-version
11319 stats scope .
11320 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011321 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011322 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11323 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11324
11325 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11326 backend private_monitoring
11327 stats enable
11328 stats uri /admin?stats
11329 stats refresh 5s
11330
11331 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
11332
11333
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011334stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
11335 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011336 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011337 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011338
11339 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011340 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011341 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011342 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011343 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
11344
11345 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11346 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11347 the "stick-table" statement.
11348
11349 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
11350 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
11351 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
11352 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
11353 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
11354
11355 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11356 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
11357 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
11358 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
11359 transformation rules.
11360
11361 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11362 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11363 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11364 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11365 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11366 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11367 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11368
11369 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
11370 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
11371 ACL based conditions.
11372
11373 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
11374 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
11375 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
11376 matches can be used as fallbacks.
11377
11378 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
11379 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
11380 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
11381 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
11382
11383 Example :
11384 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
11385 # last 30 minutes
11386 backend pop
11387 mode tcp
11388 balance roundrobin
11389 stick store-request src
11390 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11391 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11392 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11393
11394 backend smtp
11395 mode tcp
11396 balance roundrobin
11397 stick match src table pop
11398 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11399 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11400
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020011401 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and samples
11402 fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011403
11404
11405stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11406 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
11407 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11408 no | no | yes | yes
11409
11410 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
11411 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
11412 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
11413 for writing more maintainable configurations.
11414
11415 Examples :
11416 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010011417 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011418
11419 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
11420 stick match src table pop if !localhost
11421 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
11422
11423
11424 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
11425 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
11426 backend http
11427 mode http
11428 balance roundrobin
11429 stick on src table https
11430 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
11431 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
11432 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
11433
11434 backend https
11435 mode tcp
11436 balance roundrobin
11437 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11438 stick on src
11439 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11440 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11441
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020011442 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011443
11444
11445stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11446 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
11447 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11448 no | no | yes | yes
11449
11450 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011451 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011452 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011453 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011454 server is selected.
11455
11456 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11457 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11458 the "stick-table" statement.
11459
11460 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11461 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11462 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
11463 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
11464 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
11465 address.
11466
11467 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11468 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
11469 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
11470 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
11471 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
11472 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
11473 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
11474 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
11475 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
11476 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
11477
11478 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11479 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11480 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11481 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11482 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11483 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11484 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11485
11486 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
11487 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11488 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
11489 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11490
11491 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
11492 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11493 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11494 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11495 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11496 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011497 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
11498 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11499 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11500 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11501 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11502 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011503
11504 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
11505 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
11506 the request.
11507
11508 Example :
11509 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
11510 # last 30 minutes
11511 backend pop
11512 mode tcp
11513 balance roundrobin
11514 stick store-request src
11515 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11516 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11517 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11518
11519 backend smtp
11520 mode tcp
11521 balance roundrobin
11522 stick match src table pop
11523 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11524 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11525
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020011526 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011527
11528
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011529stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011530 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>] [srvkey <srvkey>]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011531 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080011532 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011533 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011534 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011535
11536 Arguments :
11537 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
11538 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
11539 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11540 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11541
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010011542 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
11543 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
11544 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11545 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11546
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011547 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
11548 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
11549 instance.
11550
11551 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
11552 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
11553 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
11554 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
11555 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
11556 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011557 to 32 characters.
11558
11559 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
11560 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
11561 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011562 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011563 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
11564 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011565
11566 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011567 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
11568 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011569 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
11570 increase.
11571
11572 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011573 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
11574 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
11575 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011576
11577 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011578 is full. When not specified and the table is full when HAProxy
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011579 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
11580 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011581 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011582 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
11583 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
11584 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
11585 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
11586 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
11587 parameter (see below).
11588
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011589 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
11590 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
11591 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
11592 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
11593 soft restart.
11594
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011595 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
11596 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
11597 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
11598 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011599 section 2.5 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011600 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011601 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
11602 if not expiration delay is specified.
11603
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011604 <srvkey> specifies how each server is identified for the purposes of the
11605 stick table. The valid values are "name" and "addr". If "name" is
11606 given, then <name> argument for the server (may be generated by
11607 a template). If "addr" is given, then the server is identified
11608 by its current network address, including the port. "addr" is
11609 especially useful if you are using service discovery to generate
11610 the addresses for servers with peered stick-tables and want
11611 to consistently use the same host across peers for a stickiness
11612 token.
11613
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011614 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
11615 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
11616 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
11617 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011618 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
11619 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
11620 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
11621 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
11622 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
11623 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
11624 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
11625 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
11626 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
11627 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
11628 types and their arguments.
11629
11630 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
11631 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
11632 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
11633 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
11634
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020011635 - gpc(<nb>) : General Purpose Counters Array of <nb> elements. This is an
11636 array of positive 32-bit integers which may be used to count anything.
11637 Most of the time they will be used as a incremental counters on some
11638 entries, for instance to note that a limit is reached and trigger some
11639 actions. This array is limited to a maximum of 100 elements:
11640 gpc0 to gpc99, to ensure that the build of a peer update
11641 message can fit into the buffer. Users should take in consideration
11642 that a large amount of counters will increase the data size and the
11643 traffic load using peers protocol since all data/counters are pushed
11644 each time any of them is updated.
Emeric Brun726783d2021-06-30 19:06:43 +020011645 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_types 'gpc0'
11646 and 'gpc1' on the same table. Using the 'gpc' array data_type, all 'gpc0'
11647 and 'gpc1' related fetches and actions will apply to the two first
11648 elements of this array.
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020011649
11650 - gpc_rate(<nb>,<period>) : Array of increment rates of General Purpose
11651 Counters over a period. Those elements are positive 32-bit integers which
11652 may be used for anything. Just like <gpc>, the count events, but instead
11653 of keeping a cumulative number, they maintain the rate at which the
11654 counter is incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the
11655 frequency of occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific
11656 URL). This array is limited to a maximum of 100 elements: gpc0 to gpc99,
11657 to ensure that the build of a peer update message can fit into the
11658 buffer. Users should take in consideration that a large amount of
11659 counters will increase the data size and the traffic load using peers
11660 protocol since all data/counters are pushed each time any of them is
11661 updated.
Emeric Brun726783d2021-06-30 19:06:43 +020011662 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_types
11663 'gpc0_rate' and 'gpc1_rate' on the same table. Using the 'gpc_rate'
11664 array data_type, all 'gpc0' and 'gpc1' related fetches and actions
11665 will apply to the two first elements of this array.
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020011666
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011667 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11668 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11669 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011670 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011671
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011672 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
11673 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11674 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011675 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011676 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011677 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011678
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011679 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11680 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11681 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11682 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
11683
11684 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
11685 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11686 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
11687 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
11688 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
11689 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
11690
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020011691 - gpt(<nb>) : General Purpose Tags Array of <nb> elements. This is an array
11692 of positive 32-bit integers which may be used for anything.
11693 Most of the time they will be used to put a special tags on some entries,
11694 for instance to note that a specific behavior was detected and must be
11695 known for future matches. This array is limited to a maximum of 100
11696 elements: gpt0 to gpt99, to ensure that the build of a peer update
11697 message can fit into the buffer. Users should take in consideration
11698 that a large amount of counters will increase the data size and the
11699 traffic load using peers protocol since all data/counters are pushed
11700 each time any of them is updated.
Emeric Brunf7ab0bf2021-06-30 18:58:22 +020011701 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_type 'gpt0'
11702 on the same table. Using the 'gpt' array data_type, all 'gpt0' related
11703 fetches and actions will apply to the first element of this array.
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020011704
Emeric Brun1a6b7252021-07-01 18:34:48 +020011705 - gpt0 : first General Purpose Tag. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11706 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11707 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11708 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches
11709
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011710 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11711 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
11712 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
11713 they were received.
11714
11715 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11716 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
11717 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
11718 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
11719 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
11720
11721 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11722 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11723 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11724 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
11725 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11726
11727 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11728 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
11729 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
11730
11731 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11732 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11733 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11734 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
11735 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11736
11737 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11738 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
11739 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
11740 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
11741 the client side.
11742
11743 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11744 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11745 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11746 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
11747 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
11748 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
11749 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
11750
11751 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11752 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
11753 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11754 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
11755 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
11756 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011757 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011758
11759 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11760 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11761 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11762 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11763 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
11764 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11765
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010011766 - http_fail_cnt : HTTP Failure Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11767 counts the absolute number of HTTP response failures induced by servers
11768 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11769 responses, as well as any 5xx response other than 501 or 505. It aims at
11770 being used combined with path or URI to detect service failures.
11771
11772 - http_fail_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11773 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11774 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11775 HTTP response failure rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11776 http_fail_cnt above for what is accounted as a failure). The result is an
11777 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11778
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011779 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011780 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011781 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
11782 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
11783
11784 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11785 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11786 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11787 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11788 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11789 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
11790 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
11791 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
11792 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
11793 recommended for better fairness.
11794
11795 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011796 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011797 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
11798 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
11799
11800 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11801 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11802 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11803 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11804 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11805 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
11806 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
11807 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
11808 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
11809 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011810
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011811 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
11812 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011813 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
11814 reference it.
11815
11816 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
11817 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010011818 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
11819 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
11820 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011821
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011822 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
11823 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
11824 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
11825 something that can be ignored.
11826
11827 Example:
11828 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
11829 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
11830 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
11831 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
11832
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011833 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.5
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010011834 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011835
11836
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011837stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010011838 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011839 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11840 no | no | yes | yes
11841
11842 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011843 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011844 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011845 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011846 server is selected.
11847
11848 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11849 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11850 the "stick-table" statement.
11851
11852 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11853 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11854 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
11855 when the response is a SSL server hello.
11856
11857 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11858 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
11859 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
11860 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
11861 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
11862 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011863 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011864 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
11865 rules.
11866
11867 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11868 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11869 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11870 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11871 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11872 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11873 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11874
11875 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
11876 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11877 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
11878 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11879
11880 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
11881 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11882 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11883 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11884 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11885 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011886 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
11887 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11888 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11889 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11890 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11891 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
11892 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
11893 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
11894 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011895
11896 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
11897
11898 Example :
11899 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
11900 backend https
11901 mode tcp
11902 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011903 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011904 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011905
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010011906 acl clienthello req.ssl_hello_type 1
11907 acl serverhello rep.ssl_hello_type 2
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011908
11909 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
11910 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11911 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
11912
11913 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
11914 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011915
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011916 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
11917 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
11918 # at offset 44.
11919
11920 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010011921 stick on req.payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011922
11923 # Learn on response if server hello.
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010011924 stick store-response resp.payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011925
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011926 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11927 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11928
11929 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
11930 extraction.
11931
11932
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011933tcp-check comment <string>
11934 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
11935 it fails.
11936 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11937 yes | no | yes | yes
11938
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011939 Arguments :
11940 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
11941 rule fails.
11942
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011943 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
11944 user-friendly error reporting.
11945
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011946 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
11947 "tcp-check expect".
11948
11949
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011950tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
11951 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011952 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011953 Opens a new connection
11954 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011955 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011956
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011957 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011958 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11959
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011960 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040011961 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011962
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011963 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011964 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
11965 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011966 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011967
11968 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011969
11970 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
11971
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020011972 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
11973
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011974 ssl opens a ciphered connection
11975
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020011976 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
11977
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020011978 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
11979 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
11980 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11981 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11982
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011983 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
11984 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
11985 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
11986 haproxy -vv.
11987
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011988 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011989
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011990 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
11991 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
11992 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
11993
11994 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
11995 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
11996 of the sequence.
11997
11998 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
11999 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
12000 do.
12001
12002 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
12003 unset-var or comment rules.
12004
12005 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012006 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
12007 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
12008 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
12009 option tcp-check
12010 tcp-check connect
12011 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
12012 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
12013 tcp-check send \r\n
12014 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
12015 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
12016 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
12017 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
12018 tcp-check send \r\n
12019 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
12020 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
12021
12022 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
12023 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010012024 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012025 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
12026 tcp-check connect port 143
12027 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
12028 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
12029
12030 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
12031
12032
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012033tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020012034 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020012035 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020012036 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012037 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012038 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012039 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012040
12041 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012042 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
12043
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010012044 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
12045 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
12046 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
12047 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
12048 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
12049 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
12050 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
12051 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
12052 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
12053 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
12054
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012055 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010012056 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
12057 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012058 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
12059 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
12060 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
12061
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020012062 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
12063 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
12064 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020012065 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
12066 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010012067 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
12068 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020012069 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
12070 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020012071 By default "L7OK" is used.
12072
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020012073 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
12074 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010012075 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
12076 supported :
12077 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
12078 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020012079 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
12080 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
12081 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
12082 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
12083 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020012084
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020012085 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020012086 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020012087 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
12088 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
12089 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
12090 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020012091 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
12092
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020012093 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
12094 informational message reported in logs if the expect
12095 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
12096 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
12097
12098 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
12099 informational message reported in logs if an error
12100 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
12101 log-format string.
12102
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020012103 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
12104 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
12105 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12106 followed by some converters.
12107
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012108 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
12109 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
12110 with the usual backslash ('\').
12111 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012112 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012113 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
12114 used upper or lower case.
12115
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012116 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
12117
12118 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
12119 A health check response will be considered valid if the
12120 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
12121 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
12122 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
12123 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
12124 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
12125 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
12126
12127 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
12128 A health check response will be considered valid if the
12129 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
12130 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
12131 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
12132 expression.
12133
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020012134 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
12135 A health check response will be considered valid if the
12136 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
12137 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
12138 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
12139 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
12140
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012141 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
12142 in the response buffer. A health check response will
12143 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
12144 this exact hexadecimal string.
12145 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
12146
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010012147 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
12148 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
12149 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
12150 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
12151 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
12152 size of the original response. As such, the expected
12153 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
12154 size.
12155
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020012156 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
12157 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
12158 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
12159 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
12160 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
12161 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
12162 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
12163 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
12164 in a binary string before matching the response's
12165 buffer.
12166
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012167 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010012168 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012169 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
12170 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
12171 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
12172 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
12173 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
12174 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
12175 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
12176 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
12177 the null character.
12178
12179 Examples :
12180 # perform a POP check
12181 option tcp-check
12182 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
12183
12184 # perform an IMAP check
12185 option tcp-check
12186 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
12187
12188 # look for the redis master server
12189 option tcp-check
12190 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020012191 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012192 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
12193 tcp-check expect string role:master
12194 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
12195 tcp-check expect string +OK
12196
12197
12198 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010012199 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012200
12201
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020012202tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
12203tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
12204 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
12205 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012206 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012207 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012208
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012209 Arguments :
12210 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
12211
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020012212 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
12213 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020012214
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020012215 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
12216 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012217
12218 Examples :
12219 # look for the redis master server
12220 option tcp-check
12221 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
12222 tcp-check expect string role:master
12223
12224 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010012225 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012226
12227
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020012228tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
12229tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
12230 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
12231 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012232 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012233 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012234
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012235 Arguments :
12236 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012237
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020012238 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
12239 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020012240
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020012241 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
12242 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
12243 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012244
12245 Examples :
12246 # redis check in binary
12247 option tcp-check
12248 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
12249 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
12250
12251
12252 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010012253 "tcp-check send", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012254
12255
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012256tcp-check set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
12257tcp-check set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012258 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012259 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012260 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012261
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012262 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012263 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
12264 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
12265 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
12266 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
12267 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
12268 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
12269 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
12270 and '-'.
12271
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012272 <cond> A set of conditions that must all be true for the variable to
12273 actually be set (such as "ifnotempty", "ifgt" ...). See the
Ilya Shipitsin5e87bcf2021-12-25 11:45:52 +050012274 set-var converter's description for a full list of possible
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012275 conditions.
12276
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012277 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
12278
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020012279 <fmt> This is the value expressed using log-format rules (see Custom
12280 Log Format in section 8.2.4).
12281
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012282 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012283 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020012284 tcp-check set-var-fmt(check.name) "%H"
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012285
12286
12287tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012288 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012289 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012290 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012291
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012292 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012293 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
12294 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
12295 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
12296 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
12297 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
12298 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
12299 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
12300 and '-'.
12301
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012302 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012303 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
12304
12305
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012306tcp-request connection <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012307 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020012308 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020012309 yes(!) | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012310 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012311 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12312 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020012313
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012314 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012315
12316 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
12317 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012318 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
12319 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
12320 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
12321 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
12322 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
12323 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012324
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012325 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12326 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12327 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012328 rules which may be inserted. Any rule may optionally be followed by an
12329 ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition
12330 is true.
12331
12332 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
12333 supported:
12334 - accept
12335 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4
12336 - expect-proxy layer4
12337 - reject
12338 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
12339 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
12340 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
12341 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12342 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12343 - set-dst <expr>
12344 - set-dst-port <expr>
12345 - set-mark <mark>
12346 - set-src <expr>
12347 - set-src-port <expr>
12348 - set-tos <tos>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012349 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
12350 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012351 - silent-drop
12352 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
12353 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
12354 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
Jaroslaw Rzeszótkoc8637032021-11-02 16:56:05 +010012355 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012356
12357 The supported actions are described below.
12358
12359 There is no limit to the number of "tcp-request connection" statements per
12360 instance.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012361
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020012362 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
12363 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
12364 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
12365 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
12366 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
12367 a defaults section defining such rules.
12368
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012369 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12370 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12371 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012372
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012373 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12374 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
12375 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012376
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012377 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12378 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
12379 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012380
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012381 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
12382 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12383 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012384
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012385 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12386 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12387 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012388
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012389 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012390
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012391 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012392
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012393 See section 7 about ACL usage.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012394
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012395 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012396
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012397tcp-request connection accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012398
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012399 This is used to accept the connection. No further "tcp-request connection"
12400 rules are evaluated.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012401
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012402tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip layer4
12403 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012404
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012405 This configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client IP
12406 insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket. This is
12407 equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the "bind" line,
12408 except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only
12409 for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple
12410 layers of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
12411 hosts.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012412
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012413tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012414
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012415 This configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
12416 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to having
12417 the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule
12418 allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges
12419 using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are
12420 passed through by traffic coming from public hosts.
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012421
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012422tcp-request connection reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012423
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012424 This is used to reject the connection. No further "tcp-request connection"
12425 rules are evaluated. Rejected connections do not even become a session, which
12426 is why they are accounted separately for in the stats, as "denied
12427 connections". They are not considered for the session rate-limit and are not
12428 logged either. The reason is that these rules should only be used to filter
12429 extremely high connection rates such as the ones encountered during a massive
12430 DDoS attack. Under these extreme conditions, the simple action of logging
12431 each event would make the system collapse and would considerably lower the
12432 filtering capacity. If logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request
12433 content" rules should be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will
12434 not log either.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012435
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012436tcp-request connection sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12437tcp-request connection sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12438tcp-request connection sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012439
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012440 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
12441 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
12442 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
12443 description.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012444
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012445tcp-request connection sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12446 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12447tcp-request connection sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12448 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012449
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012450 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
12451 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
12452 sc-inc-gpt" and "http-request sc-inc-gpt0" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012453
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012454tcp-request connection set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12455tcp-request connection set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012456
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012457 These actions are used to set the destination IP/Port address to the value of
12458 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-dst" and
12459 "http-request set-dst-port" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012460
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012461tcp-request connection set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012462
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012463 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
12464 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
12465 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012466
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012467tcp-request connection set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12468tcp-request connection set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012469
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012470 These actions are used to set the source IP/Port address to the value of
12471 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-src" and
12472 "http-request set-src-port" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012473
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012474tcp-request connection set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012475
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012476 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
12477 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
12478 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012479
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012480tcp-request connection set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12481tcp-request connection set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Jaroslaw Rzeszótkoc8637032021-11-02 16:56:05 +010012482
12483 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
12484 inline. "tcp-request connection" can set variables in the "proc" and "sess"
12485 scopes. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
12486 for a complete description.
12487
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012488tcp-request connection silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012489
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012490 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
12491 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
12492 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
12493 complete description.
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012494
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012495tcp-request connection track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12496tcp-request connection track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12497tcp-request connection track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012498
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012499 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
12500 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
12501 track-sc2" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012502
Jaroslaw Rzeszótkoc8637032021-11-02 16:56:05 +010012503tcp-request connection unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12504
12505 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
12506 details about variables.
12507
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012508
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012509tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12510 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012511 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020012512 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012513 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012514 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12515 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012516
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012517 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012518
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012519 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012520 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12521 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012522 "accept", a "reject" or a "switch-mode" rule matches, or the TCP request
12523 inspection delay expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012524
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012525 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
12526 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
12527 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
12528 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012529 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012530 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so HAProxy keeps a record of
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012531 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
12532 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
12533 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
12534 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012535 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012536 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012537
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012538 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12539 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12540 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12541 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012542
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012543 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
12544 supported:
12545 - accept
12546 - capture <sample> len <length>
12547 - do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
12548 - reject
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012549 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012550 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012551 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020012552 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012553 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012554 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012555 - set-dst <expr>
12556 - set-dst-port <expr>
Christopher Faulet551a6412021-06-25 14:35:29 +020012557 - set-log-level <level>
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012558 - set-mark <mark>
Christopher Faulet1da374a2021-06-25 14:46:02 +020012559 - set-nice <nice>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012560 - set-priority-class <expr>
12561 - set-priority-offset <expr>
Christopher Faulet1e83b702021-06-23 12:07:21 +020012562 - set-src <expr>
12563 - set-src-port <expr>
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012564 - set-tos <tos>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012565 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
12566 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012567 - silent-drop
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012568 - switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012569 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
12570 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
12571 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012572 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012573 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012574
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012575 The supported actions are described below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012576
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012577 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
12578 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
12579 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
12580 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
12581 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
12582 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012583
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012584 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
12585 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
12586 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
12587 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
12588 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
12589 a defaults section defining such rules.
12590
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012591 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012592 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12593 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012594
Christopher Faulet2079a4a2020-10-02 11:48:57 +020012595 Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
12596 information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
12597 frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
12598 lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
12599 level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
12600 prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
12601
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012602 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet7ea509e2020-10-02 11:38:46 +020012603 rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
12604 preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
12605 data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
12606 ACL does not match. The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
12607 as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
12608 differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
12609 HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
12610 first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
12611 connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
12612 "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012613
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012614 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012615 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
12616 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
12617 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012618
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012619 Example:
12620 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
12621
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012622 Example:
12623
12624 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020012625 tcp-request content set-var-fmt(sess.from) %[src]:%[src_port]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012626 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012627
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012628 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012629 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012630 # and reject everything else. (Only works for HTTP/1 connections)
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012631 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12632 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020012633 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012634 tcp-request content reject
12635
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012636 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
12637 # and reject everything else. (works for HTTP/1 and HTTP/2 connections)
12638 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12639 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12640 tcp-request switch-mode http if HTTP
12641 tcp-request reject # non-HTTP traffic is implicit here
12642 ...
12643 http-request reject unless is_host_com
12644
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012645 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012646 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
12647 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012648 acl content_present req.len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012649 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012650
12651 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
12652 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012653 acl content_present req.len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012654 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012655 tcp-request content reject
12656
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012657 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012658 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012659 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012660 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012661 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
12662 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012663
12664 Example:
12665 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
12666 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012667 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012668
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012669 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012670 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012671
12672 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012673 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012674 # protecting all our sites
12675 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012676 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12677 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012678 ...
12679 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
12680
12681 backend http_dynamic
12682 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012683 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012684 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012685 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012686 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012687 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012688 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012689
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012690 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012691
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030012692 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
12693 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012694
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012695tcp-request content accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12696
12697 This is used to accept the connection. No further "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet27025602021-11-09 17:58:12 +010012698 rules are evaluated for the current section.
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012699
12700tcp-request content capture <sample> len <length>
12701 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12702
12703 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
12704 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
12705 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
12706 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
12707 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
12708 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
12709 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life. Please
12710 check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for more
12711 information.
12712
12713tcp-request content do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
12714
12715 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores the
12716 result in the variable <var>. Please refer to "http-request do-resolve" for a
12717 complete description.
12718
12719tcp-request content reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12720
12721 This is used to reject the connection. No further "tcp-request content" rules
12722 are evaluated.
12723
12724tcp-request content sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12725tcp-request content sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12726tcp-request content sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12727
12728 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
12729 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
12730 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
12731 description.
12732
12733tcp-request content sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12734 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12735tcp-request content sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12736 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12737
12738 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
12739 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
12740 sc-inc-gpt" and "http-request sc-inc-gpt0" for a complete description.
12741
12742tcp-request content send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
12743 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12744
12745 Thaction is is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. Please
12746 refer to "http-request send-spoe-group" for a complete description.
12747
12748tcp-request content set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12749tcp-request content set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12750
12751 These actions are used to set the destination IP/Port address to the value of
12752 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-dst" and
12753 "http-request set-dst-port" for a complete description.
12754
12755tcp-request content set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12756
12757 This action is used to set the log level of the current session. Please refer
12758 to "http-request set-log-level". for a complete description.
12759
12760tcp-request content set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12761
12762 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
12763 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
12764 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
12765
12766tcp-request content set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12767
12768 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. Please
12769 refer to "http-request set-nice" for a complete description.
12770
12771tcp-request content set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12772
12773 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request. Please
12774 refer to "http-request set-priority-class" for a complete description.
12775
12776tcp-request content set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12777
12778 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
12779 request. Please refer to "http-request set-priority-offset" for a complete
12780 description.
12781
Christopher Faulet1e83b702021-06-23 12:07:21 +020012782tcp-request content set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12783tcp-request content set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12784
12785 These actions are used to set the source IP/Port address to the value of
12786 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-src" and
12787 "http-request set-src-port" for a complete description.
12788
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012789tcp-request content set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12790
12791 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
12792 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
12793 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
12794
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012795tcp-request content set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12796tcp-request content set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012797
12798 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
12799 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
12800 for a complete description.
12801
12802tcp-request content silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12803
12804 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
12805 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
12806 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
12807 complete description.
12808
12809tcp-request content switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
12810 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12811
12812 This action is used to perform a connection upgrade. Only HTTP upgrades are
12813 supported for now. The protocol may optionally be specified. This action is
12814 only available for a proxy with the frontend capability. The connection
12815 upgrade is immediately performed, following "tcp-request content" rules are
12816 not evaluated. This upgrade method should be preferred to the implicit one
12817 consisting to rely on the backend mode. When used, it is possible to set HTTP
12818 directives in a frontend without any warning. These directives will be
12819 conditionally evaluated if the HTTP upgrade is performed. However, an HTTP
12820 backend must still be selected. It remains unsupported to route an HTTP
12821 connection (upgraded or not) to a TCP server.
12822
12823 See section 4 about Proxies for more details on HTTP upgrades.
12824
12825tcp-request content track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12826tcp-request content track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12827tcp-request content track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12828
12829 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
12830 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
12831 track-sc2" for a complete description.
12832
12833tcp-request content unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12834
12835 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
12836 details about variables.
12837
Aleksandar Lazic332258a2022-03-30 00:11:40 +020012838tcp-request content use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012839
12840 This action is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the request
12841 and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to reply by
12842 sending any valid response or it may immediately close the connection without
12843 sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible to write your own
12844 services in Lua. No further "tcp-request content" rules are evaluated.
12845
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012846
12847tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
12848 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
12849 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020012850 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012851 Arguments :
12852 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12853 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12854 as explained at the top of this document.
12855
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012856 People using HAProxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012857 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
12858 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
12859 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
12860 data for at most the specified amount of time.
12861
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012862 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
12863 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
12864 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
12865 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
12866
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012867 Note that when performing content inspection, HAProxy will evaluate the whole
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012868 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012869 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012870 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012871 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, HAProxy will not wait at all
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010012872 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
12873 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
12874 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012875
12876 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
12877 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
12878 it pass through unaffected.
12879
12880 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
12881 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
12882 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012883 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012884 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
12885 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020012886 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
12887 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
12888 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012889
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020012890 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
12891 ones. Proxies inherit this value from their defaults section.
12892
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012893 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012894 "timeout client".
12895
12896
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020012897tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12898 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
12899 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020012900 yes(!) | yes | yes | no
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020012901 Arguments :
12902 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12903 below.
12904
12905 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12906
12907 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
12908 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
12909 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
12910 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
Anubhave09efaa2021-10-14 22:28:25 +053012911 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case is to copy some
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020012912 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
12913 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
12914 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
12915 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
12916 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
12917 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
12918 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
12919 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
12920 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
12921 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
12922 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
12923 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
12924 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
12925 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
12926 instead.
12927
12928 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12929 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12930 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
12931 rules which may be inserted.
12932
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012933 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
12934 supported:
12935 - accept
12936 - reject
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020012937 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
12938 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
12939 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
12940 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12941 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020012942 - set-dst <expr>
12943 - set-dst-port <expr>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012944 - set-mark <mark>
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020012945 - set-src <expr>
12946 - set-src-port <expr>
12947 - set-tos <tos>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012948 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
12949 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020012950 - silent-drop
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012951 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
12952 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
12953 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
12954 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020012955
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012956 The supported actions are described below.
12957
12958 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
12959 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
12960 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
12961 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
12962 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
12963 a defaults section defining such rules.
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020012964
12965 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12966 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12967 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
12968
12969 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
12970 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
12971 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
12972 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
12973 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
12974
12975 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12976 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12977
12978 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12979 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
12980 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
12981
12982 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12983 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
12984 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12985
12986 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
12987 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12988 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
12989
12990 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12991 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12992 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
12993
12994 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12995
12996 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
12997
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012998tcp-request session accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12999
13000 This is used to accept the connection. No further "tcp-request session"
13001 rules are evaluated.
13002
13003tcp-request session reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13004
13005 This is used to reject the connection. No further "tcp-request session" rules
13006 are evaluated.
13007
13008tcp-request session sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13009tcp-request session sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13010tcp-request session sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13011
13012 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
13013 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
13014 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
13015 description.
13016
13017tcp-request session sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13018 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13019tcp-request session sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13020 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13021
13022 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
13023 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "tcp-request connection
13024 sc-inc-gpt" and "tcp-request connection sc-inc-gpt0" for a complete
13025 description.
13026
13027tcp-request session set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13028tcp-request session set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13029
13030 These actions are used to set the destination IP/Port address to the value of
13031 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-dst" and
13032 "http-request set-dst-port" for a complete description.
13033
13034tcp-request session set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13035
13036 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
13037 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
13038 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
13039
13040tcp-request session set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13041tcp-request session set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13042
13043 These actions are used to set the source IP/Port address to the value of
13044 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-src" and
13045 "http-request set-src-port" for a complete description.
13046
13047tcp-request session set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13048
13049 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
13050 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
13051 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
13052
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010013053tcp-request session set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13054tcp-request session set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013055
13056 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
13057 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
13058 for a complete description.
13059
13060tcp-request session silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13061
13062 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
13063 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
13064 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
13065 complete description.
13066
13067tcp-request session track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13068tcp-request session track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13069tcp-request session track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13070
13071 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
13072 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
13073 track-sc2" for a complete description.
13074
13075tcp-request session unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13076
13077 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
13078 details about variables.
13079
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013080
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013081tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
13082 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
13083 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013084 yes(!) | no | yes | yes
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013085 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020013086 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
13087 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013088
13089 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
13090
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013091 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013092 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
13093 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020013094 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
13095 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013096
13097 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
13098
13099 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
13100 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
13101 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
13102 inserted.
13103
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013104 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
13105 supported:
13106 - accept
13107 - close
13108 - reject
13109 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
13110 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
13111 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
13112 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13113 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13114 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
13115 - set-log-level <level>
13116 - set-mark <mark>
13117 - set-nice <nice>
13118 - set-tos <tos>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010013119 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
13120 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013121 - silent-drop
13122 - unset-var(<var-name>)
13123
13124 The supported actions are described below.
13125
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013126 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
13127 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
13128 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
13129 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
13130 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
13131 a defaults section defining such rules.
13132
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013133 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
13134 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
13135 for changing the default action to a reject.
13136
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013137 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013138
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013139 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
13140 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
13141 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
13142 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
13143 period.
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020013144
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013145 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013146
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013147 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
Christopher Faulet551a6412021-06-25 14:35:29 +020013148
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013149tcp-response content accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020013150
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013151 This is used to accept the response. No further "tcp-response content" rules
13152 are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet1da374a2021-06-25 14:46:02 +020013153
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013154tcp-response content close [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020013155
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013156 This is used to immediately closes the connection with the server. No further
13157 "tcp-response content" rules are evaluated. The main purpose of this action
13158 is to force a connection to be finished between a client and a server after
13159 an exchange when the application protocol expects some long time outs to
13160 elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle connections which take
13161 significant resources on servers with certain protocols.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013162
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013163tcp-response content reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020013164
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013165 This is used to reject the response. No further "tcp-response content" rules
13166 are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013167
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013168tcp-response content sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13169tcp-response content sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13170tcp-response content sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020013171
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013172 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
13173 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
13174 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
13175 description.
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020013176
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013177tcp-response content sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13178 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13179tcp-resposne content sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13180 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010013181
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013182 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
13183 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
13184 sc-inc-gpt" and "http-request sc-inc-gpt0" for a complete description.
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020013185
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013186tcp-response content send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
13187 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013188
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013189 Thaction is is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. Please
13190 refer to "http-request send-spoe-group" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020013191
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013192tcp-response content set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020013193
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013194 This action is used to set the log level of the current session. Please refer
13195 to "http-request set-log-level". for a complete description.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013196
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013197tcp-response content set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013198
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013199 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
13200 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
13201 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013202
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013203tcp-response content set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013204
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013205 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. Please
13206 refer to "http-request set-nice" for a complete description.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013207
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013208tcp-response content set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020013209
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013210 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
13211 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
13212 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013213
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010013214tcp-response content set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13215tcp-response content set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020013216
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013217 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
13218 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
13219 for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020013220
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013221tcp-response content silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020013222
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013223 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
13224 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
13225 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
13226 complete description.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013227
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013228tcp-response content unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013229
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013230 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
13231 details about variables.
13232
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013233
13234tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
13235 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
13236 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013237 yes(!) | no | yes | yes
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013238 Arguments :
13239 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13240 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13241 as explained at the top of this document.
13242
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013243 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
13244 ones. Proxies inherit this value from their defaults section.
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013245
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013246 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
13247
13248
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013249timeout check <timeout>
13250 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
13251 established.
13252
13253 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13254 yes | no | yes | yes
13255 Arguments:
13256 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13257 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13258 as explained at the top of this document.
13259
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013260 If set, HAProxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013261 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013262 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013263 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010013264 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
13265 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
13266 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013267
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013268 If "timeout check" is not set HAProxy uses "inter" for complete check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013269 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
13270
13271 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
13272 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010013273 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013274
13275 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13276 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13277 forget about it.
13278
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013279 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
13280 ones. Proxies inherit this value from their defaults section.
13281
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010013282 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
13283 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013284
13285
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013286timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013287 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
13288 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13289 yes | yes | yes | no
13290 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013291 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013292 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13293 as explained at the top of this document.
13294
13295 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
13296 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
13297 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010013298 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
13299 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
13300 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
13301 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013302 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
13303 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
13304 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013305 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013306 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013307 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
13308 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013309 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
13310 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013311
13312 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
13313 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13314 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
13315 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013316 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013317 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
13318
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013319 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013320
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013321
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013322timeout client-fin <timeout>
13323 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
13324 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13325 yes | yes | yes | no
13326 Arguments :
13327 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13328 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13329 as explained at the top of this document.
13330
13331 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
13332 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
13333 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
13334 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
13335 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
13336 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
13337 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010013338 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
13339 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
13340 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013341
13342 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
13343 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
13344 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
13345
13346 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
13347
13348
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013349timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013350 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
13351 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13352 yes | no | yes | yes
13353 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013354 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013355 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13356 as explained at the top of this document.
13357
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013358 If the server is located on the same LAN as HAProxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013359 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013360 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013361 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013362 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
13363 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013364
13365 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13366 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13367 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
13368 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013369 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013370 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
13371
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013372 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013373
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013374
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010013375timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
13376 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
13377 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13378 yes | yes | yes | yes
13379 Arguments :
13380 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13381 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13382 as explained at the top of this document.
13383
13384 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
13385 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
13386 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
13387 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
13388 once the request has started to present itself.
13389
13390 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
13391 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
13392 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
13393 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
13394 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
13395
13396 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
13397 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
13398 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
13399 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
13400
13401 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
13402 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013403 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010013404 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
13405 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020013406 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010013407
13408 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
13409 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
13410 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
13411 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
13412
13413 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
13414
13415
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013416timeout http-request <timeout>
13417 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
13418 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020013419 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013420 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013421 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013422 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13423 as explained at the top of this document.
13424
13425 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
13426 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
13427 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
13428 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
13429 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
13430 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
13431 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020013432 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
13433 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
13434 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
13435 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013436 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020013437 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
13438 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013439
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010013440 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
13441 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
13442 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
13443 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
13444 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010013445 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013446
13447 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
13448 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013449 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013450 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
13451 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
13452
13453 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020013454 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
13455 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
13456 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013457
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020013458 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010013459 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013460
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013461
13462timeout queue <timeout>
13463 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
13464 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13465 yes | no | yes | yes
13466 Arguments :
13467 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13468 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13469 as explained at the top of this document.
13470
13471 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
13472 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
13473 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
13474 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
13475 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
13476
13477 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
13478 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
13479 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
13480 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
13481
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013482 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013483
13484
13485timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013486 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
13487 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13488 yes | no | yes | yes
13489 Arguments :
13490 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13491 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13492 as explained at the top of this document.
13493
13494 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
13495 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
13496 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
13497 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
13498 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
13499 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
13500 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
13501
13502 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13503 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13504 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
13505 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
13506 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013507 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013508 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013509 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
13510 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013511 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
13512 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013513
13514 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13515 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13516 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
13517 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013518 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013519 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
13520
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013521 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013522
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013523
13524timeout server-fin <timeout>
13525 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
13526 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13527 yes | no | yes | yes
13528 Arguments :
13529 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13530 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13531 as explained at the top of this document.
13532
13533 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
13534 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
13535 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
13536 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
13537 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
13538 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
13539 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
13540 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
13541 situations, it should not be needed.
13542
13543 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13544 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
13545 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
13546
13547 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
13548
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013549
13550timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010013551 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013552 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13553 yes | yes | yes | yes
13554 Arguments :
13555 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
13556 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13557 as explained at the top of this document.
13558
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020013559 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
13560 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
13561 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013562
13563 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13564 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13565 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
13566 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010013567 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013568
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013569 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013570
13571
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013572timeout tunnel <timeout>
13573 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
13574 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13575 yes | no | yes | yes
13576 Arguments :
13577 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13578 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13579 as explained at the top of this document.
13580
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013581 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013582 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
13583 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
13584 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013585 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
13586 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013587 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
13588 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
13589 specified.
13590
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013591 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
13592 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
13593 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
13594 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
13595 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
13596 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
13597 state.
13598
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013599 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13600 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13601 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
13602 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013603 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013604
13605 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13606 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13607 forget about it.
13608
13609 Example :
13610 defaults http
13611 option http-server-close
13612 timeout connect 5s
13613 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013614 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013615 timeout server 30s
13616 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
13617
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013618 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013619
13620
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013621transparent (deprecated)
13622 Enable client-side transparent proxying
13623 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010013624 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013625 Arguments : none
13626
13627 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
13628 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
13629 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
13630 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
13631 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
13632 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
13633 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
13634 appropriate server.
13635
13636 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
13637
13638 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
13639 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
13640
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013641 See also: "option transparent"
13642
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013643unique-id-format <string>
13644 Generate a unique ID for each request.
13645 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13646 yes | yes | yes | no
13647 Arguments :
13648 <string> is a log-format string.
13649
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013650 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
13651 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
13652 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
13653 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013654
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013655 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013656 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple HAProxy instances
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013657 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
13658 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
13659 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
13660 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
13661 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
13662 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013663
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013664 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
13665 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013666
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013667 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013668
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013669 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013670
13671 will generate:
13672
13673 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13674
13675 See also: "unique-id-header"
13676
13677unique-id-header <name>
13678 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
13679 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13680 yes | yes | yes | no
13681 Arguments :
13682 <name> is the name of the header.
13683
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013684 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
13685 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013686
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013687 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013688
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013689 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013690 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
13691
13692 will generate:
13693
13694 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13695
13696 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013697
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013698use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013699 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013700 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13701 no | yes | yes | no
13702 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013703 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
13704 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013705
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013706 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
13707 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013708
13709 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
13710 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
13711 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013712 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013713 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013714 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
13715 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013716
13717 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
13718 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
13719 assign the backend.
13720
13721 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
13722 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13723 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
13724 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
13725 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
13726 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
13727
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013728 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013729 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013730 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
13731 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
13732 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
13733
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013734 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
13735 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
13736 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
13737 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
13738 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
13739 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
13740 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
13741 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
13742 cannot be forced from the request.
13743
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013744 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013745 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
13746 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
13747
13748 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
13749 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013750
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020013751use-fcgi-app <name>
13752 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
13753 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13754 no | no | yes | yes
13755 Arguments :
13756 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
13757
13758 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013759
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013760use-server <server> if <condition>
13761use-server <server> unless <condition>
13762 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
13763 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13764 no | no | yes | yes
13765 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013766 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
13767 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013768
13769 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
13770
13771 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
13772 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
13773 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
13774
13775 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
13776 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
13777 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
13778 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
13779 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
13780 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
13781 matches will assign the server.
13782
13783 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
13784 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
13785 with the next rules until one matches.
13786
13787 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
13788 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13789 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
13790 according to other persistence mechanisms.
13791
13792 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
13793 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
13794 stripped.
13795
13796 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
13797 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013798 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013799 implicit TLS (also see "req.ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013800 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013801
13802 Example :
13803 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013804 use-server www if { req.ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013805 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013806 use-server mail if { req.ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013807 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013808 use-server imap if { req.ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000013809 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013810 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
13811 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
13812
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013813 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
13814 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
13815 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
13816 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050013817 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013818 and we fall back to load balancing.
13819
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013820 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013821
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013822
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100138235. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013824--------------------------
13825
13826The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
13827depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
13828settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
13829written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
13830described in this section.
13831
13832
138335.1. Bind options
13834-----------------
13835
13836The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
13837as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
13838no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
13839parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
13840while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
13841provided immediately after the setting name.
13842
13843The currently supported settings are the following ones.
13844
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013845accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
13846 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
13847 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
13848 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
13849 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
13850 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
13851 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
13852 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
13853 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
13854 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010013855 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
13856 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
13857 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013858
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013859accept-proxy
13860 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020013861 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
13862 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013863 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
13864 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
13865 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
13866 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013867 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013868 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
13869 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020013870 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
13871 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013872
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013873allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010013874 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013875 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013876 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013877 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
13878 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013879
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013880alpn <protocols>
13881 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
13882 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
13883 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013884 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013885 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013886 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
13887 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
13888 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
13889 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
13890 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
13891 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
13892 preference, like below :
13893
13894 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013895
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013896backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010013897 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013898 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
13899
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010013900curves <curves>
13901 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13902 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
13903 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
13904 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
13905 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
13906 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
13907
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013908ecdhe <named curve>
13909 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010013910 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
13911 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013912
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013913ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013914 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13915 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
William Lallemand34107802022-04-01 23:49:11 +020013916 client's certificate. It is possible to load a directory containing multiple
13917 CAs, in this case HAProxy will try to load every ".pem", ".crt", ".cer", and
William Lallemande4b93eb2022-05-09 09:29:00 +020013918 .crl" available in the directory, files starting with a dot are ignored.
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013919
William Lallemand1639d6c2022-05-26 00:18:46 +020013920 Warning: The "@system-ca" parameter could be used in place of the cafile
13921 in order to use the trusted CAs of your system, like its done with the server
13922 directive. But you mustn't use it unless you know what you are doing.
13923 Configuring it this way basically mean that the bind will accept any client
13924 certificate generated from one of the CA present on your system, which is
13925 extremely unsecure.
13926
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013927ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
13928 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
13929 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
13930 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
13931 error is ignored.
13932
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013933ca-sign-file <cafile>
13934 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13935 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
13936 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
13937 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13938 'generate-certificates' for details.
13939
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000013940ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013941 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
13942 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
13943 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13944 'generate-certificates' for details.
13945
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013946ca-verify-file <cafile>
13947 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
13948 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
13949 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
13950 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
13951 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
13952
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013953ciphers <ciphers>
13954 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13955 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000013956 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013957 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013958 information and recommendations see e.g.
13959 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
13960 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
13961 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
13962
13963ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
13964 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
13965 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
13966 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
13967 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013968 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
13969 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013970
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013971crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013972 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13973 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
Remi Tricot-Le Breton02bd6842021-05-04 12:22:34 +020013974 to verify client's certificate. You need to provide a certificate revocation
13975 list for every certificate of your certificate authority chain.
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013976
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013977crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013978 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13979 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
13980 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
13981 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
13982 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010013983 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
13984 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013985
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010013986 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
13987 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
13988
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013989 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
13990 are loaded.
13991
13992 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010013993 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
William Lallemand589570d2022-05-09 10:30:51 +020013994 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). Files
13995 starting with a dot are also ignored. This directive may be specified multiple
13996 times in order to load certificates from multiple files or directories. The
13997 certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server Name
13998 Indication field matching one of their CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are
13999 supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used instead of the first
14000 hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches www.example.org but not
14001 www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000014002
14003 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
14004 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
14005 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
14006 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010014007 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
14008 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000014009
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020014010 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014011
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014012 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000014013 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014014 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
14015 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000014016 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
14017 clients).
14018
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014019 For each PEM file, HAProxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020014020 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
14021 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
14022 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
14023 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
14024 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
14025 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
14026 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
14027 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
14028 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
14029 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
14030 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
14031 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
14032
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014033 For each PEM file, HAProxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010014034 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
14035 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
14036 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
14037 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
14038
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050014039 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
14040 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
14041 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
14042 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050014043
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020014044 To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
14045 by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
14046 bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050014047
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020014048crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000014049 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014050 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014051 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000014052 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020014053
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010014054crt-list <file>
14055 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010014056 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
14057 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010014058
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010014059 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
14060
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020014061 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
14062 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
14063 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
14064 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
14065 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010014066
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020014067 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030014068 useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI, or
14069 after the first certificate to exclude a pattern from its CN or Subject Alt
14070 Name (SAN). The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
14071 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI
14072 filter is specified, the CN and SAN are used. This directive may be specified
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020014073 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
14074 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
14075 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010014076
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020014077 Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
14078 as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
14079 the same work on all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050014080
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020014081 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
14082
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030014083 The first declared certificate of a bind line is used as the default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014084 certificate, either from crt or crt-list option, which HAProxy should use in
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030014085 the TLS handshake if no other certificate matches. This certificate will also
14086 be used if the provided SNI matches its CN or SAN, even if a matching SNI
14087 filter is found on any crt-list. The SNI filter !* can be used after the first
14088 declared certificate to not include its CN and SAN in the SNI tree, so it will
14089 never match except if no other certificate matches. This way the first
14090 declared certificate act as a fallback.
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030014091
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010014092 crt-list file example:
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030014093 cert1.pem !*
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020014094 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010014095 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010014096 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010014097 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010014098
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014099defer-accept
14100 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
14101 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
14102 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014103 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014104 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
14105 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
14106 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
14107 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
14108 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
14109 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
14110 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
14111
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020014112expose-fd listeners
14113 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
14114 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemand2be557f2021-11-24 18:45:37 +010014115 In master-worker mode, this is not required anymore, the listeners will be
14116 passed using the internal socketpairs between the master and the workers.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014117 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020014118
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014119force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014120 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014121 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014122 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014123 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014124
14125force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014126 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014127 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014128 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014129
14130force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014131 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014132 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014133 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014134
14135force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014136 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014137 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014138 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014139
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014140force-tlsv13
14141 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
14142 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014143 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014144
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020014145generate-certificates
14146 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14147 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
14148 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
14149 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
14150 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
14151 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
14152 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
14153 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
14154 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
14155 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
14156 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
14157
14158 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
14159 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014160 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020014161 certificate is used many times.
14162
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014163gid <gid>
14164 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
14165 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
14166 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
14167 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
14168 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14169
14170group <group>
14171 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
14172 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
14173 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
14174 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
14175 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14176
14177id <id>
14178 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
14179 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
14180 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
14181 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
14182
14183interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010014184 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
14185 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
14186 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
14187 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
14188 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
14189 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010014190 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
14191 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
14192 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
14193 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
14194 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
14195 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014196
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020014197level <level>
14198 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
14199 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
14200 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014201 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020014202 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
14203 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
14204 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014205 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020014206 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014207 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020014208 all counters).
14209
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020014210severity-output <format>
14211 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
14212 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
14213 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
14214 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
14215 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
14216 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
14217 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
14218 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
14219 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
14220 rfc5424 convention.
14221
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014222maxconn <maxconn>
14223 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
14224 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
14225 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
14226 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
14227 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
14228 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
14229 eat all memory.
14230
14231mode <mode>
14232 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
14233 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
14234 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
14235 UNIX sockets.
14236
14237mss <maxseg>
14238 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
14239 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
14240 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
14241 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
14242 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
14243 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
14244 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
14245 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
14246 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
14247 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
14248 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
14249
14250name <name>
14251 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
14252 page.
14253
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020014254namespace <name>
14255 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
14256 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
14257 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
14258 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
14259
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014260nice <nice>
14261 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
14262 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
14263 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
14264 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
14265 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
14266 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
14267 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
14268 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
14269 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
14270 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
14271 one for an RDP socket.
14272
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020014273no-ca-names
14274 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14275 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010014276 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020014277
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014278no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014279 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014280 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014281 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014282 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014283 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
14284 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014285
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020014286no-tls-tickets
14287 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14288 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
14289 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014290 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
14291 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014292 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14293 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14294 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020014295
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014296no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014297 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014298 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014299 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014300 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014301 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
14302 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014303
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014304no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014305 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014306 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014307 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014308 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014309 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
14310 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014311
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014312no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014313 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014314 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014315 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014316 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014317 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
14318 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014319
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014320no-tlsv13
14321 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14322 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
14323 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
14324 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014325 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
14326 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014327
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020014328npn <protocols>
14329 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
14330 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
14331 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014332 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020014333 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010014334 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
14335 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
14336 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
14337 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
14338 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020014339
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000014340prefer-client-ciphers
14341 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
14342 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
14343 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020014344 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
14345 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
14346 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000014347
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010014348process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020014349 This restricts the list of threads on which this listener is allowed to run.
14350 It does not enforce any of them but eliminates those which do not match. Note
14351 that only process number 1 is permitted. If a thread set is specified, it
14352 limits the threads allowed to process incoming connections for this listener.
14353 For the unlikely case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be
14354 repeated. <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010014355
14356 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
14357
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020014358 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such a
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020014359 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose is
14360 to have multiple bind lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same thread
14361 in a listener, so that the system can distribute the incoming connections
14362 into multiple queues, bypassing haproxy's internal queue load balancing.
14363 Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known for supporting this.
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020014364
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020014365 This directive is deprecated in favor of the more suited "thread" directive
14366 below, and will be removed in 2.7.
14367
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020014368proto <name>
14369 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
14370 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
14371 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014372 in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP),
14373 the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14374
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020014375 Some protocols are subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side
14376 (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG).
14377 The HTX compatibility is also reported (flag=HTX).
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014378
14379 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
14380 a bind line :
14381
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020014382 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014383 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14384 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14385
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014386 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020014387 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080014388 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020014389 h2" on the bind line.
14390
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +020014391quic-force-retry
14392 Warning: QUIC support in HAProxy is currently experimental. Configuration may
14393 change without deprecation in the future.
14394
14395 This is a QUIC specific setting which forces the use of the QUIC Retry feature
14396 for all the connection attempts to the configured QUIC listeners. It consists
14397 in veryfying the peers are able to receive packets at the transport address
14398 they used to initiate a new connection, sending them a Retry packet which
14399 contains a token. This token must be sent back to the Retry packet sender,
14400 this latter being the only one to be able to validate the token. Note that QUIC
14401 Retry will always be used even if a Retry threshold was set (see
14402 "tune.quic.retry-threshold" setting). To be functional this setting needs a
14403 cluster secret to be set, if not it will be silently ignored (see "cluster-secret"
14404 setting).
14405
14406 See https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc9000.html#section-8.1.2 for more
14407 information about QUIC retry.
14408
Willy Tarreau6dfbef42021-10-12 15:23:03 +020014409shards <number> | by-thread
14410 In multi-threaded mode, on operating systems supporting multiple listeners on
14411 the same IP:port, this will automatically create this number of multiple
14412 identical listeners for the same line, all bound to a fair share of the number
14413 of the threads attached to this listener. This can sometimes be useful when
14414 using very large thread counts where the in-kernel locking on a single socket
14415 starts to cause a significant overhead. In this case the incoming traffic is
14416 distributed over multiple sockets and the contention is reduced. Note that
14417 doing this can easily increase the CPU usage by making more threads work a
14418 little bit.
14419
14420 If the number of shards is higher than the number of available threads, it
14421 will automatically be trimmed to the number of threads (i.e. one shard per
14422 thread). The special "by-thread" value also creates as many shards as there
14423 are threads on the "bind" line. Since the system will evenly distribute the
14424 incoming traffic between all these shards, it is important that this number
14425 is an integral divisor of the number of threads.
14426
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014427ssl
14428 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014429 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014430 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
14431 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020014432 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
14433 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014434
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014435ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
14436 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020014437 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
14438 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
14439 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014440 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
14441
14442ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020014443 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
14444 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
14445 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
14446 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014447
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010014448strict-sni
14449 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
14450 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
14451 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
14452 See the "crt" option for more information.
14453
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010014454tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014455 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010014456 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014457 allows HAProxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014458 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010014459 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
14460 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
14461 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
14462 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
14463 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
14464 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
14465 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
14466
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020014467tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010014468 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020014469 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
14470 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
14471 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
14472 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
14473 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
14474 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
14475 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020014476 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
14477 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
14478 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020014479
Willy Tarreaud57b9ff2021-09-29 18:50:31 +020014480thread [<thread-group>/]<thread-set>
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020014481 This restricts the list of threads on which this listener is allowed to run.
14482 It does not enforce any of them but eliminates those which do not match. It
14483 limits the threads allowed to process incoming connections for this listener.
Willy Tarreaud57b9ff2021-09-29 18:50:31 +020014484
14485 There are two numbering schemes. By default, thread numbers are absolute in
14486 the process, comprised between 1 and the value specified in global.nbthread.
14487 When thread groups are enabled, the number of a single desired thread group
14488 (starting at 1) may be specified before a slash ('/') before the thread
14489 range. In this case, the thread numbers in the range are relative to the
14490 thread group instead, and start at 1 for each thread group. Absolute and
14491 relative thread numbers may be used interchangeably but they must not be
14492 mixed on a single "bind" line, as those not set will be resolved at the end
14493 of the parsing.
14494
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020014495 For the unlikely case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be
Willy Tarreaud57b9ff2021-09-29 18:50:31 +020014496 repeated. It is not permitted to use different thread groups even when using
14497 multiple directives. The <thread-set> specification must use the format:
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020014498
14499 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
14500
14501 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such a
14502 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose is
14503 to have multiple bind lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same thread
14504 in a listener, so that the system can distribute the incoming connections
14505 into multiple queues, bypassing haproxy's internal queue load balancing.
14506 Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known for supporting this.
14507
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010014508tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
14509 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010014510 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
14511 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
14512 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
14513 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
14514 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
14515 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
14516 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
14517 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
14518 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
14519 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010014520 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
14521 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
14522
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014523transparent
14524 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
14525 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
14526 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
14527 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
14528 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
14529 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
14530 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
14531 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
14532 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
14533 so check for support with your vendor.
14534
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014535v4v6
14536 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
14537 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
14538 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
14539 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014540 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014541
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010014542v6only
14543 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
14544 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
14545 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014546 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
14547 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010014548
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014549uid <uid>
14550 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
14551 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
14552 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
14553 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
14554 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14555
14556user <user>
14557 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
14558 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
14559 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
14560 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
14561 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14562
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020014563verify [none|optional|required]
14564 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
14565 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
14566 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
14567 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
14568 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020014569 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
14570 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
14571 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
14572 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014573
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200145745.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010014575------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014576
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010014577The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
14578which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
14579arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
14580settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
14581after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
14582Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
14583address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014584
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014585 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010014586 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014587
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014588Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
14589keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
14590
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014591The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014592
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020014593addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014594 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010014595 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
14596 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
14597 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
14598 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
14599 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014600
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014601agent-check
14602 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014603 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010014604 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
14605 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
14606 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014607
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014608 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014609 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014610 weight of a server as configured when HAProxy starts. Note that a zero
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020014611 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
14612 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014613
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014614 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
14615 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
14616 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
14617 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
14618 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020014619
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014620 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014621 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014622
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014623 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
14624 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
14625 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014626
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014627 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
14628 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
14629 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014630
William Dauchyf8e795c2020-09-26 13:35:51 +020014631 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014632 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
14633 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
14634 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
14635 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014636 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014637 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014638
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014639 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
14640 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014641
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014642 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
14643 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
14644 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
14645 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
14646 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
14647 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
14648 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
14649 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
14650 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014651
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090014652 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
14653 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014654 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
14655 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
14656 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010014657 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090014658
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014659 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014660 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014661
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070014662agent-send <string>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014663 If this option is specified, HAProxy will send the given string (verbatim)
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070014664 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
14665 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
14666 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
14667 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
14668
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014669agent-inter <delay>
14670 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
14671 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14672
14673 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
14674 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
14675 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
14676 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
14677 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14678 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14679 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14680 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14681 of backends use the same servers.
14682
14683 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
14684
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010014685agent-addr <addr>
14686 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
14687
14688 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014689 managing status and weights of servers defined in HAProxy in case you can't
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010014690 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
14691 hostname, it will be resolved.
14692
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014693agent-port <port>
14694 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
14695
14696 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
14697
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020014698allow-0rtt
14699 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020014700 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
14701 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020014702
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014703alpn <protocols>
14704 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
14705 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
14706 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014707 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014708 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
14709 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
14710 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
14711 now obsolete NPN extension.
14712 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
14713 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
14714
14715 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
14716
Amaury Denoyellef9d59572021-10-18 14:40:29 +020014717 See also "ws" to use an alternative ALPN for websocket streams.
14718
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014719backup
14720 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
14721 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
14722 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
14723 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014724 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
14725 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014726
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014727ca-file <cafile>
14728 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14729 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
William Lallemand34107802022-04-01 23:49:11 +020014730 server's certificate. It is possible to load a directory containing multiple
14731 CAs, in this case HAProxy will try to load every ".pem", ".crt", ".cer", and
William Lallemande4b93eb2022-05-09 09:29:00 +020014732 .crl" available in the directory, files starting with a dot are ignored.
William Lallemand34107802022-04-01 23:49:11 +020014733
14734 In order to use the trusted CAs of your system, the "@system-ca" parameter
14735 could be used in place of the cafile. The location of this directory could be
14736 overwritten by setting the SSL_CERT_DIR environment variable.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014737
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014738check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014739 This option enables health checks on a server:
14740 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
14741 considered available.
14742 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
14743 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
14744 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
14745 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
14746 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
Amaury Denoyelle7d098be2022-03-09 14:20:10 +010014747 set. This behavior is slightly different for dynamic servers, read the
14748 following paragraphs for more details.
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014749 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
14750 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
14751 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
14752 exchanges succeed.
14753
14754 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
14755 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
14756 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
14757 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
14758 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050014759 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014760 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
14761
Amaury Denoyelle7d098be2022-03-09 14:20:10 +010014762 Note that the implicit configuration of ssl and PROXY protocol is not
14763 performed for dynamic servers. In this case, it is required to explicitely
14764 use "check-ssl" and "check-send-proxy" when wanted, even if the check port is
14765 not overridden.
14766
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014767 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
14768 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
14769
14770 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
14771 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
14772
14773 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
14774 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
14775 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
14776 available.
14777
14778 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
14779 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
14780 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
14781
14782 Example:
14783 # simple tcp check
14784 backend foo
14785 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
14786 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
14787 backend foo
14788 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
14789 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
14790 backend foo
14791 option tcp-check
14792 tcp-check connect
14793 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014794
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020014795check-send-proxy
14796 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
14797 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
14798 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
14799 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
14800 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
14801 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
14802 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
14803
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010014804check-alpn <protocols>
14805 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
14806 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
14807 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
14808
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014809check-proto <name>
14810 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
14811 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
14812 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014813 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are
14814 reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14815
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020014816 Some protocols are subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side
14817 (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG).
14818 The HTX compatibility is also reported (flag=HTX).
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014819
14820 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "check-proto"
14821 directive on a server line:
14822
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020014823 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014824 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14825 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14826 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14827
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014828 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014829 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
14830 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
14831
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014832check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014833 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014834 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
14835 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014836
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014837check-ssl
14838 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
14839 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
14840 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
14841 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014842 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014843 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
14844 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014845 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014846 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
14847 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014848
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014849check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014850 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014851 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
14852 for normal traffic.
14853
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014854ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014855 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
14856 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
14857 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014858 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
14859 information and recommendations see e.g.
14860 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
14861 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
14862 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014863
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014864ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
14865 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
14866 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
14867 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
14868 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014869 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
14870 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
14871 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014872
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014873cookie <value>
14874 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
14875 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
14876 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
14877 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
14878 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
14879 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
14880 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
14881
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014882crl-file <crlfile>
14883 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14884 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
14885 to verify server's certificate.
14886
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020014887crt <cert>
14888 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
14889 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
14890 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
14891 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
14892 certificate request.
14893
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +020014894 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load the key
14895 at the same path suffixed by a ".key" (provided the "ssl-load-extra-files"
14896 option is set accordingly).
14897
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014898disabled
14899 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
14900 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
14901 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
14902 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
14903 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014904 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014905
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014906enabled
14907 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
14908 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
14909 default value.
14910 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
14911 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014912
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014913error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010014914 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
14915 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
14916 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014917
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014918 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014919
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014920fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014921 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
14922 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
14923 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
14924
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014925force-sslv3
14926 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14927 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014928 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014929 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014930
14931force-tlsv10
14932 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014933 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014934 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014935
14936force-tlsv11
14937 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014938 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014939 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014940
14941force-tlsv12
14942 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014943 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014944 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014945
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014946force-tlsv13
14947 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14948 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014949 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014950
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014951id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020014952 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
14953 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
14954 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014955
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014956init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
14957 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
14958 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014959 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014960 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
14961 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
14962 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
14963 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
14964 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
14965 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
14966 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
14967 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
14968 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014969 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014970 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
14971 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
14972 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
14973 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
14974 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
14975 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014976 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014977
14978 Example:
14979 defaults
14980 # never fail on address resolution
14981 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
14982
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014983inter <delay>
14984fastinter <delay>
14985downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014986 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
14987 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14988 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
14989 between checks depending on the server state :
14990
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020014991 Server state | Interval used
14992 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14993 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
14994 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14995 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
14996 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
14997 or yet unchecked. |
14998 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14999 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
15000 | "inter" otherwise.
15001 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015002
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015003 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
15004 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
15005 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
15006 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015007 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
15008 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
15009 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
15010 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
15011 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015012
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020015013log-proto <logproto>
15014 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
15015 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
15016 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
15017 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
15018
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015019maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015020 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
15021 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010015022 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
15023 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015024 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
15025 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
15026 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
15027 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
15028
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010015029 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
15030 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
15031 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
15032 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
15033 than 50 concurrent requests.
15034
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015035maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015036 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
15037 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
15038 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
15039 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
Willy Tarreau8ae8c482020-10-22 17:19:07 +020015040 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. Some load
15041 balancing algorithms such as leastconn take this into account and accept to
15042 add requests into a server's queue up to this value if it is explicitly set
15043 to a value greater than zero, which often allows to better smooth the load
15044 when dealing with single-digit maxconn values. The default value is "0" which
15045 means the queue is unlimited. See also the "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters
15046 and "balance leastconn".
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015047
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010015048max-reuse <count>
15049 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
15050 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
15051 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
15052 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
15053 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
15054 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
15055 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
15056 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
15057
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015058minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015059 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
15060 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
15061 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
15062 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
15063 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
15064 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015065 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015066 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010015067
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020015068namespace <name>
15069 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
15070 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
15071 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
15072 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
15073
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015074no-agent-check
15075 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
15076 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15077 default value.
15078 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15079 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
15080
15081no-backup
15082 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
15083 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15084 default value.
15085 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15086 "default-server" "backup" setting.
15087
15088no-check
15089 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
15090 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15091 default value.
15092 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15093 "default-server" "check" setting.
15094
15095no-check-ssl
15096 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
15097 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15098 default value.
15099 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15100 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
15101
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015102no-send-proxy
15103 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
15104 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15105 default value.
15106 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15107 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
15108
15109no-send-proxy-v2
15110 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
15111 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15112 default value.
15113 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15114 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
15115
15116no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
15117 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
15118 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15119 default value.
15120 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15121 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
15122
15123no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
15124 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
15125 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15126 default value.
15127 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15128 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
15129
15130no-ssl
15131 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
15132 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15133 default value.
15134 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15135 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
15136
William Dauchyf6370442020-11-14 19:25:33 +010015137 Note that using `default-server ssl` setting and `no-ssl` on server will
15138 however init SSL connection, so it can be later be enabled through the
15139 runtime API: see `set server` commands in management doc.
15140
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010015141no-ssl-reuse
15142 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
15143 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
15144 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
15145 and for paranoid users.
15146
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020015147no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015148 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
15149 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015150 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015151
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020015152 Supported in default-server: No
15153
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020015154no-tls-tickets
15155 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
15156 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
15157 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015158 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
15159 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010015160 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
15161 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
15162 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015163 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020015164
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020015165no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020015166 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020015167 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
15168 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015169 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
15170 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015171 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015172
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020015173 Supported in default-server: No
15174
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020015175no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020015176 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020015177 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
15178 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015179 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
15180 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015181 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015182
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020015183 Supported in default-server: No
15184
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020015185no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020015186 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015187 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
15188 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015189 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
15190 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015191 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020015192
15193 Supported in default-server: No
15194
15195no-tlsv13
15196 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
15197 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
15198 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
15199 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
15200 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015201 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015202
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020015203 Supported in default-server: No
15204
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015205no-verifyhost
15206 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
15207 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15208 default value.
15209 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15210 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015211
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020015212no-tfo
15213 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
15214 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15215 default value.
15216 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15217 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
15218
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090015219non-stick
15220 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
15221 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
15222 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
15223
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010015224npn <protocols>
15225 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
15226 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
15227 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015228 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010015229 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
15230 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
15231 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
15232
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010015233observe <mode>
15234 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
15235 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
15236 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
15237 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
15238 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
15239 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010015240 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010015241
15242 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
15243
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015244on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010015245 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
15246 Currently, four modes are available:
15247 - fastinter: force fastinter
15248 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
15249 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
15250 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
15251 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
15252
15253 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
15254
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090015255on-marked-down <action>
15256 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
15257 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070015258 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
15259 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
15260 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
15261 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
15262 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
15263 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
15264 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
15265 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090015266
15267 Actions are disabled by default
15268
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070015269on-marked-up <action>
15270 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
15271 Currently one action is available:
15272 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
15273 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
15274 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
15275 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015276 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
15277 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070015278 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
15279 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
15280
15281 Actions are disabled by default
15282
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020015283pool-low-conn <max>
15284 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
15285 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
15286 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
15287 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
15288 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
15289 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
15290 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
15291 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
15292 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
15293 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +010015294 applying to "http-reuse". In case connection sharing between threads would
15295 be disabled via "tune.idle-pool.shared", it can become very important to use
15296 this setting to make sure each thread always has a few connections, or the
15297 connection reuse rate will decrease as thread count increases.
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020015298
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010015299pool-max-conn <max>
15300 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
15301 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
15302 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
15303 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
15304 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
15305 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
15306
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010015307pool-purge-delay <delay>
15308 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010015309 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020015310 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010015311
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015312port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015313 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
William Dauchy4858fb22021-02-03 22:30:09 +010015314 send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
15315 desirable to dedicate a port to a specific component able to perform complex
15316 tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application. It is
15317 common to run a simple script in inetd for instance. This parameter is
15318 ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "addr" parameter.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015319
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020015320proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020015321 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
15322 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
15323 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010015324 reported in haproxy -vv.The protocols properties are reported : the mode
15325 (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
15326
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020015327 Some protocols are subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side
15328 (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG).
15329 The HTX compatibility is also reported (flag=HTX).
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010015330
15331 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
15332 a server line :
15333
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020015334 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010015335 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
15336 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
15337 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
15338
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040015339 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020015340 protocol for all connections established to this server.
15341
Amaury Denoyellef9d59572021-10-18 14:40:29 +020015342 See also "ws" to use an alternative protocol for websocket streams.
15343
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015344redir <prefix>
15345 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
15346 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
15347 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
15348 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
15349 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
15350 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
15351 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
15352 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015353 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015354 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015355 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
15356 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
15357 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
15358 loop between the client and HAProxy!
15359
15360 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
15361
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015362rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015363 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
15364 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
15365 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
15366
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020015367resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
15368 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
15369 server.
15370
15371 Available options:
15372
15373 * allow-dup-ip
15374 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
15375 resolution at runtime is in operation.
15376 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
15377 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
15378 For such case, simply enable this option.
15379 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
15380
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050015381 * ignore-weight
15382 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
15383 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
15384 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
15385
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020015386 * prevent-dup-ip
15387 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
15388 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
15389 same fqdn.
15390 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
15391
15392 Example:
15393 backend b_myapp
15394 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
15395 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
15396 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
15397
15398 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
15399 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
15400 it
15401 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
15402 different address
15403
15404 Default value: not set
15405
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015406resolve-prefer <family>
15407 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
15408 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
15409 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
15410 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
15411
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020015412 Default value: ipv6
15413
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015414 Example:
15415
15416 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015417
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010015418resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015419 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010015420 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015421 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015422 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
15423 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010015424 configured network, another address is selected.
15425
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015426 Example:
15427
15428 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010015429
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015430resolvers <id>
15431 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
15432 hostname.
15433
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015434 Example:
15435
15436 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015437
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015438 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015439
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010015440send-proxy
15441 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
15442 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
15443 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
15444 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015445 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
15446 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
15447 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
15448 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015449 fully be chained to another instance of HAProxy listening with an
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015450 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
15451 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
15452 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
15453 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
15454 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015455 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
15456 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010015457
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040015458send-proxy-v2
15459 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
15460 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
15461 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
15462 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020015463 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
15464 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
15465 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
15466 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040015467
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010015468proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010015469 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
15470 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
15471
15472 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
15473 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
15474 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
15475 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
15476 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
15477 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
15478 connection is supported).
15479 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
15480 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
15481 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
15482 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
15483 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
15484 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
15485 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010015486
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040015487send-proxy-v2-ssl
15488 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
15489 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
15490 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
15491 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
15492 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
15493 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
15494 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015495 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
15496 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040015497
15498send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
15499 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
15500 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
15501 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
15502 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
15503 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
15504 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
15505 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
15506 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015507 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
15508 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040015509
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015510slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015511 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
15512 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
15513 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
15514 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
15515 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
15516 parameters :
15517
15518 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
15519 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
15520
15521 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
15522 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
15523 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
15524 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
15525
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015526 The slowstart never applies when HAProxy starts, otherwise it would cause
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015527 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
15528 seen as failed.
15529
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020015530sni <expression>
15531 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
15532 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
15533 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
15534 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020015535 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
15536 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015537 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010015538 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
15539 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020015540
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015541source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020015542source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015543source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015544 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
15545 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
15546 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
15547 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
15548
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015549 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
15550 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
15551 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
15552 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
15553 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
15554 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
15555 server.
15556
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000015557 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
15558 specifying the source address without port(s).
15559
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015560ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020015561 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
15562 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
15563 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
15564 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
15565 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
15566 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015567 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
15568 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015569
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015570ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
15571 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
15572 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
15573 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
15574
15575ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
15576 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
15577 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
15578 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
15579
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015580ssl-reuse
15581 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
15582 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15583 default value.
15584 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15585 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
15586
15587stick
15588 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
15589 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15590 default value.
15591 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15592 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015593
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015594socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015595 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015596 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
15597 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
15598
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015599tcp-ut <delay>
15600 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015601 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows HAProxy to
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015602 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015603 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015604 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
15605 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
15606 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
15607 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
15608 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
15609 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
15610 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
15611 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
15612 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
15613
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010015614tfo
15615 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
15616 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
15617 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
15618 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015619 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or HAProxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020015620 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010015621
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015622track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020015623 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
15624 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
15625 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
15626 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015627 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
15628
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015629tls-tickets
15630 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
15631 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15632 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010015633 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
15634 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
15635 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015636 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010015637 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015638
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015639verify [none|required]
15640 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010015641 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015642 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
15643 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015644 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015645 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
15646 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
15647 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
15648 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
15649 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
15650 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
15651 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
15652 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015653
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070015654verifyhost <hostname>
15655 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015656 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
15657 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
15658 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
15659 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
15660 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
15661 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
15662 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
15663 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070015664
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015665weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015666 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
15667 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
15668 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020015669 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
15670 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
15671 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
15672 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
15673 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
15674 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015675
Amaury Denoyellef9d59572021-10-18 14:40:29 +020015676ws { auto | h1 | h2 }
15677 This option allows to configure the protocol used when relaying websocket
15678 streams. This is most notably useful when using an HTTP/2 backend without the
15679 support for H2 websockets through the RFC8441.
15680
15681 The default mode is "auto". This will reuse the same protocol as the main
15682 one. The only difference is when using ALPN. In this case, it can try to
15683 downgrade the ALPN to "http/1.1" only for websocket streams if the configured
15684 server ALPN contains it.
15685
15686 The value "h1" is used to force HTTP/1.1 for websockets streams, through ALPN
15687 if SSL ALPN is activated for the server. Similarly, "h2" can be used to
15688 force HTTP/2.0 websockets. Use this value with care : the server must support
15689 RFC8441 or an error will be reported by haproxy when relaying websockets.
15690
15691 Note that NPN is not taken into account as its usage has been deprecated in
15692 favor of the ALPN extension.
15693
15694 See also "alpn" and "proto".
15695
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015696
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200156975.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
15698-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015699
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015700HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
15701using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070015702configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process's life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015703This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
15704can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
15705workload.
15706This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
15707resolution at run time.
15708Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
15709carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
15710
15711
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200157125.3.1. Global overview
15713----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015714
15715As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
15716different steps of the process life:
15717
15718 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
15719 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
15720 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
15721
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015722 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
15723 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015724
15725A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
15726 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
15727 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
15728 resolution to know this new IP.
15729
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015730When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015731HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015732SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
15733from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015734will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, HAProxy
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015735will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020015736
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015737A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015738 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015739 first valid response.
15740
15741 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
15742 servers return an error.
15743
15744
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200157455.3.2. The resolvers section
15746----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015747
15748This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015749HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
15750contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015751
William Lallemandc33df2e2022-05-06 17:14:00 +020015752At startup, HAProxy tries to generate a resolvers section named "default", if
15753no section was named this way in the configuration. This section is used by
15754default by the httpclient and uses the parse-resolv-conf keyword. If HAProxy
15755failed to generate automatically this section, no error or warning are emitted.
15756
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015757When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
15758uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
15759is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
15760answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
15761
15762When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015763used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015764
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015765 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
15766 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
15767 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015768
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015769 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
15770 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015771
Thierry Fournier55c40ea2021-12-15 19:03:52 +010015772 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retries> times. If no valid
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015773 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
15774 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015775
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015776For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
15777following scenarios are possible:
15778
15779 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
15780 ignored
15781
15782 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
15783 applied
15784
15785 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
15786 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
15787
15788 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
15789 retries the query with a new type
15790
15791 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
15792 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015793
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015794As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, HAProxy keeps
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015795a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015796<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015797
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015798
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015799resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015800 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015801
15802A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
15803
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015804accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015805 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015806 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015807 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
15808 by RFC 6891)
15809
Emeric Brun4c751952021-03-08 16:41:29 +010015810 Note: the maximum allowed value is 65535. Recommended value for UDP is
15811 4096 and it is not recommended to exceed 8192 except if you are sure
15812 that your system and network can handle this (over 65507 makes no sense
15813 since is the maximum UDP payload size). If you are using only TCP
15814 nameservers to handle huge DNS responses, you should put this value
15815 to the max: 65535.
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020015816
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015817nameserver <name> <address>[:port] [param*]
15818 Used to configure a nameserver. <name> of the nameserver should ne unique.
15819 By default the <address> is considered of type datagram. This means if an
15820 IPv4 or IPv6 is configured without special address prefixes (paragraph 11.)
15821 the UDP protocol will be used. If an stream protocol address prefix is used,
15822 the nameserver will be considered as a stream server (TCP for instance) and
15823 "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph which are relevant for DNS
15824 resolving will be considered. Note: currently, in TCP mode, 4 queries are
15825 pipelined on the same connections. A batch of idle connections are removed
15826 every 5 seconds. "maxconn" can be configured to limit the amount of those
Emeric Brun56fc5d92021-02-12 20:05:45 +010015827 concurrent connections and TLS should also usable if the server supports.
15828
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015829parse-resolv-conf
15830 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
15831 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
15832 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
15833
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015834hold <status> <period>
15835 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
15836 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010015837 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015838 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015839 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
15840 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
15841 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
15842
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020015843 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015844
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015845resolve_retries <nb>
15846 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
15847 giving up.
15848 Default value: 3
15849
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015850 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
15851 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
15852 type.
15853
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015854timeout <event> <time>
15855 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
15856 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
15857 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015858 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
15859 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015860 Default value: 1s
15861 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015862 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015863 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015864 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
15865 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
15866
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015867 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015868
15869 resolvers mydns
15870 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
15871 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015872 nameserver dns3 tcp@10.0.0.3:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015873 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015874 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015875 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015876 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010015877 hold other 30s
15878 hold refused 30s
15879 hold nx 30s
15880 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015881 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015882 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015883
15884
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200158856. Cache
15886---------
15887
15888HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
15889(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
15890RAM.
15891
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020015892The cache is based on a memory area shared between all threads, and split in 1kB
15893blocks.
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015894
15895If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
15896independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
15897when we try to allocate a new one.
15898
15899The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
15900
15901It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
15902"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
15903for more details.
15904
15905When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
15906replaced by "<CACHE>".
15907
15908
159096.1. Limitation
15910----------------
15911
15912The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
15913
15914- If the response is not a 200
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4f730832020-11-26 15:51:50 +010015915- If the response contains a Vary header and either the process-vary option is
15916 disabled, or a currently unmanaged header is specified in the Vary value (only
15917 accept-encoding and referer are managed for now)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015918- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
15919- If the response is not cacheable
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond493bc82020-11-26 15:51:29 +010015920- If the response does not have an explicit expiration time (s-maxage or max-age
15921 Cache-Control directives or Expires header) or a validator (ETag or Last-Modified
15922 headers)
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015923- If the process-vary option is enabled and there are already max-secondary-entries
15924 entries with the same primary key as the current response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton6ca89162021-01-07 14:50:51 +010015925- If the process-vary option is enabled and the response has an unknown encoding (not
15926 mentioned in https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-parameters/http-parameters.xhtml)
15927 while varying on the accept-encoding client header
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015928
15929- If the request is not a GET
15930- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
15931- If the request contains an Authorization header
15932
15933
159346.2. Setup
15935-----------
15936
15937To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
15938the corresponding http-request and response actions.
15939
15940
159416.2.1. Cache section
15942---------------------
15943
15944cache <name>
15945 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
15946 size of cache is mandatory.
15947
15948total-max-size <megabytes>
15949 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
15950 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
15951
15952max-object-size <bytes>
15953 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
15954 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
15955 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
15956
15957max-age <seconds>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015958 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set as the lowest
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015959 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
15960 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
15961 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
15962 default.
15963
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015964process-vary <on/off>
15965 Enable or disable the processing of the Vary header. When disabled, a response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015966 containing such a header will never be cached. When enabled, we need to calculate
15967 a preliminary hash for a subset of request headers on all the incoming requests
15968 (which might come with a cpu cost) which will be used to build a secondary key
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015969 for a given request (see RFC 7234#4.1). The default value is off (disabled).
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015970
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015971max-secondary-entries <number>
15972 Define the maximum number of simultaneous secondary entries with the same primary
15973 key in the cache. This needs the vary support to be enabled. Its default value is 10
15974 and should be passed a strictly positive integer.
15975
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015976
159776.2.2. Proxy section
15978---------------------
15979
15980http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15981 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
15982 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
15983 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
15984 after this one.
15985
15986http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15987 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
15988 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
15989 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
15990 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
15991
15992
15993Example:
15994
15995 backend bck1
15996 mode http
15997
15998 http-request cache-use foobar
15999 http-response cache-store foobar
16000 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
16001
16002 cache foobar
16003 total-max-size 4
16004 max-age 240
16005
16006
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200160077. Using ACLs and fetching samples
16008----------------------------------
16009
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016010HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016011client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
16012The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
16013these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
16014but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
16015data called patterns.
16016
16017
160187.1. ACL basics
16019---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016020
16021The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
16022content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
16023from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
16024simple :
16025
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016026 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016027 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016028 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
16029 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016030
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016031The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
16032adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016033
16034In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
16035
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016036 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016037
16038This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
16039Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
16040and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016041an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
16042conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
16043as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
16044are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016045
16046ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
16047'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
16048which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
16049
16050There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
16051performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
16052
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016053The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
16054specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
16055this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016056methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
16057ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016058
16059Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
16060 - boolean
16061 - integer (signed or unsigned)
16062 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
16063 - string
16064 - data block
16065
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016066Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
16067converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
16068would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
16069The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
16070which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
16071
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020016072Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
16073keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
16074fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
16075which are summarized in the table below :
16076
16077 +---------------------+-----------------+
16078 | Sample or converter | Default |
16079 | output type | matching method |
16080 +---------------------+-----------------+
16081 | boolean | bool |
16082 +---------------------+-----------------+
16083 | integer | int |
16084 +---------------------+-----------------+
16085 | ip | ip |
16086 +---------------------+-----------------+
16087 | string | str |
16088 +---------------------+-----------------+
16089 | binary | none, use "-m" |
16090 +---------------------+-----------------+
16091
16092Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
16093matching method, see below.
16094
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016095The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
16096 - boolean
16097 - integer or integer range
16098 - IP address / network
16099 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
16100 - regular expression
16101 - hex block
16102
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016103The following ACL flags are currently supported :
16104
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020016105 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
16106 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016107 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010016108 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010016109 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010016110 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016111 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
16112
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016113The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
16114read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
16115if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
16116lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
16117will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
16118beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016119a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, HAProxy may load the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016120lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
16121exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
16122
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010016123The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
16124parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
16125ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
16126a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
16127check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
16128
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010016129The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
16130socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
16131file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
16132
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016133Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
16134loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
16135
16136 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
16137
16138In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
16139the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
16140case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
16141as well.
16142
16143The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
16144sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
16145do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
16146methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
16147is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016148obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016149followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
16150default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
16151that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
16152string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
16153
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010016154The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
16155By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
16156string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
16157resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016158server is not reachable, the HAProxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016159waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010016160flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
16161function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
16162
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016163There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
16164sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
16165be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016166
16167 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
16168 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016169 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
16170 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
16171 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
16172 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016173
16174 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
16175 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016176 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016177
16178 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016179 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016180
16181 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016182 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016183
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016184 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016185 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
16186
16187 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
16188 binary or string samples.
16189
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016190 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
16191 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016192
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016193 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
16194 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
16195 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016196
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016197 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
16198 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016199
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016200 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
16201 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016202
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016203 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
16204 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016205
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016206 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
16207 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016208 This may be used with binary or string samples.
16209
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016210 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
16211 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
16212 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016213
16214For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
16215request, it is possible to do :
16216
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016217 acl jsess_present req.cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016218
16219In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
16220buffer, one would use the following acl :
16221
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016222 acl script_tag req.payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016223
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016224On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
16225possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
16226
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016227 acl script_tag req.payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016228
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016229All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
16230criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
16231method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
16232to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
16233criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
16234the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020016235
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016236If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016237the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
16238For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020016239
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016240 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
16241 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
16242 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
16243 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020016244
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020016245
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020016246The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
16247types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
16248combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
16249brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
16250default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016251
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016252 +-------------------------------------------------+
16253 | Input sample type |
16254 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020016255 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016256 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
16257 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
16258 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020016259 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016260 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020016261 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016262 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010016263 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016264 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020016265 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016266 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020016267 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016268 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010016269 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016270 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010016271 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016272 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010016273 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016274 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010016275 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016276 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010016277 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016278 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010016279 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016280 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
16281 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
16282 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016283
16284
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200162857.1.1. Matching booleans
16286------------------------
16287
16288In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
16289Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
16290When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
16291that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
16292
16293Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
16294return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
16295"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
16296
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016297
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200162987.1.2. Matching integers
16299------------------------
16300
16301Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
16302enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
16303to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
16304
16305Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
16306matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
16307lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016308
16309For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
16310unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
16311representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
16312
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016313As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
16314two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
16315instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
16316ranges and operators.
16317
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016318For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016319operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
16320Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
16321of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016322
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016323Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016324
16325 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
16326 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
16327 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
16328 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
16329 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
16330
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016331For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016332
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016333 acl negative-length req.hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016334
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016335This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
16336
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016337 acl sslv3 req.ssl_ver 3:3.1
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016338
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016339
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200163407.1.3. Matching strings
16341-----------------------
16342
16343String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
16344different forms :
16345
16346 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016347 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016348
16349 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016350 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016351
16352 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
16353 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
16354
16355 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
16356 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
16357
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010016358 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016359 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
16360 matches.
16361
16362 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
16363 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
16364 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016365
16366String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
16367exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
16368characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
16369string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
16370to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016371before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016372
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010016373Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
16374(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
16375Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
16376
16377Example:
16378 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
16379 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
16380
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016381
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200163827.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
16383---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016384
16385Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
16386they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
16387possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
16388passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
16389the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016390the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
16391match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016392
16393
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200163947.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
16395-------------------------------------
16396
16397It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
16398not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
16399a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
16400to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
16401digits may be used upper or lower case.
16402
16403Example :
16404 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016405 acl hello req.payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016406
16407
164087.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
16409---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016410
16411IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
16412netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
16413within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010016414host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016415difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
16416at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
16417does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
16418parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016419
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020016420The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
16421abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
16422
16423 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
16424 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
16425 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
16426 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
16427 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
16428 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
16429 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
16430 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
16431
16432Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
16433192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
16434
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020016435IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
16436Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
16437trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
16438IPv6 patterns.
16439
16440HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
16441following situations :
16442 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
16443 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
16444 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
16445 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
16446 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
16447 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
16448 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
16449 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
16450 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
16451 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
16452
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016453
164547.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
16455----------------------------------
16456
16457Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
16458combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
16459
16460 - AND (implicit)
16461 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
16462 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016463
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016464A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016465
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016466 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020016467
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016468Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
16469indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020016470
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016471For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
16472"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
16473requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
16474is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
16475
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016476 acl missing_cl req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030016477 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
16478 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
16479 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016480
16481To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
16482and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
16483
16484 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
16485 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
16486 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
16487 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
16488
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016489 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016490 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
16491 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
16492 use_backend www if host_www
16493
16494It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
16495expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
16496be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
16497the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
16498
16499 The following rule :
16500
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016501 acl missing_cl req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030016502 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016503
16504 Can also be written that way :
16505
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016506 http-request deny if METH_POST { req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016507
16508It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
16509to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
16510simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
16511sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
16512good use is the following :
16513
16514 With named ACLs :
16515
16516 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
16517 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
16518 monitor fail if site_dead
16519
16520 With anonymous ACLs :
16521
16522 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
16523
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030016524See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
16525keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016526
16527
165287.3. Fetching samples
16529---------------------
16530
16531Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
16532against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
16533sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
16534ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
16535of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
16536available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
16537
16538This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
16539Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
16540compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
16541deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
16542
16543The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
16544matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
16545method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
16546indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
16547
16548As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
16549when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
16550mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
16551the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
16552ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
16553
16554Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
16555multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
16556when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016557incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
16558are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016559is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
16560all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
16561
16562Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
16563 - name
16564 - name(arg1)
16565 - name(arg1,arg2)
16566
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016567
165687.3.1. Converters
16569-----------------
16570
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016571Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
16572of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
16573is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
16574was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016575has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016576unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
16577
16578These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
16579sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
16580the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016581support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016582
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016583A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
16584support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
16585supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
16586(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
16587bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
16588
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016589The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016590
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001659151d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
16592 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
16593 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
16594 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
16595 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
16596 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
16597
16598 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016599 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
16600 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000016601 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
16602 frontend http-in
16603 bind *:8081
16604 default_backend servers
16605 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
16606 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
16607
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016608add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016609 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016610 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016611 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
16612 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016613 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016614 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16615 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16616 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16617 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016618 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016619 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016620
Nikola Sale0dbf0382022-04-03 18:11:53 +020016621add_item(<delim>,[<var>][,<suff>]])
16622 Concatenates a minimum of 2 and up to 3 fields after the current sample which
16623 is then turned into a string. The first one, <delim>, is a constant string,
16624 that will be appended immediately after the existing sample if an existing
16625 sample is not empty and either the <var> or the <suff> is not empty. The
16626 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
16627 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after
16628 the <delim> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It is
16629 optional and may optionally be followed by a constant string <suff>, however
16630 if <var> is omitted, then <suff> is mandatory. This converter is similar to
16631 the concat converter and can be used to build new variables made of a
16632 succession of other variables but the main difference is that it does the
16633 checks if adding a delimiter makes sense as wouldn't be the case if e.g. the
16634 current sample is empty. That situation would require 2 separate rules using
16635 concat converter where the first rule would have to check if the current
16636 sample string is empty before adding a delimiter. If commas or closing
16637 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
16638 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
16639 level parser. See examples below.
16640
16641 Example:
16642 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",req.score1,"(site1)") if src,in_table(site1)'
16643 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",req.score2,"(site2)") if src,in_table(site2)'
16644 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",req.score3,"(site3)") if src,in_table(site3)'
16645 http-request set-header x-tagged %[var(req.tagged)]
16646
16647 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",req.score1),add_item(",",req.score2)'
16648 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",,(site1))' if src,in_table(site1)
16649
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010016650aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
16651 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
16652 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
16653 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
16654 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
16655 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
16656 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
16657
16658 Example:
16659 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
16660 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
16661
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016662and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016663 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016664 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016665 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
16666 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016667 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016668 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16669 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16670 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16671 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016672 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016673 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016674
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020016675b64dec
16676 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
16677 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020016678 For base64url("URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant
16679 see "ub64dec".
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020016680
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020016681base64
16682 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016683 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020016684 an SSL ID can be copied in a header). For base64url("URL and Filename
16685 Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant see "ub64enc".
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020016686
Marcin Deranek40ca09c2021-07-13 14:05:24 +020016687be2dec(<separator>,<chunk_size>,[<truncate>])
16688 Converts big-endian binary input sample to a string containing an unsigned
16689 integer number per <chunk_size> input bytes. <separator> is put every
16690 <chunk_size> binary input bytes if specified. <truncate> flag indicates
16691 whatever binary input is truncated at <chunk_size> boundaries. <chunk_size>
16692 maximum value is limited by the size of long long int (8 bytes).
16693
16694 Example:
16695 bin(01020304050607),be2dec(:,2) # 258:772:1286:7
16696 bin(01020304050607),be2dec(-,2,1) # 258-772-1286
16697 bin(01020304050607),be2dec(,2,1) # 2587721286
16698 bin(7f000001),be2dec(.,1) # 127.0.0.1
16699
Marcin Deranekda0264a2021-07-13 14:08:56 +020016700be2hex([<separator>],[<chunk_size>],[<truncate>])
16701 Converts big-endian binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex
16702 digits per input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some
16703 binary input data in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID
16704 can be copied in a header). <separator> is put every <chunk_size> binary
16705 input bytes if specified. <truncate> flag indicates whatever binary input is
16706 truncated at <chunk_size> boundaries.
16707
16708 Example:
16709 bin(01020304050607),be2hex # 01020304050607
16710 bin(01020304050607),be2hex(:,2) # 0102:0304:0506:07
16711 bin(01020304050607),be2hex(--,2,1) # 0102--0304--0506
16712 bin(0102030405060708),be2hex(,3,1) # 010203040506
16713
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016714bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016715 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016716 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016717 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016718 presence of a flag).
16719
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010016720bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
16721 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
16722 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016723 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010016724
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016725concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
16726 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
16727 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
16728 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
16729 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
16730 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
16731 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
16732 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
16733 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
16734 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
16735 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016736 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040016737 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016738 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020016739 level parser. This is often used to build composite variables from other
16740 ones, but sometimes using a format string with multiple fields may be more
16741 convenient. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016742
16743 Example:
16744 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
16745 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
16746 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016747 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020016748 tcp-request session set-var-fmt(txn.ipport) "addr=(%[sess.ip],%[sess.port])" ## does the same
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016749 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
16750
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016751cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016752 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
16753 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016754
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010016755crc32([<avalanche>])
16756 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
16757 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16758 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16759 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16760 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16761 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
16762 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
16763 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
16764 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
16765 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016766 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
16767
16768crc32c([<avalanche>])
16769 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
16770 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16771 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16772 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
16773 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
16774 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
16775 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
16776 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010016777
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020016778cut_crlf
16779 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
16780 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
16781 updated.
16782
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010016783da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016784 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
16785 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
16786 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
16787 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016788 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the HAProxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016789 configuration language.
16790
16791 Example:
16792 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020016793 bind *:8881
16794 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000016795 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016796
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010016797debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
16798 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
16799 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
16800 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
16801 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
16802 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
16803 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
16804 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
16805 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
16806 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
16807 printable sample types.
16808
16809 Example:
16810 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020016811
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016812digest(<algorithm>)
16813 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
16814 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
16815
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016816 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016817 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16818
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016819div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016820 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16821 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016822 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016823 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
16824 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016825 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016826 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16827 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16828 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16829 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016830 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016831 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016832
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016833djb2([<avalanche>])
16834 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
16835 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16836 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16837 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16838 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16839 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16840 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016841 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
16842 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016843
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016844even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016845 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016846 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
16847
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016848field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
16849 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
16850 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
16851 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
16852 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
16853 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
16854 fields.
16855
16856 Example :
16857 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
16858 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
16859 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
16860 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
16861 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010016862
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016863fix_is_valid
16864 Parses a binary payload and performs sanity checks regarding FIX (Financial
16865 Information eXchange):
16866
16867 - checks that all tag IDs and values are not empty and the tags IDs are well
16868 numeric
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050016869 - checks the BeginString tag is the first tag with a valid FIX version
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016870 - checks the BodyLength tag is the second one with the right body length
Christopher Fauleted4bef72021-03-18 17:40:56 +010016871 - checks the MsgType tag is the third tag.
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016872 - checks that last tag in the message is the CheckSum tag with a valid
16873 checksum
16874
16875 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16876 the server can be parsed.
16877
16878 This converter returns a boolean, true if the payload contains a valid FIX
16879 message, false if not.
16880
16881 See also the fix_tag_value converter.
16882
16883 Example:
16884 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16885 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16886
16887fix_tag_value(<tag>)
16888 Parses a FIX (Financial Information eXchange) message and extracts the value
16889 from the tag <tag>. <tag> can be a string or an integer pointing to the
16890 desired tag. Any integer value is accepted, but only the following strings
16891 are translated into their integer equivalent: BeginString, BodyLength,
Daniel Corbettbefef702021-03-09 23:00:34 -050016892 MsgType, SenderCompID, TargetCompID, CheckSum. More tag names can be easily
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016893 added.
16894
16895 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16896 the server can be parsed. No message validation is performed by this
16897 converter. It is highly recommended to validate the message first using
16898 fix_is_valid converter.
16899
16900 See also the fix_is_valid converter.
16901
16902 Example:
16903 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16904 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16905 # MsgType tag ID is 35, so both lines below will return the same content
16906 tcp-request content set-var(txn.foo) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(35)
16907 tcp-request content set-var(txn.bar) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(MsgType)
16908
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016909hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016910 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016911 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016912 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016913 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010016914
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016915hex2i
16916 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016917 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016918
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020016919htonl
16920 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
16921 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
16922 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
16923 unsigned 32-bit integer.
16924
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016925hmac(<algorithm>,<key>)
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016926 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
16927 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
16928 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
16929 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
16930
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016931 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016932 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16933
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010016934http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016935 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16936 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016937 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
16938 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
16939 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
16940 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
16941 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
16942 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
16943 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
16944 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016945
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016946iif(<true>,<false>)
16947 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
16948 string otherwise.
16949
16950 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020016951 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016952
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016953in_table(<table>)
16954 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16955 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
16956 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016957 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016958 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
16959
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016960ipmask(<mask4>,[<mask6>])
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016961 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016962 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016963 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
16964 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
16965 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
16966 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
16967 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016968
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016969json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016970 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016971 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016972 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016973 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
16974 of errors:
16975 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
16976 bytes, ...)
16977 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
16978 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
16979
16980 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
16981 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
16982 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
16983 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
16984 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
16985 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016986 - "ascii" : never fails;
16987 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
16988 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016989 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016990 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016991 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
16992 characters corresponding to the other errors.
16993
16994 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016995 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016996
16997 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016998 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016999 capture request header user-agent len 150
17000 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020017001
17002 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
17003 GET / HTTP/1.0
17004 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
17005
17006 Output log:
17007 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
17008
Alex51c8ad42021-04-15 16:45:15 +020017009json_query(<json_path>,[<output_type>])
17010 The json_query converter supports the JSON types string, boolean and
17011 number. Floating point numbers will be returned as a string. By
17012 specifying the output_type 'int' the value will be converted to an
17013 Integer. If conversion is not possible the json_query converter fails.
17014
17015 <json_path> must be a valid JSON Path string as defined in
17016 https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/draft-ietf-jsonpath-base/
17017
17018 Example:
17019 # get a integer value from the request body
17020 # "{"integer":4}" => 5
17021 http-request set-var(txn.pay_int) req.body,json_query('$.integer','int'),add(1)
17022
17023 # get a key with '.' in the name
17024 # {"my.key":"myvalue"} => myvalue
17025 http-request set-var(txn.pay_mykey) req.body,json_query('$.my\\.key')
17026
17027 # {"boolean-false":false} => 0
17028 http-request set-var(txn.pay_boolean_false) req.body,json_query('$.boolean-false')
17029
17030 # get the value of the key 'iss' from a JWT Bearer token
17031 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec,json_query('$.iss')
17032
Remi Tricot-Le Breton0a72f5e2021-10-01 15:36:57 +020017033jwt_header_query([<json_path>],[<output_type>])
17034 When given a JSON Web Token (JWT) in input, either returns the decoded header
17035 part of the token (the first base64-url encoded part of the JWT) if no
17036 parameter is given, or performs a json_query on the decoded header part of
17037 the token. See "json_query" converter for details about the accepted
17038 json_path and output_type parameters.
17039
17040 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
17041 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
17042
17043jwt_payload_query([<json_path>],[<output_type>])
17044 When given a JSON Web Token (JWT) in input, either returns the decoded
17045 payload part of the token (the second base64-url encoded part of the JWT) if
17046 no parameter is given, or performs a json_query on the decoded payload part
17047 of the token. See "json_query" converter for details about the accepted
17048 json_path and output_type parameters.
17049
17050 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
17051 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
17052
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020017053jwt_verify(<alg>,<key>)
17054 Performs a signature verification for the JSON Web Token (JWT) given in input
17055 by using the <alg> algorithm and the <key> parameter, which should either
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020017056 hold a secret or a path to a public certificate. Returns 1 in case of
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1c891bc2021-10-18 15:14:49 +020017057 verification success, 0 in case of verification error and a strictly negative
17058 value for any other error. Because of all those non-null error return values,
17059 the result of this converter should never be converted to a boolean. See
17060 below for a full list of the possible return values.
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020017061
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020017062 For now, only JWS tokens using the Compact Serialization format can be
17063 processed (three dot-separated base64-url encoded strings). Among the
17064 accepted algorithms for a JWS (see section 3.1 of RFC7518), the PSXXX ones
17065 are not managed yet.
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020017066
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020017067 If the used algorithm is of the HMAC family, <key> should be the secret used
17068 in the HMAC signature calculation. Otherwise, <key> should be the path to the
17069 public certificate that can be used to validate the token's signature. All
17070 the certificates that might be used to verify JWTs must be known during init
17071 in order to be added into a dedicated certificate cache so that no disk
17072 access is required during runtime. For this reason, any used certificate must
Ilya Shipitsina4d09e72021-11-20 23:11:12 +050017073 be mentioned explicitly at least once in a jwt_verify call. Passing an
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020017074 intermediate variable as second parameter is then not advised.
17075
17076 This converter only verifies the signature of the token and does not perform
17077 a full JWT validation as specified in section 7.2 of RFC7519. We do not
17078 ensure that the header and payload contents are fully valid JSON's once
17079 decoded for instance, and no checks are performed regarding their respective
17080 contents.
17081
17082 The possible return values are the following :
17083
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020017084 +----+----------------------------------------------------------------------+
17085 | ID | message |
17086 +----+----------------------------------------------------------------------+
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1c891bc2021-10-18 15:14:49 +020017087 | 0 | "Verification failure" |
Ilya Shipitsina4d09e72021-11-20 23:11:12 +050017088 | 1 | "Verification success" |
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1c891bc2021-10-18 15:14:49 +020017089 | -1 | "Unknown algorithm (not mentioned in RFC7518)" |
17090 | -2 | "Unmanaged algorithm (PSXXX algorithm family)" |
17091 | -3 | "Invalid token" |
17092 | -4 | "Out of memory" |
17093 | -5 | "Unknown certificate" |
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020017094 +----+----------------------------------------------------------------------+
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020017095
17096 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
17097 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
17098
17099 Example:
17100 # Get a JWT from the authorization header, extract the "alg" field of its
17101 # JOSE header and use a public certificate to verify a signature
17102 http-request set-var(txn.bearer) http_auth_bearer
17103 http-request set-var(txn.jwt_alg) var(txn.bearer),jwt_header_query('$.alg')
17104 http-request deny unless { var(txn.jwt_alg) "RS256" }
17105 http-request deny unless { var(txn.bearer),jwt_verify(txn.jwt_alg,"/path/to/crt.pem") 1 }
17106
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017107language(<value>[,<default>])
17108 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
17109 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
17110 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
17111 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
17112 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
17113 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
17114 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
17115 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
17116 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017117 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017118 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
17119 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020017120
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017121 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020017122
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017123 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
17124 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020017125
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017126 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
17127 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
17128 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
17129 use_backend spanish if es
17130 use_backend french if fr
17131 use_backend english if en
17132 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020017133
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010017134length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010017135 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
17136 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
17137 type. The result is of type integer.
17138
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020017139lower
17140 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
17141 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
17142 type. The result is of type string.
17143
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017144ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
17145 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
17146 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
17147 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
17148 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
17149 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
17150 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
17151
17152 Example :
17153
17154 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017155 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017156 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
17157
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020017158ltrim(<chars>)
17159 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
17160 representation of the input sample.
17161
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017162map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
17163map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
17164map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
17165 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
17166 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
17167 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
17168 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
17169 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
17170 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
17171 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
17172 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017173
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017174 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
17175 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
17176 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017177
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010017178 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017179 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017180
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017181 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
17182 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
17183 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
17184 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020017185 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
17186 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017187 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
17188 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
17189 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
17190 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
17191 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
17192 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
17193 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
17194 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080017195 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
17196 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
17197 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017198 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
17199 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
17200 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
17201 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
17202 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017203
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010017204 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
17205 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
17206 the corresponding match text.
17207
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017208 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
17209 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
17210 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
17211 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
17212 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017213
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017214 Example :
17215
17216 # this is a comment and is ignored
17217 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
17218 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
17219 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
17220 | | | `---------- value
17221 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
17222 | `---------------------------- key
17223 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
17224
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017225mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017226 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
17227 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017228 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017229 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017230 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017231 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17232 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
17233 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
17234 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017235 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017236 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017237
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017238mqtt_field_value(<packettype>,<fieldname_or_property_ID>)
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010017239 Returns value of <fieldname> found in input MQTT payload of type
17240 <packettype>.
17241 <packettype> can be either a string (case insensitive matching) or a numeric
17242 value corresponding to the type of packet we're supposed to extract data
17243 from.
17244 Supported string and integers can be found here:
17245 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v3.1.1/os/mqtt-v3.1.1-os.html#_Toc398718021
17246 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901022
17247
17248 <fieldname> depends on <packettype> and can be any of the following below.
17249 (note that <fieldname> matching is case insensitive).
17250 <property id> can only be found in MQTT v5.0 streams. check this table:
17251 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901029
17252
17253 - CONNECT (or 1): flags, protocol_name, protocol_version, client_identifier,
17254 will_topic, will_payload, username, password, keepalive
17255 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
17256 packets only):
17257 17: Session Expiry Interval
17258 33: Receive Maximum
17259 39: Maximum Packet Size
17260 34: Topic Alias Maximum
17261 25: Request Response Information
17262 23: Request Problem Information
17263 21: Authentication Method
17264 22: Authentication Data
17265 18: Will Delay Interval
17266 1: Payload Format Indicator
17267 2: Message Expiry Interval
17268 3: Content Type
17269 8: Response Topic
17270 9: Correlation Data
17271 Not supported yet:
17272 38: User Property
17273
17274 - CONNACK (or 2): flags, protocol_version, reason_code
17275 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
17276 packets only):
17277 17: Session Expiry Interval
17278 33: Receive Maximum
17279 36: Maximum QoS
17280 37: Retain Available
17281 39: Maximum Packet Size
17282 18: Assigned Client Identifier
17283 34: Topic Alias Maximum
17284 31: Reason String
17285 40; Wildcard Subscription Available
17286 41: Subscription Identifiers Available
17287 42: Shared Subscription Available
17288 19: Server Keep Alive
17289 26: Response Information
17290 28: Server Reference
17291 21: Authentication Method
17292 22: Authentication Data
17293 Not supported yet:
17294 38: User Property
17295
17296 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
17297 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
17298 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
17299 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
17300
17301 Example:
17302
17303 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
17304 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
17305 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(connect,protocol_name) \
17306 if data_in_buffer
17307 # do the same as above
17308 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
17309 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(1,protocol_name) \
17310 if data_in_buffer
17311
17312mqtt_is_valid
17313 Checks that the binary input is a valid MQTT packet. It returns a boolean.
17314
17315 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
17316 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
17317 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
17318 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
17319
Christopher Faulet140a3572022-03-22 09:41:11 +010017320 Only MQTT 3.1, 3.1.1 and 5.0 are supported.
17321
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010017322 Example:
17323
17324 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
Daniel Corbettcc9d9b02021-05-13 10:46:07 -040017325 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),mqtt_is_valid }
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010017326
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017327mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017328 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020017329 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
17330 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017331 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017332 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017333 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017334 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17335 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
17336 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
17337 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017338 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017339 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017340
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010017341nbsrv
17342 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
17343 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
17344 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
17345 map lookup.
17346
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017347neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017348 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
17349 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
17350 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
17351 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017352
17353not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017354 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017355 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017356 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017357 absence of a flag).
17358
17359odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017360 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017361 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
17362
17363or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017364 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017365 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017366 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
17367 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017368 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017369 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17370 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
17371 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
17372 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017373 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017374 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017375
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017376protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
17377 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
17378 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
17379 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
17380 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
17381 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
17382 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
17383 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
17384 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
17385 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
17386 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
17387 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
17388
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010017389regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010017390 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
17391 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
17392 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
17393 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
17394 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
17395 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
17396 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
17397 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
17398 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010017399 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
17400 of characters with other ones.
17401
17402 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
17403 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
17404 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
17405 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
17406 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
17407 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010017408
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010017409 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010017410
17411 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
17412 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
17413 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010017414 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010017415
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010017416 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
17417 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
17418
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010017419 # capture groups and backreferences
17420 # both lines do the same.
Willy Tarreau465dc7d2020-10-08 18:05:56 +020017421 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)']
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010017422 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
17423
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020017424capture-req(<id>)
17425 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
17426 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
17427
17428 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020017429 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
17430 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020017431
17432capture-res(<id>)
17433 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
17434 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
17435
17436 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020017437 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
17438 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020017439
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020017440rtrim(<chars>)
17441 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
17442 of the input sample.
17443
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017444sdbm([<avalanche>])
17445 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
17446 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
17447 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
17448 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
17449 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
17450 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
17451 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010017452 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
17453 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017454
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020017455secure_memcmp(<var>)
17456 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
17457 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
17458 match.
17459
17460 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
17461 performed in constant time.
17462
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017463 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020017464 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
17465
17466 Example :
17467
17468 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
17469 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
17470 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
17471 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
17472
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010017473set-var(<var>[,<cond> ...])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017474 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010017475 as-is if all of the specified conditions are true (see below for a list of
17476 possible conditions). The variable keeps the value and the associated input
17477 type. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
17478 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017479 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017480 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17481 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017482 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017483 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17484 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017485 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017486 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017487
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010017488 You can pass at most four conditions to the converter among the following
17489 possible conditions :
17490 - "ifexists"/"ifnotexists":
17491 Checks if the variable already existed before the current set-var call.
17492 A variable is usually created through a successful set-var call.
17493 Note that variables of scope "proc" are created during configuration
17494 parsing so the "ifexists" condition will always be true for them.
17495 - "ifempty"/"ifnotempty":
17496 Checks if the input is empty or not.
17497 Scalar types are never empty so the ifempty condition will be false for
17498 them regardless of the input's contents (integers, booleans, IPs ...).
17499 - "ifset"/"ifnotset":
17500 Checks if the variable was previously set or not, or if unset-var was
17501 called on the variable.
17502 A variable that does not exist yet is considered as not set. A "proc"
17503 variable can exist while not being set since they are created during
17504 configuration parsing.
17505 - "ifgt"/"iflt":
17506 Checks if the content of the variable is "greater than" or "less than"
17507 the input. This check can only be performed if both the input and
17508 the variable are of type integer. Otherwise, the check is considered as
17509 true by default.
17510
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020017511sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020017512 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020017513 sample with length of 20 bytes.
17514
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020017515sha2([<bits>])
17516 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
17517 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
17518
17519 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
17520 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
17521
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017522 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020017523 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
17524
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020017525srv_queue
17526 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
17527 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
17528 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
17529 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
17530 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
17531
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020017532strcmp(<var>)
17533 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
17534 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
17535 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
17536 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
17537 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
17538 shorter).
17539
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020017540 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
17541 strings in constant time.
17542
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020017543 Example :
17544
17545 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
17546 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
17547 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
17548
17549
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017550sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017551 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
17552 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017553 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017554 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
17555 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017556 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017557 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17558 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017559 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017560 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17561 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017562 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017563 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017564
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017565table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
17566 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17567 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17568 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
17569 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
17570 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
17571 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
17572
17573
17574table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
17575 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17576 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17577 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
17578 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
17579 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
17580 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
17581
17582table_conn_cnt(<table>)
17583 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17584 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017585 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017586 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
17587 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
17588
17589table_conn_cur(<table>)
17590 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17591 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17592 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
17593 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
17594 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
17595
17596table_conn_rate(<table>)
17597 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17598 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17599 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
17600 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
17601 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
17602
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020017603table_gpt(<idx>,<table>)
17604 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
17605 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
17606 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the general
17607 purpose tag at the index <idx> of the array associated to the input sample
17608 in the designated <table>. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
17609 If there is no GPT stored at this index, it also returns the boolean value 0.
17610 This applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not on the legacy 'gpt0'
17611 data-type).
17612 See also the sc_get_gpt sample fetch keyword.
17613
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020017614table_gpt0(<table>)
17615 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17616 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
17617 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
17618 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
17619 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
17620
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020017621table_gpc(<idx>,<table>)
17622 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
17623 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17624 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the
17625 General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array associated
17626 to the input sample in the designated <table>. <idx> is an integer
17627 between 0 and 99.
17628 If there is no GPC stored at this index, it also returns the boolean value 0.
17629 This applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
17630 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
17631 See also the sc_get_gpc sample fetch keyword.
17632
17633table_gpc_rate(<idx>,<table>)
17634 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
17635 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17636 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the Global
17637 Purpose Counter at index <idx> of the array (associated to the input sample
17638 in the designated stick-table <table>) was incremented over the
17639 configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
17640 If there is no gpc_rate stored at this index, it also returns the boolean
17641 value 0.
17642 This applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to the
17643 legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
17644 See also the sc_gpc_rate sample fetch keyword.
17645
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017646table_gpc0(<table>)
17647 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17648 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17649 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
17650 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
17651 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
17652
17653table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
17654 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17655 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17656 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
17657 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
17658 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
17659 sample fetch keyword.
17660
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017661table_gpc1(<table>)
17662 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17663 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17664 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
17665 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
17666 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
17667
17668table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
17669 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17670 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17671 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
17672 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
17673 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
17674 sample fetch keyword.
17675
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017676table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
17677 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17678 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017679 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017680 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
17681 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
17682
17683table_http_err_rate(<table>)
17684 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17685 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17686 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
17687 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
17688 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
17689 keyword.
17690
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010017691table_http_fail_cnt(<table>)
17692 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17693 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17694 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
17695 failures associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
17696 the sc_http_fail_cnt sample fetch keyword.
17697
17698table_http_fail_rate(<table>)
17699 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17700 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17701 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP failures associated with the
17702 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of failures over the
17703 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_fail_rate sample fetch
17704 keyword.
17705
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017706table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
17707 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17708 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017709 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017710 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
17711 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
17712
17713table_http_req_rate(<table>)
17714 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17715 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17716 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
17717 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
17718 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
17719 keyword.
17720
17721table_kbytes_in(<table>)
17722 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17723 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017724 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017725 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
17726 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
17727 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
17728 keyword.
17729
17730table_kbytes_out(<table>)
17731 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17732 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017733 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017734 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
17735 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
17736 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
17737 keyword.
17738
17739table_server_id(<table>)
17740 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17741 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17742 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
17743 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
17744 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
17745 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
17746
17747table_sess_cnt(<table>)
17748 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17749 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017750 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017751 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
17752 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
17753 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
17754 keyword.
17755
17756table_sess_rate(<table>)
17757 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17758 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17759 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
17760 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
17761 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
17762 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
17763 keyword.
17764
17765table_trackers(<table>)
17766 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17767 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17768 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
17769 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
17770 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
17771 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
17772 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
17773 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
17774 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
17775 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
17776
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020017777ub64dec
17778 This converter is the base64url variant of b64dec converter. base64url
17779 encoding is the "URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" variant of base64 encoding.
17780 It is also the encoding used in JWT (JSON Web Token) standard.
17781
17782 Example:
17783 # Decoding a JWT payload:
17784 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec
17785
17786ub64enc
17787 This converter is the base64url variant of base64 converter.
17788
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020017789upper
17790 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
17791 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
17792 type. The result is of type string.
17793
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020017794url_dec([<in_form>])
17795 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
17796 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
17797 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
17798 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
17799 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
17800 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020017801
William Dauchy888b0ae2021-01-06 23:39:50 +010017802url_enc([<enc_type>])
17803 Takes a string provided as input and returns the encoded version as output.
17804 The input and the output are of type string. By default the type of encoding
17805 is meant for `query` type. There is no other type supported for now but the
17806 optional argument is here for future changes.
17807
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017808ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017809 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017810 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
17811 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
17812 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017813 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
17814 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
17815 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
17816 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010017817 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017818 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
17819 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017820
17821 Example:
17822 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
17823 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
17824
17825 message Point {
17826 int32 latitude = 1;
17827 int32 longitude = 2;
17828 }
17829
17830 message PPoint {
17831 Point point = 59;
17832 }
17833
17834 message Rectangle {
17835 // One corner of the rectangle.
17836 PPoint lo = 48;
17837 // The other corner of the rectangle.
17838 PPoint hi = 49;
17839 }
17840
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017841 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
17842 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
17843 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017844
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017845 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
17846 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017847 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017848 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
17849
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017850 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017851
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010017852 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017853
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017854 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
17855 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
17856 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017857
17858 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
17859 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
17860 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
17861
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017862 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
17863 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
17864 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017865
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017866
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010017867unset-var(<var>)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010017868 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
17869 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
17870 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
17871 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17872 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
17873 response),
17874 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17875 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
17876 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
17877 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
17878
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017879utime(<format>[,<offset>])
17880 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
17881 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
17882 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
17883 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
17884 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
17885 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
17886
17887 Example :
17888
17889 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017890 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017891 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
17892
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020017893word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
17894 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
17895 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
17896 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010017897 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020017898 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
17899 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
17900
17901 Example :
17902 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
17903 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
17904 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
17905 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
17906 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010017907 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010017908
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017909wt6([<avalanche>])
17910 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
17911 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
17912 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
17913 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
17914 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
17915 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
17916 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010017917 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
17918 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017919
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017920xor(<value>)
17921 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017922 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017923 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017924 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017925 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017926 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17927 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017928 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017929 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17930 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017931 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017932 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017933
Dragan Dosen04bf0cc2020-12-22 21:44:33 +010017934xxh3([<seed>])
17935 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the XXH3
17936 64-bit variant of the XXhash hash function. This hash supports a seed which
17937 defaults to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument.
17938 This hash is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash
17939 URLs and/or URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics
17940 with a low collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not
17941 considered as cryptographically secure.
17942
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010017943xxh32([<seed>])
17944 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
17945 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
17946 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
17947 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
17948 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
17949 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
17950 as cryptographically secure.
17951
17952xxh64([<seed>])
17953 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
17954 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
17955 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
17956 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
17957 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
17958 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
17959 as cryptographically secure.
17960
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017961
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200179627.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017963--------------------------------------------
17964
17965A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
17966not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
17967"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
17968The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
17969
17970always_false : boolean
17971 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
17972 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
17973
17974always_true : boolean
17975 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
17976 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
17977
17978avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017979 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017980 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
17981 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
17982 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
17983 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
17984 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
17985 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
17986 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
17987 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
17988 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
17989 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
17990 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
17991 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
17992 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010017993
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017994be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017995 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
17996 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
17997 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
17998 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017999 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
18000
18001be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
18002 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
18003 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
18004 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
18005 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
18006 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040018007 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
18008 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040018009
18010 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
18011 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
18012 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018013
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018014be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
18015 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
18016 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
18017 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018018 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018019 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
18020 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018021
18022 Example :
18023 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
18024 backend dynamic
18025 mode http
18026 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
18027 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018028
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018029bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020018030 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
18031 of the string.
18032
18033bool(<bool>) : bool
18034 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
18035 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
18036
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018037connslots([<backend>]) : integer
18038 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018039 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018040 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
18041 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050018042
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080018043 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020018044 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080018045 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
18046
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020018047 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
18048 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080018049
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020018050 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020018051 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018052 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020018053 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018054 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018055 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020018056 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080018057
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020018058 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
18059 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018060 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020018061 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080018062
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010018063cpu_calls : integer
18064 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
18065 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
18066 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
18067 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
18068 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
18069 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
18070
18071cpu_ns_avg : integer
18072 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
18073 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
18074 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
18075 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
18076 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
18077 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
18078 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
18079 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
18080 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
18081 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
18082 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
18083
18084cpu_ns_tot : integer
18085 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
18086 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
18087 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
18088 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
18089 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
18090 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
18091 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
18092 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
18093 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
18094 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
18095 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
18096 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
18097 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
18098
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010018099date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020018100 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000018101
18102 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
18103 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
18104 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020018105 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
18106
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000018107 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
18108 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
18109 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
18110 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
18111 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
18112
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020018113 Example :
18114
18115 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
18116 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020018117
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000018118 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
18119 # millisecond granularity
18120 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
18121
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010018122date_us : integer
18123 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
18124 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
18125 from the same timeval structure.
18126
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020018127env(<name>) : string
18128 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
18129 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
18130 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
18131 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
18132 certain way.
18133
18134 Examples :
18135 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
18136 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
18137
18138 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010018139 http-request deny if !{ req.cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020018140
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018141fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
18142 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018143 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
18144 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018145 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
18146 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018147 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018148 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
18149 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020018150
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020018151fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
18152 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
18153 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
18154 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
18155
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018156fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
18157 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
18158 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
18159 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
18160 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
18161 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
18162 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
18163 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
18164 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010018165
18166 Example :
18167 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
18168 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
18169 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
18170 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
18171 frontend mail
18172 bind :25
18173 mode tcp
18174 maxconn 100
18175 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
18176 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
18177 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
18178 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018179
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010018180hostname : string
18181 Returns the system hostname.
18182
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018183int(<integer>) : signed integer
18184 Returns a signed integer.
18185
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020018186ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
18187 Returns an ipv4.
18188
18189ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
18190 Returns an ipv6.
18191
Tim Duesterhus46419372022-05-27 23:20:36 +020018192last_rule_file : string
Willy Tarreau0657b932022-03-09 17:33:05 +010018193 This returns the name of the configuration file containing the last final
18194 rule that was matched during stream analysis. A final rule is one that
18195 terminates the evaluation of the rule set (like an "accept", "deny" or
18196 "redirect"). This works for TCP request and response rules acting on the
18197 "content" rulesets, and on HTTP rules from "http-request", "http-response"
18198 and "http-after-response" rule sets. The legacy "redirect" rulesets are not
18199 supported (such information is not stored there), and neither "tcp-request
18200 connection" nor "tcp-request session" rulesets are supported because the
18201 information is stored at the stream level and streams do not exist during
18202 these rules. The main purpose of this function is to be able to report in
18203 logs where was the rule that gave the final verdict, in order to help
18204 figure why a request was denied for example. See also "last_rule_line".
18205
Tim Duesterhus46419372022-05-27 23:20:36 +020018206last_rule_line : integer
Willy Tarreau0657b932022-03-09 17:33:05 +010018207 This returns the line number in the configuration file where is located the
18208 last final rule that was matched during stream analysis. A final rule is one
18209 that terminates the evaluation of the rule set (like an "accept", "deny" or
18210 "redirect"). This works for TCP request and response rules acting on the
18211 "content" rulesets, and on HTTP rules from "http-request", "http-response"
18212 and "http-after-response" rule sets. The legacy "redirect" rulesets are not
18213 supported (such information is not stored there), and neither "tcp-request
18214 connection" nor "tcp-request session" rulesets are supported because the
18215 information is stored at the stream level and streams do not exist during
18216 these rules. The main purpose of this function is to be able to report in
18217 logs where was the rule that gave the final verdict, in order to help
18218 figure why a request was denied for example. See also "last_rule_file".
18219
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010018220lat_ns_avg : integer
18221 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
18222 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
18223 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
18224 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
18225 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
18226 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
18227 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
18228 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
18229 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020018230 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
18231 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
18232 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
18233 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
18234 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
18235 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010018236
18237lat_ns_tot : integer
18238 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
18239 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
18240 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
18241 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
18242 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
18243 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
18244 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
18245 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
18246 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020018247 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
18248 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
18249 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
18250 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
18251 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010018252 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
18253 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
18254 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
18255 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
18256 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
18257 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
18258
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020018259meth(<method>) : method
18260 Returns a method.
18261
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018262nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
18263 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
18264 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
18265 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018266 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
18267 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
18268 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010018269
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040018270prio_class : integer
18271 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
18272 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
18273 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
18274
18275prio_offset : integer
18276 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
18277 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
18278 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
18279 set-priority-offset".
18280
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010018281proc : integer
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +020018282 Always returns value 1 (historically it would return the calling process
18283 number).
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010018284
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018285queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018286 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
18287 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
18288 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018289 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
18290 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
18291 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
18292 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
18293 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
18294
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010018295rand([<range>]) : integer
18296 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
18297 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
18298 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
18299 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
18300 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
18301
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018302srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
18303 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
18304 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
18305 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
18306 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
18307 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040018308 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
18309 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
18310
18311srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
18312 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
18313 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
18314 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
18315 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
18316 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
18317 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
18318 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
18319
18320 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
18321 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018322
18323srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
18324 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
18325 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
18326 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018327 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018328 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
18329 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
18330 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
18331
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020018332srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
18333 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
18334 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
18335 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
18336 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
18337 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
18338 fetch methods.
18339
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018340srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
18341 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
18342 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018343 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018344 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
18345 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018346 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018347 overloading servers).
18348
18349 Example :
18350 # Redirect to a separate back
18351 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
18352 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
18353 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
18354
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020018355srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020018356 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
18357 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
18358 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
18359
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020018360srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020018361 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
18362 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
18363 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
18364
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020018365srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020018366 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
18367 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
18368 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
18369
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010018370stopping : boolean
18371 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
18372 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
18373 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
18374
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020018375str(<string>) : string
18376 Returns a string.
18377
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018378table_avl([<table>]) : integer
18379 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
18380 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
18381
18382table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18383 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
18384 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
18385 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
18386
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010018387thread : integer
18388 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
18389 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
18390 and debugging purposes.
18391
Alexandar Lazic528adc32021-06-01 00:27:01 +020018392uuid([<version>]) : string
18393 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
18394 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
18395 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
18396
Willy Tarreau54496a62021-09-03 12:00:13 +020018397var(<var-name>[,<default>]) : undefined
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020018398 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Willy Tarreau54496a62021-09-03 12:00:13 +020018399 sample fetch fails, unless a default value is provided, in which case it will
18400 return it as a string. Empty strings are permitted. The name of the variable
18401 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010018402 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018403 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18404 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020018405 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018406 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
18407 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020018408 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010018409 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020018410
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200184117.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018412----------------------------------
18413
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018414The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018415closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
18416methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
18417sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
18418TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018419the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
18420counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020018421"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
18422used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
18423can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
18424Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
18425table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
18426tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
18427currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018428
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020018429bc_dst : ip
18430 This is the destination ip address of the connection on the server side,
18431 which is the server address HAProxy connected to. It is of type IP and works
18432 on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its
18433 IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
18434
18435bc_dst_port : integer
18436 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018437 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected to.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020018438
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010018439bc_err : integer
18440 Returns the ID of the error that might have occurred on the current backend
18441 connection. See the "fc_err_str" fetch for a full list of error codes
18442 and their corresponding error message.
18443
18444bc_err_str : string
18445 Returns an error message describing what problem happened on the current
18446 backend connection, resulting in a connection failure. See the
18447 "fc_err_str" fetch for a full list of error codes and their
18448 corresponding error message.
18449
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010018450bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010018451 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
18452 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
18453 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
18454
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020018455bc_src : ip
18456 This is the source ip address of the connection on the server side, which is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018457 the server address HAProxy connected from. It is of type IP and works on both
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020018458 IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
18459 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
18460
18461bc_src_port : integer
18462 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018463 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected from.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020018464
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018465be_id : integer
18466 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018467 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
18468 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018469
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010018470be_name : string
18471 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018472 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
18473 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010018474
Amaury Denoyelled91d7792020-12-10 13:43:56 +010018475be_server_timeout : integer
18476 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the server timeout of the
18477 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
18478 also the "cur_server_timeout".
18479
18480be_tunnel_timeout : integer
18481 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the tunnel timeout of the
18482 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
18483 also the "cur_tunnel_timeout".
18484
Amaury Denoyellef7719a22020-12-10 13:43:58 +010018485cur_server_timeout : integer
18486 Returns the currently applied server timeout in millisecond for the stream.
18487 In the default case, this will be equal to be_server_timeout unless a
18488 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_server_timeout".
18489
18490cur_tunnel_timeout : integer
18491 Returns the currently applied tunnel timeout in millisecond for the stream.
18492 In the default case, this will be equal to be_tunnel_timeout unless a
18493 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_tunnel_timeout".
18494
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018495dst : ip
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020018496 This is the destination IP address of the connection on the client side,
18497 which is the address the client connected to. Any tcp/http rules may alter
18498 this address. It can be useful when running in transparent mode. It is of
18499 type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address
18500 is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. When the incoming
18501 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
18502 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
18503 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
18504 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
18505 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
18506 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018507
18508dst_conn : integer
18509 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
18510 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
18511 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
18512 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
18513 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
18514 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
18515 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
18516 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018517
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018518dst_is_local : boolean
18519 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
18520 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
18521 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
18522 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018523 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018524 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
18525 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
18526 it only once per connection.
18527
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018528dst_port : integer
18529 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
18530 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020018531 Any tcp/http rules may alter this address. This might be used when running in
18532 transparent mode, when assigning dynamic ports to some clients for a whole
18533 application session, to stick all users to a same server, or to pass the
18534 destination port information to a server using an HTTP header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018535
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010018536fc_dst : ip
18537 This is the original destination IP address of the connection on the client
18538 side. Only "tcp-request connection" rules may alter this address. See "dst"
18539 for details.
18540
18541fc_dst_is_local : boolean
18542 Returns true if the original destination address of the incoming connection
18543 is local to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the
18544 system. See "dst_is_local" for details.
18545
18546fc_dst_port : integer
18547 Returns an integer value corresponding to the original destination TCP port
18548 of the connection on the client side. Only "tcp-request connection" rules may
18549 alter this address. See "dst-port" for details.
18550
18551fc_err : integer
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020018552 Returns the ID of the error that might have occurred on the current
18553 connection. Any strictly positive value of this fetch indicates that the
18554 connection did not succeed and would result in an error log being output (as
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +010018555 described in section 8.2.6). See the "fc_err_str" fetch for a full list of
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020018556 error codes and their corresponding error message.
18557
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010018558fc_err_str : string
Ilya Shipitsin01881082021-08-07 14:41:56 +050018559 Returns an error message describing what problem happened on the current
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020018560 connection, resulting in a connection failure. This string corresponds to the
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +010018561 "message" part of the error log format (see section 8.2.6). See below for a
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020018562 full list of error codes and their corresponding error messages :
18563
18564 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
18565 | ID | message |
18566 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
18567 | 0 | "Success" |
18568 | 1 | "Reached configured maxconn value" |
18569 | 2 | "Too many sockets on the process" |
18570 | 3 | "Too many sockets on the system" |
18571 | 4 | "Out of system buffers" |
18572 | 5 | "Protocol or address family not supported" |
18573 | 6 | "General socket error" |
18574 | 7 | "Source port range exhausted" |
18575 | 8 | "Can't bind to source address" |
18576 | 9 | "Out of local source ports on the system" |
18577 | 10 | "Local source address already in use" |
18578 | 11 | "Connection closed while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
18579 | 12 | "Connection error while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
18580 | 13 | "Timeout while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
18581 | 14 | "Truncated PROXY protocol header received" |
18582 | 15 | "Received something which does not look like a PROXY protocol header" |
18583 | 16 | "Received an invalid PROXY protocol header" |
18584 | 17 | "Received an unhandled protocol in the PROXY protocol header" |
18585 | 18 | "Connection closed while waiting for NetScaler Client IP header" |
18586 | 19 | "Connection error while waiting for NetScaler Client IP header" |
18587 | 20 | "Timeout while waiting for a NetScaler Client IP header" |
18588 | 21 | "Truncated NetScaler Client IP header received" |
18589 | 22 | "Received an invalid NetScaler Client IP magic number" |
18590 | 23 | "Received an unhandled protocol in the NetScaler Client IP header" |
18591 | 24 | "Connection closed during SSL handshake" |
18592 | 25 | "Connection error during SSL handshake" |
18593 | 26 | "Timeout during SSL handshake" |
18594 | 27 | "Too many SSL connections" |
18595 | 28 | "Out of memory when initializing an SSL connection" |
18596 | 29 | "Rejected a client-initiated SSL renegotiation attempt" |
18597 | 30 | "SSL client CA chain cannot be verified" |
18598 | 31 | "SSL client certificate not trusted" |
18599 | 32 | "Server presented an SSL certificate different from the configured one" |
18600 | 33 | "Server presented an SSL certificate different from the expected one" |
18601 | 34 | "SSL handshake failure" |
18602 | 35 | "SSL handshake failure after heartbeat" |
18603 | 36 | "Stopped a TLSv1 heartbeat attack (CVE-2014-0160)" |
18604 | 37 | "Attempt to use SSL on an unknown target (internal error)" |
18605 | 38 | "Server refused early data" |
18606 | 39 | "SOCKS4 Proxy write error during handshake" |
18607 | 40 | "SOCKS4 Proxy read error during handshake" |
18608 | 41 | "SOCKS4 Proxy deny the request" |
18609 | 42 | "SOCKS4 Proxy handshake aborted by server" |
Remi Tricot-Le Breton61944f72021-09-29 18:56:51 +020018610 | 43 | "SSL fatal error" |
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020018611 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
18612
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020018613fc_fackets : integer
18614 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
18615 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
18616 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
18617 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
18618
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020018619fc_http_major : integer
18620 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
18621 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
18622 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
18623
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020018624fc_lost : integer
18625 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
18626 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
18627 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
18628 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
18629
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020018630fc_pp_authority : string
18631 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
18632 if any.
18633
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010018634fc_pp_unique_id : string
18635 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
18636 if any.
18637
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010018638fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
18639 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
18640 header.
18641
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020018642fc_reordering : integer
18643 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
18644 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
18645 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
18646 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
18647
18648fc_retrans : integer
18649 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
18650 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
18651 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
18652 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
18653
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020018654fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
18655 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
18656 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
18657 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
18658 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
18659 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
18660 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
18661
18662fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
18663 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
18664 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
18665 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
18666 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
18667 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
18668 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
18669
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020018670fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070018671 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
18672 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
18673 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
18674 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
18675
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020018676fc_src : ip
18677 This is the original destination IP address of the connection on the client
18678 side. Only "tcp-request connection" rules may alter this address. See "src"
18679 for details.
18680
18681fc_src_is_local : boolean
18682 Returns true if the source address of incoming connection is local to the
18683 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system. See
18684 "src_is_local" for details.
18685
18686fc_src_port : integer
18687
18688 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
18689 connection on the client side. Only "tcp-request connection" rules may alter
18690 this address. See "src-port" for details.
18691
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070018692
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020018693fc_unacked : integer
18694 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
18695 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
18696 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
18697 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070018698
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020018699fe_defbe : string
18700 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
18701 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
18702
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018703fe_id : integer
18704 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010018705 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018706 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
18707
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010018708fe_name : string
18709 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
18710 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
18711 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
18712
Amaury Denoyelleda184d52020-12-10 13:43:55 +010018713fe_client_timeout : integer
18714 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the client timeout of the
18715 current frontend.
18716
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018717sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018718sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
18719sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
18720sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018721 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
18722 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
18723 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
18724
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018725sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018726sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
18727sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
18728sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018729 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
18730 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
18731 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
18732
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018733sc_clr_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18734 Clears the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
18735 associated to the designated tracked counter of ID <ctr> from current
18736 proxy's stick table or from the designated stick-table <table>, and
18737 returns its previous value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
18738 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
18739 Before the first invocation, the stored value is zero, so first invocation
18740 will always return zero.
18741 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18742 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
18743
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018744sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018745sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18746sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18747sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018748 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
18749 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018750 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
18751 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
18752 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018753
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018754 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018755 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
18756 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018757 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
18758 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
18759 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018760 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
18761 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18762
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018763sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18764sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18765sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18766sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18767 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
18768 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
18769 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
18770 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
18771 when a first ACL was verified.
18772
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018773sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018774sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18775sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18776sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018777 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018778 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
18779
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018780sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018781sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
18782sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
18783sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018784 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
18785 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
18786 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
18787
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018788sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018789sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
18790sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
18791sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018792 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
18793 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
18794 See also src_conn_rate.
18795
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018796sc_get_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18797 Returns the value of the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
18798 in the GPC array and associated to the currently tracked counter of
18799 ID <ctr> from the current proxy's stick-table or from the designated
18800 stick-table <table>. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
18801 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2. If there is not gpc stored at this
18802 index, zero is returned.
18803 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18804 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types). See also src_get_gpc and sc_inc_gpc.
18805
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018806sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018807sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18808sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18809sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018810 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018811 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018812
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018813sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18814sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18815sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18816sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18817 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
18818 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
18819
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020018820sc_get_gpt(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18821 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag at the index <idx> of
18822 the array associated to the tracked counter of ID <ctr> and from the
18823 current proxy's sitck-table or the designated stick-table <table>. <idx>
18824 is an integer between 0 and 99 and <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
18825 If there is no GPT stored at this index, zero is returned.
18826 This fetch applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not on
18827 the legacy 'gpt0' data-type). See also src_get_gpt.
18828
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020018829sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18830sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18831sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18832sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18833 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
18834 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
18835
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018836sc_gpc_rate(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18837 Returns the average increment rate of the General Purpose Counter at the
18838 index <idx> of the array associated to the tracked counter of ID <ctr> from
18839 the current proxy's table or from the designated stick-table <table>.
18840 It reports the frequency which the gpc counter was incremented over the
18841 configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <ctr> an integer
18842 between 0 and 2.
18843 Note that the 'gpc_rate' counter array must be stored in the stick-table
18844 for a value to be returned, as 'gpc' only holds the event count.
18845 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to
18846 the legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
18847 See also src_gpc_rate, sc_get_gpc, and sc_inc_gpc.
18848
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018849sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018850sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
18851sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
18852sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018853 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
18854 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
18855 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018856 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
18857 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18858 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018859
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018860sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18861sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18862sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18863sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18864 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
18865 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
18866 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
18867 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
18868 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18869 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
18870
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018871sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018872sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18873sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18874sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018875 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018876 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
18877 See also src_http_err_cnt.
18878
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018879sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018880sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18881sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18882sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018883 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
18884 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
18885 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
18886 src_http_err_rate.
18887
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018888sc_http_fail_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18889sc0_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18890sc1_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18891sc2_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18892 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures from the currently
18893 tracked counters. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes
18894 other than 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_cnt.
18895
18896sc_http_fail_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18897sc0_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18898sc1_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18899sc2_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18900 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures from the currently tracked
18901 counters, measured in amount of failures over the period configured in the
18902 table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes other than
18903 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_rate.
18904
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018905sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018906sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18907sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18908sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018909 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018910 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
18911 src_http_req_cnt.
18912
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018913sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018914sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18915sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18916sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018917 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
18918 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
18919 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
18920 src_http_req_rate.
18921
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018922sc_inc_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18923 Increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
18924 associated to the designated tracked counter of ID <ctr> from current
18925 proxy's stick table or from the designated stick-table <table>, and
18926 returns its new value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
18927 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
18928 Before the first invocation, the stored value is zero, so first invocation
18929 will increase it to 1 and will return 1.
18930 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18931 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
18932
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018933sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018934sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18935sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18936sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018937 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018938 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
18939 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
18940 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
18941 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018942
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018943 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018944 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
18945 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018946 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18947
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018948sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18949sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18950sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18951sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18952 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
18953 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
18954 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
18955 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
18956 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
18957
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018958sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018959sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
18960sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
18961sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018962 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
18963 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
18964 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018965
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018966sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018967sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
18968sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
18969sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018970 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
18971 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
18972 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018973
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018974sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018975sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18976sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18977sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018978 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018979 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
18980 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
18981 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018982 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018983 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
18984
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018985sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018986sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18987sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18988sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018989 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
18990 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
18991 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
18992 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
18993 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018994 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018995
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018996sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018997sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
18998sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
18999sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020019000 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
19001 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
19002 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
19003
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019004sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019005sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
19006sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
19007sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010019008 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
19009 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020019010 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010019011 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
19012 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019013 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
19014 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
19015 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010019016
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019017so_id : integer
19018 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
19019 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
19020 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019021
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010019022so_name : string
19023 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
19024 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
19025 strings instead of integers.
19026
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019027src : ip
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020019028 This is the source IP address of the client of the session. Any tcp/http
19029 rules may alter this address. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and
19030 IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
19031 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the TCP-level source
19032 address which is used, and not the address of a client behind a
19033 proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind directive
19034 is used, it can be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol
19035 compatible component for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which
19036 sees the real address. When the incoming connection passed through address
19037 translation or redirection involving connection tracking, the original
19038 destination address before the redirection will be reported. On Linux
19039 systems, the source and destination may seldom appear reversed if the
19040 nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late response may reopen a
19041 timed out connection and switch what is believed to be the source and the
19042 destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019043
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010019044 Example:
19045 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
19046 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
19047
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019048src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
19049 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
19050 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
19051 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019052 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019053
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019054src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
19055 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
19056 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019057 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019058 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019059
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020019060src_clr_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
19061 Clears the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
19062 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
19063 stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>, and returns its
19064 previous value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
19065 If the address is not found, an entry is created and 0 is returned.
19066 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
19067 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
19068 See also sc_clr_gpc.
19069
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019070src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
19071 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
19072 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
19073 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
19074 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
19075 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
19076 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020019077
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030019078 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020019079 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
19080 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
19081 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
19082 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010019083 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020019084 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
19085 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
19086
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010019087src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
19088 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
19089 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
19090 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
19091 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
19092 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
19093 was verified.
19094
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019095src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019096 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019097 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019098 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019099 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019100
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019101src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019102 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019103 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
19104 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019105 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019106
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019107src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
19108 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
19109 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
19110 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019111 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019112
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020019113src_get_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
19114 Returns the value of the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the
19115 array associated to the incoming connection's source address in the
19116 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>. <idx>
19117 is an integer between 0 and 99.
19118 If the address is not found or there is no gpc stored at this index, zero
19119 is returned.
19120 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not on the legacy
19121 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
19122 See also sc_get_gpc and src_inc_gpc.
19123
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019124src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019125 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019126 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019127 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019128 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019129
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010019130src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
19131 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
19132 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
19133 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
19134 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
19135
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020019136src_get_gpt(<idx>[,<table>]) : integer
19137 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag at the index <idx> of
19138 the array associated to the incoming connection's source address in the
19139 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>.
19140 <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
19141 If the address is not found or the GPT is not stored, zero is returned.
19142 See also the sc_get_gpt sample fetch keyword.
19143
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020019144src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
19145 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
19146 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
19147 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
19148 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
19149
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020019150src_gpc_rate(<idx>[,<table>]) : integer
19151 Returns the average increment rate of the General Purpose Counter at the
19152 index <idx> of the array associated to the incoming connection's
19153 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
19154 stick-table <table>. It reports the frequency which the gpc counter was
19155 incremented over the configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
19156 Note that the 'gpc_rate' counter must be stored in the stick-table for a
19157 value to be returned, as 'gpc' only holds the event count.
19158 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to
19159 the legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
19160 See also sc_gpc_rate, src_get_gpc, and sc_inc_gpc.
19161
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019162src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020019163 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019164 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020019165 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
19166 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019167 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
19168 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
19169 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020019170
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010019171src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
19172 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
19173 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
19174 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
19175 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
19176 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
19177 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
19178 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
19179
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019180src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019181 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019182 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019183 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019184 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019185 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019186
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019187src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
19188 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
19189 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
19190 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
19191 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019192 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019193
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010019194src_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19195 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures triggered by the
19196 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Ilya Shipitsin0de36ad2021-02-20 00:23:36 +050019197 the designated stick-table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010019198 status codes other than 501 and 505. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_cnt.
19199 If the address is not found, zero is returned.
19200
19201src_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
19202 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures triggered by the incoming
19203 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
19204 designated stick-table, measured in amount of failures over the period
19205 configured in the table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
19206 status codes other than 501 and 505. If the address is not found, zero is
19207 returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_rate.
19208
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019209src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019210 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019211 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
19212 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019213 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019214
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019215src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
19216 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
19217 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
19218 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019219 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019220 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019221
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020019222src_inc_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
19223 Increments the General Purpose Counter at index <idx> of the array
19224 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
19225 stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>, and returns its new
19226 value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
19227 If the address is not found, an entry is created and 1 is returned.
19228 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
19229 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
19230 See also sc_inc_gpc.
19231
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019232src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
19233 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
19234 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
19235 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020019236 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019237 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
19238 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019239
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030019240 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019241 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010019242 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019243 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019244
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010019245src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
19246 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
19247 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
19248 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
19249 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
19250 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
19251 connection when a first ACL was verified.
19252
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020019253src_is_local : boolean
19254 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
19255 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
19256 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
19257 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019258 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020019259 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
19260 once per connection.
19261
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019262src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020019263 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
19264 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
19265 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
19266 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
19267 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019268
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019269src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020019270 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
19271 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
19272 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
19273 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
19274 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020019275
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019276src_port : integer
19277 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020019278 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected
19279 from. Any tcp/http rules may alter this address. Usage of this function is
19280 very limited as modern protocols do not care much about source ports
19281 nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010019282
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019283src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019284 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019285 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
19286 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
19287 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019288 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019289
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019290src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
19291 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
19292 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
19293 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
19294 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019295 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019296
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019297src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19298 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
19299 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
19300 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
19301 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
19302 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
19303 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
19304 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
19305 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020019306
19307 Example :
19308 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
19309 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
19310 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
19311 listen ssh
19312 bind :22
19313 mode tcp
19314 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019315 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019316 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020019317 server local 127.0.0.1:22
19318
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019319srv_id : integer
19320 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
19321 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020019322 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020019323
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080019324srv_name : string
19325 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
19326 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020019327 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080019328
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200193297.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019330----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020019331
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019332The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019333closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
19334when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
19335usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019336future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020019337
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001933851d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
19339 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
19340 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
19341 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
19342 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
19343 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
19344
19345 Example :
19346 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
19347 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
19348 # the request.
19349 frontend http-in
19350 bind *:8081
19351 default_backend servers
19352 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
19353 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
19354
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019355ssl_bc : boolean
19356 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
19357 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019358 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
19359 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019360
19361ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
19362 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019363 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
19364 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019365
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010019366ssl_bc_alpn : string
19367 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
19368 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020019369 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010019370 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
19371 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
19372 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
19373 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
19374 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019375 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
19376 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010019377
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019378ssl_bc_cipher : string
19379 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019380 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
19381 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019382
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040019383ssl_bc_client_random : binary
19384 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
19385 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
19386 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019387 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040019388
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020019389ssl_bc_err : integer
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020019390 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020019391 returns the ID of the last error of the first error stack raised on the
19392 backend side. It can raise handshake errors as well as other read or write
19393 errors occurring during the connection's lifetime. In order to get a text
19394 description of this error code, you can either use the "ssl_bc_err_str"
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020019395 sample fetch or use the "openssl errstr" command (which takes an error code
19396 in hexadecimal representation as parameter). Please refer to your SSL
19397 library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error codes.
19398
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020019399ssl_bc_err_str : string
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020019400 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020019401 returns a string representation of the last error of the first error stack
19402 that was raised on the connection from the backend's perspective. See also
19403 "ssl_fc_err".
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020019404
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010019405ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
19406 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
19407 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019408 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
19409 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010019410
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010019411ssl_bc_npn : string
19412 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
19413 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020019414 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010019415 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
19416 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
19417 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
19418 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019419 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
19420 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010019421
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019422ssl_bc_protocol : string
19423 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019424 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
19425 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019426
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020019427ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019428 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020019429 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019430 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
19431 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019432
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040019433ssl_bc_server_random : binary
19434 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
19435 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
19436 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019437 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040019438
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019439ssl_bc_session_id : binary
19440 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
19441 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019442 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
19443 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019444
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040019445ssl_bc_session_key : binary
19446 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
19447 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
19448 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019449 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040019450
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019451ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
19452 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019453 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
19454 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019455
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019456ssl_c_ca_err : integer
19457 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19458 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
19459 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
19460 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
19461 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020019462
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019463ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
19464 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19465 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
19466 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
19467 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010019468
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010019469ssl_c_chain_der : binary
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020019470 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
19471 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19472 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050019473 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020019474 does not support resumed sessions.
19475
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010019476ssl_c_der : binary
19477 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
19478 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19479 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
19480
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019481ssl_c_err : integer
19482 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19483 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
19484 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
19485 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
19486 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020019487
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050019488ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019489 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19490 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
19491 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19492 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
19493 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
19494 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
19495 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19496 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050019497 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19498 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19499 LDAP v3.
19500 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19501 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020019502
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019503ssl_c_key_alg : string
19504 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
19505 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19506 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020019507
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019508ssl_c_notafter : string
19509 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
19510 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19511 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020019512
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019513ssl_c_notbefore : string
19514 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
19515 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19516 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010019517
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050019518ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019519 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19520 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
19521 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19522 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
19523 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
19524 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
19525 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19526 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050019527 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19528 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19529 LDAP v3.
19530 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19531 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010019532
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019533ssl_c_serial : binary
19534 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
19535 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19536 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020019537
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019538ssl_c_sha1 : binary
19539 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
19540 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
19541 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020019542 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
19543 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
19544
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030019545 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020019546 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020019547
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019548ssl_c_sig_alg : string
19549 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
19550 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
19551 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020019552
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019553ssl_c_used : boolean
19554 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
19555 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020019556
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019557ssl_c_verify : integer
19558 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
19559 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
19560 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
19561 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020019562
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019563ssl_c_version : integer
19564 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
19565 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020019566
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010019567ssl_f_der : binary
19568 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
19569 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19570 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
19571
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050019572ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019573 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19574 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
19575 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19576 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020019577 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019578 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
19579 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19580 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050019581 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19582 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19583 LDAP v3.
19584 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19585 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020019586
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019587ssl_f_key_alg : string
19588 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
19589 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
19590 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020019591
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019592ssl_f_notafter : string
19593 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
19594 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19595 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020019596
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019597ssl_f_notbefore : string
19598 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
19599 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19600 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020019601
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050019602ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019603 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19604 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
19605 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19606 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
19607 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
19608 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
19609 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19610 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050019611 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19612 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19613 LDAP v3.
19614 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19615 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020019616
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019617ssl_f_serial : binary
19618 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
19619 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19620 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020019621
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020019622ssl_f_sha1 : binary
19623 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
19624 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
19625 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
19626
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019627ssl_f_sig_alg : string
19628 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
19629 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
19630 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020019631
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019632ssl_f_version : integer
19633 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
19634 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
19635
19636ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020019637 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
19638 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
19639 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
19640
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019641 Example :
19642 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
19643 listen http-https
19644 bind :80
19645 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
19646 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
19647
19648ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
19649 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
19650 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
19651
19652ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019653 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019654 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019655 HAProxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019656 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
19657 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
19658 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
19659 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
19660 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
19661 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
19662
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019663ssl_fc_cipher : string
19664 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
19665 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020019666
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019667ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin([<filter_option>]) : binary
19668 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
19669 returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019670 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019671 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
19672 0 : return the full list of ciphers (default)
19673 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010019674
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019675 Example:
19676 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
19677 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19678 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19679 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19680 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
19681 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
19682 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
19683 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
19684 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
19685
19686ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex([<filter_option>]) : string
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010019687 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019688 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is limited by the shared
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019689 capture buffer size controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting.
19690 Setting <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019691 0 : return the full list of ciphers (default)
19692 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010019693
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019694ssl_fc_cipherlist_str([<filter_option>]) : string
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010019695 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019696 returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019697 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019698 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
19699 0 : return the full list of ciphers (default)
19700 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
19701 Note that this sample-fetch is only available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the
19702 function is not enabled, this sample-fetch returns the hash like
19703 "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010019704
19705ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019706 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can return only if the value
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019707 "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash take
19708 into account all the data of the cipher list.
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019709
19710ssl_fc_ecformats_bin : binary
19711 Return the binary form of the client hello supported elliptic curve point
19712 formats. The maximum returned value length is limited by the shared capture
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019713 buffer size controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting.
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019714
19715 Example:
19716 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
19717 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19718 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19719 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19720 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
19721 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
19722 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
19723 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
19724 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
19725
19726ssl_fc_eclist_bin([<filter_option>]) : binary
19727 Returns the binary form of the client hello supported elliptic curves. The
19728 maximum returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019729 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019730 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
19731 0 : return the full list of supported elliptic curves (default)
19732 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
19733
19734 Example:
19735 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
19736 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19737 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19738 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19739 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
19740 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
19741 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
19742 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
19743 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
19744
19745ssl_fc_extlist_bin([<filter_option>]) : binary
19746 Returns the binary form of the client hello extension list. The maximum
19747 returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019748 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019749 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
19750 0 : return the full list of extensions (default)
19751 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
19752
19753 Example:
19754 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
19755 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19756 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19757 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19758 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
19759 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
19760 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
19761 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
19762 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010019763
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040019764ssl_fc_client_random : binary
19765 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
19766 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
19767 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
19768
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020019769ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
19770 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
19771 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
19772 transport layer.
19773 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19774 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19775 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19776 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19777
19778ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
19779 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
19780 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
19781 transport layer.
19782 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19783 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19784 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19785 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19786
19787ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
19788 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
19789 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
19790 transport layer.
19791 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19792 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19793 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19794 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19795
19796ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
19797 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
19798 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
19799 transport layer.
19800 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19801 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19802 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19803 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19804
19805ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
19806 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
19807 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
19808 transport layer.
19809 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19810 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19811 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19812 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19813
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020019814ssl_fc_err : integer
19815 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19816 returns the ID of the last error of the first error stack raised on the
19817 frontend side, or 0 if no error was encountered. It can be used to identify
19818 handshake related errors other than verify ones (such as cipher mismatch), as
19819 well as other read or write errors occurring during the connection's
19820 lifetime. Any error happening during the client's certificate verification
19821 process will not be raised through this fetch but via the existing
19822 "ssl_c_err", "ssl_c_ca_err" and "ssl_c_ca_err_depth" fetches. In order to get
19823 a text description of this error code, you can either use the
19824 "ssl_fc_err_str" sample fetch or use the "openssl errstr" command (which
19825 takes an error code in hexadecimal representation as parameter). Please refer
19826 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
19827 codes.
19828
19829ssl_fc_err_str : string
19830 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19831 returns a string representation of the last error of the first error stack
19832 that was raised on the frontend side. Any error happening during the client's
19833 certificate verification process will not be raised through this fetch. See
19834 also "ssl_fc_err".
19835
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019836ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020019837 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
19838 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010019839 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
19840 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
19841 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
19842 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020019843
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020019844ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
19845 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
19846 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
19847 wait until the handshake happened.
19848
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019849ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
19850 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020019851 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
19852 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019853 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020019854 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020019855
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020019856ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020019857 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010019858 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
19859 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020019860
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019861ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019862 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019863 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by HAProxy. The result
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019864 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
19865 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
19866 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
19867 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
19868 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
19869 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020019870
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019871ssl_fc_protocol : string
19872 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
19873 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020019874
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019875ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id : integer
19876 The version of the TLS protocol by which the client wishes to communicate
19877 during the session as indicated in client hello message. This value can
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019878 return only if the value "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" is set greater than
19879 0.
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019880
19881 Example:
19882 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
19883 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19884 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19885 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19886 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
19887 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
19888 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
19889 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
19890 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
19891
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020019892ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040019893 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020019894 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Faulet15ae22c2021-11-09 14:23:36 +010019895 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_fc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040019896
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020019897ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
19898 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
19899 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
19900 transport layer.
19901 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19902 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19903 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19904 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19905
19906ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
19907 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
19908 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
19909 transport layer.
19910 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19911 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19912 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19913 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19914
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040019915ssl_fc_server_random : binary
19916 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
19917 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
19918 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
19919
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019920ssl_fc_session_id : binary
19921 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
19922 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
19923 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
19924 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020019925
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040019926ssl_fc_session_key : binary
19927 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
19928 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
19929 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
19930 BoringSSL.
19931
19932
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019933ssl_fc_sni : string
19934 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
19935 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019936 deciphered by HAProxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019937 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
19938 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
19939
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020019940 This fetch is different from "req.ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019941 connection being deciphered by HAProxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019942 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019943 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020019944 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020019945
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019946 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019947 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
19948 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020019949
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019950ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
19951 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
19952 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020019953
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020019954ssl_s_der : binary
19955 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
19956 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19957 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
19958
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020019959ssl_s_chain_der : binary
19960 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
19961 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19962 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050019963 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020019964 does not support resumed sessions.
19965
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020019966ssl_s_key_alg : string
19967 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
19968 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
19969 SSL/TLS transport layer.
19970
19971ssl_s_notafter : string
19972 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
19973 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19974 transport layer.
19975
19976ssl_s_notbefore : string
19977 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
19978 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19979 transport layer.
19980
19981ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
19982 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19983 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
19984 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19985 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
19986 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
19987 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020019988 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19989 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020019990 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19991 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19992 LDAP v3.
19993 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19994 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
19995
19996ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
19997 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19998 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
19999 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
20000 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
20001 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
20002 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020020003 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
20004 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020020005 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
20006 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
20007 LDAP v3.
20008 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
20009 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
20010
20011ssl_s_serial : binary
20012 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
20013 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
20014 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
20015
20016ssl_s_sha1 : binary
20017 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
20018 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
20019 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
20020
20021ssl_s_sig_alg : string
20022 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
20023 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
20024 layer.
20025
20026ssl_s_version : integer
20027 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
20028 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020020029
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200200307.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020031------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020020032
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020033Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
20034sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
20035only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
20036For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
20037be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
20038can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
20039sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
20040for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
20041content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020020042
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010020043Warning : Following sample fetches are ignored if used from HTTP proxies. They
20044 only deal with raw contents found in the buffers. On their side,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020045 HTTP proxies use structured content. Thus raw representation of
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010020046 these data are meaningless. A warning is emitted if an ACL relies on
20047 one of the following sample fetches. But it is not possible to detect
20048 all invalid usage (for instance inside a log-format string or a
20049 sample expression). So be careful.
20050
Willy Tarreau3ec14612022-03-10 10:39:58 +010020051distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
20052 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
20053 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
20054 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
20055 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
20056 HAProxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
20057 list of supported tokens.
20058
20059distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
20060 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
20061 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
20062 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
20063 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
20064 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through HAProxy.
20065 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
20066 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
20067 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
20068 supported tokens.
20069
20070 Example :
20071 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
20072 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
20073 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
20074 # send large files to the big farm
20075 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
20076
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020077payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020078 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020079 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
20080 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010020081
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020082payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
20083 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020084 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020085 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010020086
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020087req.len : integer
20088req_len : integer (deprecated)
20089 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
20090 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
20091 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
20092 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
20093 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020094 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020095 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
20096 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020020097
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020098req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
20099 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020020100 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
20101 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
20102 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
20103 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020020104
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020105 ACL derivatives :
20106 req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020020107
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020108req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
20109 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
20110 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
20111 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
20112 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020020113
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020114 ACL derivatives :
20115 req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020020116
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020117 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020020118
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020119req.proto_http : boolean
20120req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
20121 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
20122 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
20123 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
20124 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
20125 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
20126 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
20127 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020020128
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020129 Example:
20130 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
20131 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
20132 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020020133 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020020134
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020135req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
20136rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
20137 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
20138 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
20139 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
20140 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
20141 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
20142 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
20143 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020144
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020145 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
20146 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
20147 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
20148 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
20149 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
20150 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020151
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020152 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020153 req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020154
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020155 Example :
20156 listen tse-farm
20157 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
20158 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
20159 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
20160 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
20161 # apply RDP cookie persistence
20162 persist rdp-cookie
20163 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
20164 # This is only useful makes sense if
20165 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
20166 stick-table type string size 204800
20167 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
20168 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
20169 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020170
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020171 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020172 "req.rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020173
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020174req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
20175rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
20176 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
20177 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
20178 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
20179 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020180
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020181 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020182 req.rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020183
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110020184req.ssl_alpn : string
20185 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
20186 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
20187 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
20188 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
20189 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
20190 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020020191 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110020192
20193 Examples :
20194 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
20195 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020196 tcp-request content accept if { req.ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020020197 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110020198 default_backend bk_default
20199
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020020200req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
20201 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
20202 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020020203 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
20204 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
20205 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
20206 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
20207 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020020208
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020209req.ssl_hello_type : integer
20210req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
20211 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
20212 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
20213 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
20214 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
20215 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
20216 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
20217 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020218
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020219req.ssl_sni : string
20220req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
20221 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
20222 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
20223 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
20224 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
20225 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020020226 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
20227 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
20228 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
20229 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
20230 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
20231 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
20232 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
20233 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
20234 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020235
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020236 ACL derivatives :
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020020237 req.ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020238
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020239 Examples :
20240 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
20241 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020242 tcp-request content accept if { req.ssl_hello_type 1 }
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020020243 use_backend bk_allow if { req.ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020244 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020245
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053020246req.ssl_st_ext : integer
20247 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
20248 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
20249 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
20250 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
20251 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
20252 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
20253 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
20254 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
20255 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
20256
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020257req.ssl_ver : integer
20258req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
20259 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
20260 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
20261 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
20262 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
20263 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
20264 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
20265 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020266 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020267 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020268
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020269 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020270 req.ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020271
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020020272res.len : integer
20273 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
20274 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
20275 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
20276 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
20277 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020278 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020020279 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020280 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020020281
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020282res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
20283 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020020284 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020285 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020020286 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020287 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020288
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020289res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
20290 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
20291 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
20292 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020293 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
20294 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020295
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020296 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020297
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020020298res.ssl_hello_type : integer
20299rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
20300 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
20301 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
20302 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
20303 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
20304 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
20305 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
20306 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
20307
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020308wait_end : boolean
20309 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
20310 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020311 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020312 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
20313 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020314 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020315 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
20316 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020317
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020318 Examples :
20319 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
20320 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
20321 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020322
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020323 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
20324 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
20325 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
20326 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
20327 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
20328 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
20329 tcp-request content reject
20330
20331
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200203327.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020333--------------------------------------
20334
20335It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
20336This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
20337data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
20338its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
20339HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
20340content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
20341to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
20342more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
20343response are indexed.
20344
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010020345Note : Regarding HTTP processing from the tcp-request content rules, everything
20346 will work as expected from an HTTP proxy. However, from a TCP proxy,
20347 without an HTTP upgrade, it will only work for HTTP/1 content. For
20348 HTTP/2 content, only the preface is visible. Thus, it is only possible
20349 to rely to "req.proto_http", "req.ver" and eventually "method" sample
20350 fetches. All other L7 sample fetches will fail. After an HTTP upgrade,
20351 they will work in the same manner than from an HTTP proxy.
20352
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020353base : string
20354 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
20355 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
20356 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
20357 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
20358 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
20359 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
20360 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
20361 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
20362
20363 ACL derivatives :
20364 base : exact string match
20365 base_beg : prefix match
20366 base_dir : subdir match
20367 base_dom : domain match
20368 base_end : suffix match
20369 base_len : length match
20370 base_reg : regex match
20371 base_sub : substring match
20372
20373base32 : integer
20374 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
20375 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
20376 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020020377 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
20378 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
20379 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020380
20381base32+src : binary
20382 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
20383 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
20384 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
20385 per-URL counters.
20386
Yves Lafonb4d37082021-02-11 11:01:28 +010020387baseq : string
20388 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
20389 the request with the query-string, which starts at the first slash. Using this
20390 instead of "base" allows one to properly identify the target resource, for
20391 statistics or caching use cases. See also "path", "pathq" and "base".
20392
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010020393capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
20394 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
20395 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
20396 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
20397
20398capture.req.method : string
20399 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
20400 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
20401 because it's allocated.
20402
20403capture.req.uri : string
20404 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
20405 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
20406 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
20407 allocated.
20408
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020020409capture.req.ver : string
20410 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
20411 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
20412 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
20413
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010020414capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
20415 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
20416 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
20417 The first entry is an index of 0.
20418 See also: "capture response header"
20419
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020020420capture.res.ver : string
20421 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
20422 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
20423 persistent flag.
20424
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020020425req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020020426 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
20427 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
20428 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020020429
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020020430req.body_param([<name>) : string
20431 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
20432 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
20433 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
20434 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
20435 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
20436 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
20437 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
20438 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
20439 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
20440 given.
20441
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020020442req.body_len : integer
20443 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
20444 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020020445 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
20446 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020020447
20448req.body_size : integer
20449 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020020450 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
20451 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020020452
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020453req.cook([<name>]) : string
20454cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
20455 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
20456 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
20457 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
20458 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
20459 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
20460 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
20461 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
20462 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
20463
20464 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020465 req.cook([<name>]) : exact string match
20466 req.cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
20467 req.cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
20468 req.cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
20469 req.cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
20470 req.cook_len([<name>]) : length match
20471 req.cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
20472 req.cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020473
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020474req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
20475cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
20476 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
20477 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020478
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020479req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
20480cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
20481 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
20482 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
20483 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
20484 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020020485
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020486cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
20487 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
20488 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
20489 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
20490 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020020491 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020492 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
20493 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
20494 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
20495 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020496
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020497hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
20498 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
20499 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
20500 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
20501 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020502 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020503
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020504req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020505 This returns the full value of the last occurrence of header <name> in an
20506 HTTP request. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas present in the
20507 value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is sometimes useful
20508 with headers such as User-Agent.
20509
20510 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
20511 found.
20512
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020513 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
20514 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
20515 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020516 with -1 being the last one.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020517
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020518req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
20519 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
20520 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020521 not specified. Like req.fhdr() it differs from res.hdr_cnt() by not splitting
20522 headers at commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020523
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020524req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020525 This returns the last comma-separated value of the header <name> in an HTTP
20526 request. The fetch considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values.
20527 This is useful if you need to process headers that are defined to be a list
20528 of values, such as Accept, or X-Forwarded-For. If full-line headers are
20529 desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC 7231 to know how
20530 certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
20531 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
20532
20533 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
20534 found.
20535
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020536 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
20537 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
20538 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020539 with -1 being the last one.
20540
20541 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once converted to IP,
20542 associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020543
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020544 ACL derivatives :
20545 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
20546 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
20547 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
20548 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
20549 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
20550 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
20551 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
20552 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
20553
20554req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
20555hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
20556 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
20557 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020558 <name> is not specified. Like req.hdr() it counts each comma separated
20559 part of the header's value. If counting of full-line headers is desired,
20560 then req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead.
20561
20562 With ACLs, it can be used to detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific
20563 header, as well as to block request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests
20564 which contain more than one of certain headers.
20565
20566 Refer to req.hdr() for more information on header matching.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020567
20568req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
20569hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
20570 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
20571 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
20572 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
Willy Tarreau7b0e00d2021-03-25 14:12:29 +010020573 of every header is checked. The parser strictly adheres to the format
20574 described in RFC7239, with the extension that IPv4 addresses may optionally
20575 be followed by a colon (':') and a valid decimal port number (0 to 65535),
20576 which will be silently dropped. All other forms will not match and will
20577 cause the address to be ignored.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020578
20579 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
20580
20581 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020582
20583req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
20584hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
20585 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
20586 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
20587 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020588
20589 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
20590
20591 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020592
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010020593req.hdrs : string
20594 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
20595 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
20596 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
20597 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
20598
20599req.hdrs_bin : binary
20600 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
20601 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
20602 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
20603 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
20604 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
20605 names and values (length of 0 for both).
20606
20607 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010020608
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010020609 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
20610 str: <int:length><bytes>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010020611
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020612http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
20613 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
20614 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
20615 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
20616 basic auth is supported.
20617
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonf5dd3372021-10-01 15:36:53 +020020618http_auth_bearer([<header>]) : string
20619 Returns the client-provided token found in the authorization data when the
20620 Bearer scheme is used (to send JSON Web Tokens for instance). No check is
20621 performed on the data sent by the client.
20622 If a specific <header> is supplied, it will parse this header instead of the
20623 Authorization one.
20624
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010020625http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
20626 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
20627 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
20628 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
20629 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020630 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
20631 basic auth is supported.
20632
20633 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010020634 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
20635 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
20636 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
20637 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020638
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020020639http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010020640 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
20641 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
20642 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020020643
20644http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010020645 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
20646 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
20647 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020020648
20649http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010020650 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
20651 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
20652 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020020653
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020654http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020020655 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
20656 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020657 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
20658 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020020659
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020660method : integer + string
20661 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
20662 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
20663 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
20664 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
20665 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
20666 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
20667 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020668
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020669 ACL derivatives :
20670 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020671
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020672 Example :
20673 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
20674 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
20675 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020676
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020677path : string
20678 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
20679 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
20680 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
20681 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
20682 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020683 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020684 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020685
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020686 ACL derivatives :
20687 path : exact string match
20688 path_beg : prefix match
20689 path_dir : subdir match
20690 path_dom : domain match
20691 path_end : suffix match
20692 path_len : length match
20693 path_reg : regex match
20694 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020695
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020020696pathq : string
20697 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
20698 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
20699 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
20700 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
20701 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
20702 result in both cases.
20703
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010020704query : string
20705 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
20706 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
20707 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
20708 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010020709 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010020710 which stops before the question mark.
20711
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010020712req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
20713 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
20714 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
20715 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
20716 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
20717
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020718req.ver : string
20719req_ver : string (deprecated)
20720 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
20721 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
20722 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020723
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020724 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020725 req.ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020020726
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020727res.body : binary
20728 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
20729 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020730 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
20731
20732 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020733
20734res.body_len : integer
20735 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
20736 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020737 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
20738
20739 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020740
20741res.body_size : integer
20742 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
20743 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
20744 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
20745 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020746 useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
20747
20748 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020749
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonbf971212020-10-27 11:55:57 +010020750res.cache_hit : boolean
20751 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been built out of an
20752 HTTP cache entry, otherwise returns boolean "false".
20753
20754res.cache_name : string
20755 Returns a string containing the name of the HTTP cache that was used to
20756 build the HTTP response if res.cache_hit is true, otherwise returns an
20757 empty string.
20758
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020759res.comp : boolean
20760 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
20761 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
20762 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020763
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020764res.comp_algo : string
20765 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
20766 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
20767 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020768
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020769res.cook([<name>]) : string
20770scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
20771 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
20772 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020773 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
20774
20775 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020020776
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020777 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020778 res.scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020020779
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020780res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
20781scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
20782 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
20783 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020784 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
20785
20786 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020787
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020788res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
20789scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
20790 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
20791 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020792 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
20793
20794 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020795
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020796res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020797 This fetch works like the req.fhdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
20798 on the headers within an HTTP response.
20799
20800 Like req.fhdr() the res.fhdr() fetch returns full values. If the header is
20801 defined to be a list you should use res.hdr().
20802
20803 This fetch is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or Expires.
20804
20805 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020806
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020807res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020808 This fetch works like the req.fhdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
20809 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
20810
20811 Like req.fhdr_cnt() the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch acts on full values. If the
20812 header is defined to be a list you should use res.hdr_cnt().
20813
20814 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020815
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020816res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
20817shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020818 This fetch works like the req.hdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
20819 on the headers within an HTTP response.
20820
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050020821 Like req.hdr() the res.hdr() fetch considers the comma to be a delimiter. If
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020822 this is not desired res.fhdr() should be used.
20823
20824 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020825
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020826 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020827 res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
20828 res.hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
20829 res.hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
20830 res.hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
20831 res.hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
20832 res.hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
20833 res.hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
20834 res.hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020835
20836res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
20837shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020838 This fetch works like the req.hdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
20839 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
20840
20841 Like req.hdr_cnt() the res.hdr_cnt() fetch considers the comma to be a
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050020842 delimiter. If this is not desired res.fhdr_cnt() should be used.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020843
20844 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020845
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020846res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
20847shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020848 This fetch works like the req.hdr_ip() fetch with the difference that it
20849 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
20850
20851 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
20852
20853 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020854
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010020855res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
20856 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
20857 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
20858 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020859 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
20860
20861 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010020862
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020863res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
20864shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020865 This fetch works like the req.hdr_val() fetch with the difference that it
20866 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
20867
20868 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
20869
20870 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020871
20872res.hdrs : string
20873 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
20874 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
20875 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020876 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
20877
20878 It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020879
20880res.hdrs_bin : binary
20881 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
20882 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
20883 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
20884 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
20885 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
20886 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
20887 (length of 0 for both).
20888
20889 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
20890
20891 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
20892 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010020893
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020894res.ver : string
20895resp_ver : string (deprecated)
20896 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020897 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
20898
20899 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020020900
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020901 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020902 resp.ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010020903
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020904set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
20905 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
20906 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020020907 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020908 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010020909
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020910 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
20911 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010020912
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020913status : integer
20914 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
20915 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020916 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
20917
20918 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020919
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020020920unique-id : string
20921 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
20922 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
20923 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
20924 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
20925 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
20926 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
20927
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020928url : string
20929 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
20930 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
20931 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
20932 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
20933 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
20934 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
20935 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020936
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020937 ACL derivatives :
20938 url : exact string match
20939 url_beg : prefix match
20940 url_dir : subdir match
20941 url_dom : domain match
20942 url_end : suffix match
20943 url_len : length match
20944 url_reg : regex match
20945 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020946
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020947url_ip : ip
20948 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
20949 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
20950 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
20951 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +020020952 entry in a table for a given source address. It may be used in combination
20953 with 'http-request set-dst' to emulate the older 'option http_proxy'.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020954
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020955url_port : integer
20956 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +020020957 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed..
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020958
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020020959urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
20960url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020961 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
20962 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020020963 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
20964 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
20965 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
20966 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020967 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
20968 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020020969 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
20970 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020971
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020972 ACL derivatives :
20973 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
20974 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
20975 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
20976 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
20977 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
20978 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
20979 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
20980 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020981
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020982
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020983 Example :
20984 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
20985 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
20986 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
20987 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020988
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030020989urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020990 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
20991 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
20992 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020020993
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020020994url32 : integer
20995 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
20996 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
20997 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
20998 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
20999 is an unsigned integer.
21000
21001url32+src : binary
21002 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
21003 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
21004 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
21005
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020021006
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200210077.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010021008---------------------------------------
21009
21010This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
21011used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
21012purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
21013There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
21014or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
21015any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
21016for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
21017
21018internal.htx.data : integer
21019 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
21020 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
21021
21022internal.htx.free : integer
21023 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
21024 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
21025
21026internal.htx.free_data : integer
21027 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
21028 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
21029
21030internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
Christopher Fauletd1ac2b92020-12-02 19:12:22 +010021031 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains the
21032 end-of-message flag (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is chosen
21033 depending on the sample direction.
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010021034
21035internal.htx.nbblks : integer
21036 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
21037 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
21038
21039internal.htx.size : integer
21040 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
21041 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
21042
21043internal.htx.used : integer
21044 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
21045 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
21046 direction.
21047
21048internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
21049 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
21050 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
21051 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
21052 of the special value :
21053 * head : The oldest inserted block
21054 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021055 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010021056
21057internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
21058 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
21059 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
21060 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
21061 integer or one of the special value :
21062 * head : The oldest inserted block
21063 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021064 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010021065
21066internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
21067 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
21068 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
21069 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
21070 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
21071
21072 * head : The oldest inserted block
21073 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021074 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010021075
21076internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
21077 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
21078 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
21079 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
21080 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
21081
21082 * head : The oldest inserted block
21083 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021084 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010021085
21086internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
21087 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
21088 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
21089 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
21090 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
21091
21092 * head : The oldest inserted block
21093 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021094 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010021095
21096internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
21097 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
21098 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
21099 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
21100 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
21101
21102 * head : The oldest inserted block
21103 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021104 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010021105
21106internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
21107 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
21108 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
21109 it returns false.
21110
21111
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200211127.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021113---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010021114
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021115Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
21116every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020021117order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010021118
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021119ACL name Equivalent to Usage
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020021120---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
21121FALSE always_false never match
21122HTTP req.proto_http match if request protocol is valid HTTP
21123HTTP_1.0 req.ver 1.0 match if HTTP request version is 1.0
21124HTTP_1.1 req.ver 1.1 match if HTTP request version is 1.1
Christopher Faulet8043e832021-03-26 16:00:54 +010021125HTTP_2.0 req.ver 2.0 match if HTTP request version is 2.0
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020021126HTTP_CONTENT req.hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length in the HTTP request
21127HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
21128HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
21129HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
Björn Jacke20d0f502021-10-15 16:32:15 +020021130LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 ::1 match connection from local host
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020021131METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
21132METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
21133METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
21134METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
21135METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
21136METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
21137METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
21138METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
21139RDP_COOKIE req.rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie in the request buffer
21140REQ_CONTENT req.len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
21141TRUE always_true always match
21142WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
21143---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010021144
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010021145
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200211468. Logging
21147----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010021148
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021149One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
21150provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
21151very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
21152provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
21153state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021154to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021155headers.
21156
21157In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
21158about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
21159send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
21160
21161 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
21162 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
21163 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
21164 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
21165 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021166 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060021167 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021168
21169The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
21170allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
21171as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
21172while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
21173real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
21174delay.
21175
21176
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200211778.1. Log levels
21178---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021179
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090021180TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021181source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090021182HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
21183in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
21184track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
21185syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
21186about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021187
21188
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200211898.2. Log formats
21190----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021191
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021192HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090021193and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
21194slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
21195options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021196
21197 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
21198 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
21199 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
21200 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
21201 extents.
21202
21203 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
21204 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
21205 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
21206 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
21207 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
21208
21209 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
21210 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
21211 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
21212 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
21213 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
21214
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020021215 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
21216 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
21217 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
21218 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
21219
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021220 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
21221
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021222Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
21223specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
21224field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
21225servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
21226always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
21227identifier.
21228
21229Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
21230 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
21231 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
21232 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
21233 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
21234
21235
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200212368.2.1. Default log format
21237-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021238
21239This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
21240as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
21241format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
21242
21243 Example :
21244 listen www
21245 mode http
21246 log global
21247 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
21248
21249 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
21250 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
21251 (www/HTTP)
21252
21253 Field Format Extract from the example above
21254 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
21255 2 'Connect from' Connect from
21256 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
21257 4 'to' to
21258 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
21259 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
21260
21261Detailed fields description :
21262 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
21263 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
21264 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
21265 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
21266 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
21267 and processed the connection.
21268 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
21269
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010021270In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
21271"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
21272connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
21273
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021274It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
21275will eventually disappear.
21276
21277
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200212788.2.2. TCP log format
21279---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021280
21281The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
21282is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
21283information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
21284counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
21285emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
21286environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
21287the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
21288sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020021289specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010021290not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend.
21291
21292The TCP log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on the
21293exact following string, which may also be used as a basis to extend the format
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +010021294if required. Refer to section 8.2.6 "Custom log format" to see how to use this:
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010021295
21296 # strict equivalent of "option tcplog"
21297 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
21298 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
21299
21300A few fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those
21301are marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021302
21303 Example :
21304 frontend fnt
21305 mode tcp
21306 option tcplog
21307 log global
21308 default_backend bck
21309
21310 backend bck
21311 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
21312
21313 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
21314 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
21315 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
21316
21317 Field Format Extract from the example above
21318 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
21319 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
21320 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
21321 4 frontend_name fnt
21322 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
21323 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
21324 7 bytes_read* 212
21325 8 termination_state --
21326 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
21327 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
21328
21329Detailed fields description :
21330 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021331 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010021332 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
21333 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010021334 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021335 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010021336 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021337
21338 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010021339 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
21340 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
21341 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021342
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021343 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by HAProxy
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021344 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
21345 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020021346 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
21347 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
21348 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
21349 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021350
21351 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
21352 and processed the connection.
21353
21354 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
21355 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
21356 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
21357 applications.
21358
21359 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
21360 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
21361 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
21362 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
21363 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
21364
21365 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
21366 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
21367 See "Timers" below for more details.
21368
21369 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
21370 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
21371 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
21372 "Timers" below for more details.
21373
21374 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021375 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021376 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
21377 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
21378 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
21379 details.
21380
21381 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
21382 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
21383 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
21384 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
21385 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
21386
21387 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
21388 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
21389 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
21390 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
21391 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
21392 for more details.
21393
21394 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040021395 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021396 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
21397 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
21398 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021399 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021400
21401 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
21402 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
21403 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
21404 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
21405 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
21406 caused by a denial of service attack.
21407
21408 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
21409 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
21410 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
21411 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
21412 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
21413 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
21414 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
21415 denial of service attack.
21416
21417 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
21418 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
21419 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
21420 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
21421 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
21422 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
21423 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
21424 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
21425 be processed than on other servers.
21426
21427 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
21428 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
21429 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
21430 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021431 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021432 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
21433 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
21434 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
21435 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
21436 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
21437 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
21438 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
21439 should not be attributed to the logged server.
21440
21441 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
21442 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
21443 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
21444 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
21445 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
21446 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021447 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021448 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
21449
21450 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
21451 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
21452 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
21453 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
21454 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
21455 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021456 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021457 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
21458 occurs.
21459
21460
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200214618.2.3. HTTP log format
21462----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021463
21464The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
21465is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
21466the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
21467are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
21468emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
21469generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
21470"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
21471which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020021472frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
21473is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021474
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010021475The HTTP log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on the
21476exact following string, which may also be used as a basis to extend the format
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +010021477if required. Refer to section 8.2.6 "Custom log format" to see how to use this:
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010021478
21479 # strict equivalent of "option httplog"
21480 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
21481 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
21482
21483And the CLF log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on
21484this exact string:
21485
21486 # strict equivalent of "option httplog clf"
21487 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
21488 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
21489 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
21490
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021491Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
21492slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
21493with a star ('*') after the field name below.
21494
21495 Example :
21496 frontend http-in
21497 mode http
21498 option httplog
21499 log global
21500 default_backend bck
21501
21502 backend static
21503 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
21504
21505 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
21506 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
21507 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021508 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021509
21510 Field Format Extract from the example above
21511 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
21512 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021513 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021514 4 frontend_name http-in
21515 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021516 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021517 7 status_code 200
21518 8 bytes_read* 2750
21519 9 captured_request_cookie -
21520 10 captured_response_cookie -
21521 11 termination_state ----
21522 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
21523 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
21524 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
21525 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
21526 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021527
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021528Detailed fields description :
21529 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021530 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010021531 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
21532 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010021533 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021534 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010021535 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021536
21537 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010021538 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
21539 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
21540 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021541
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021542 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021543 was received by HAProxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021544
21545 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
21546 and processed the connection.
21547
21548 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
21549 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
21550 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
21551
21552 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
21553 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
21554 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
21555 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
21556 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
21557 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
21558
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021559 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
21560 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
21561 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050021562 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021563 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
21564 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021565 HAProxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020021566 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021567
21568 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
21569 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020021570 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021571
21572 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
21573 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020021574 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
21575 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021576
21577 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
21578 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
21579 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
21580 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
21581 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020021582 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
21583 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021584
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021585 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in HAProxy, which is the total
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021586 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
21587 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
21588 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
21589 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
21590 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
21591 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020021592 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021593
21594 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021595 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by HAProxy when
21596 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021597
21598 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
21599 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050021600 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021601 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
21602 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
21603 overflowing.
21604
21605 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
21606 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
21607 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
21608 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
21609 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
21610 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
21611 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
21612 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
21613
21614 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
21615 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
21616 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
21617 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
21618 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
21619 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
21620 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
21621 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
21622
21623 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
21624 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
21625 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
21626 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
21627 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
21628 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
21629 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
21630
21631 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040021632 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021633 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
21634 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
21635 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021636 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021637 system.
21638
21639 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
21640 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
21641 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
21642 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
21643 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
21644 caused by a denial of service attack.
21645
21646 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
21647 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
21648 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
21649 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
21650 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
21651 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
21652 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
21653 denial of service attack.
21654
21655 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
21656 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
21657 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
21658 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
21659 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
21660 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
21661 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
21662 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
21663 processed than on other servers.
21664
21665 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
21666 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
21667 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
21668 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021669 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021670 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
21671 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
21672 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
21673 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
21674 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
21675 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
21676 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
21677 should not be attributed to the logged server.
21678
21679 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
21680 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
21681 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
21682 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
21683 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
21684 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021685 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021686 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
21687
21688 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
21689 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
21690 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
21691 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
21692 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
21693 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021694 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021695 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
21696 occurs.
21697
21698 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
21699 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
21700 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
21701 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
21702 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
21703 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
21704 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
21705 cookies" below for more details.
21706
21707 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
21708 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
21709 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
21710 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
21711 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
21712 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
21713 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
21714 and cookies" below for more details.
21715
21716 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
21717 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
21718 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
21719 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
21720 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
21721 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
21722 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
21723 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
21724
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021725
217268.2.4. HTTPS log format
21727----------------------
21728
21729The HTTPS format is the best suited for HTTP over SSL connections. It is an
21730extension of the HTTP format (see section 8.2.3) to which SSL related
21731information are added. It is enabled when "option httpslog" is specified in the
21732frontend. Just like the TCP and HTTP formats, the log is usually emitted at the
21733end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified. A session which
21734matches the "monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log
21735sessions for which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option
21736dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if
21737"option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend.
21738
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010021739The HTTPS log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on the
21740exact following string, which may also be used as a basis to extend the format
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +010021741if required. Refer to section 8.2.6 "Custom log format" to see how to use this:
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010021742
21743 # strict equivalent of "option httpslog"
21744 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
21745 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r \
21746 %[fc_err]/%[ssl_fc_err,hex]/%[ssl_c_err]/\
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010021747 %[ssl_c_ca_err]/%[ssl_fc_is_resumed] %[ssl_fc_sni]/%sslv/%sslc"
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010021748
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021749This format is basically the HTTP one (see section 8.2.3) with new fields
21750appended to it. The new fields (lines 17 and 18) will be detailed here. For the
21751HTTP ones, refer to the HTTP section.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021752
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021753 Example :
21754 frontend https-in
21755 mode http
21756 option httpslog
21757 log global
21758 bind *:443 ssl crt mycerts/srv.pem ...
21759 default_backend bck
21760
21761 backend static
21762 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000 ssl crt mycerts/clt.pem ...
21763
21764 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
21765 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] https-in \
21766 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010021767 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1" 0/0/0/0/0 \
21768 1wt.eu/TLSv1.3/TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021769
21770 Field Format Extract from the example above
21771 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
21772 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
21773 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
21774 4 frontend_name https-in
21775 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
21776 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
21777 7 status_code 200
21778 8 bytes_read* 2750
21779 9 captured_request_cookie -
21780 10 captured_response_cookie -
21781 11 termination_state ----
21782 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
21783 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
21784 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
21785 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
21786 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010021787 17 fc_err '/' ssl_fc_err '/' ssl_c_err
William Lallemand1d58b012021-10-14 14:27:48 +020021788 '/' ssl_c_ca_err '/' ssl_fc_is_resumed 0/0/0/0/0
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010021789 18 ssl_fc_sni '/' ssl_version
21790 '/' ssl_ciphers 1wt.eu/TLSv1.3/TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021791
21792Detailed fields description :
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010021793 - "fc_err" is the status of the connection on the frontend's side. It
21794 corresponds to the "fc_err" sample fetch. See the "fc_err" and "fc_err_str"
21795 sample fetch functions for more information.
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021796
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020021797 - "ssl_fc_err" is the last error of the first SSL error stack that was
21798 raised on the connection from the frontend's perspective. It might be used
21799 to detect SSL handshake errors for instance. It will be 0 if everything
Ilya Shipitsinbd6b4be2021-10-15 16:18:21 +050021800 went well. See the "ssl_fc_err" sample fetch's description for more
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020021801 information.
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021802
21803 - "ssl_c_err" is the status of the client's certificate verification process.
21804 The handshake might be successful while having a non-null verification
21805 error code if it is an ignored one. See the "ssl_c_err" sample fetch and
21806 the "crt-ignore-err" option.
21807
21808 - "ssl_c_ca_err" is the status of the client's certificate chain verification
21809 process. The handshake might be successful while having a non-null
21810 verification error code if it is an ignored one. See the "ssl_c_ca_err"
21811 sample fetch and the "ca-ignore-err" option.
21812
William Lallemand1d58b012021-10-14 14:27:48 +020021813 - "ssl_fc_is_resumed" is true if the incoming TLS session was resumed with
21814 the stateful cache or a stateless ticket. Don't forgot that a TLS session
21815 can be shared by multiple requests.
21816
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010021817 - "ssl_fc_sni" is the SNI (Server Name Indication) presented by the client
21818 to select the certificate to be used. It usually matches the host name for
21819 the first request of a connection. An absence of this field may indicate
21820 that the SNI was not sent by the client, and will lead haproxy to use the
21821 default certificate, or to reject the connection in case of strict-sni.
21822
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021823 - "ssl_version" is the SSL version of the frontend.
21824
21825 - "ssl_ciphers" is the SSL cipher used for the connection.
21826
21827
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +0100218288.2.5. Error log format
21829-----------------------
21830
21831When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
21832protocol header, HAProxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format,
21833unless a dedicated error log format is defined through an "error-log-format"
21834line. By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
21835"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
21836will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
21837logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
21838
21839The default format looks like this :
21840
21841 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
21842 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
21843 Connection error during SSL handshake
21844
21845 Field Format Extract from the example above
21846 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
21847 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
21848 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
21849 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
21850 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
21851
21852These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
21853failures.
21854
21855By using the "error-log-format" directive, the legacy log format described
21856above will not be used anymore, and all error log lines will follow the
21857defined format.
21858
21859An example of reasonably complete error-log-format follows, it will report the
21860source address and port, the connection accept() date, the frontend name, the
21861number of active connections on the process and on thit frontend, haproxy's
21862internal error identifier on the front connection, the hexadecimal OpenSSL
21863error number (that can be copy-pasted to "openssl errstr" for full decoding),
21864the client certificate extraction status (0 indicates no error), the client
21865certificate validation status using the CA (0 indicates no error), a boolean
21866indicating if the connection is new or was resumed, the optional server name
21867indication (SNI) provided by the client, the SSL version name and the SSL
21868ciphers used on the connection, if any. Note that backend connection errors
21869are never reported here since in order for a backend connection to fail, it
21870would have passed through a successful stream, hence will be available as
21871regular traffic log (see option httplog or option httpslog).
21872
21873 # detailed frontend connection error log
Lukas Tribus2b949732021-12-09 01:27:14 +010021874 error-log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %ac/%fc %[fc_err]/\
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +010021875 %[ssl_fc_err,hex]/%[ssl_c_err]/%[ssl_c_ca_err]/%[ssl_fc_is_resumed] \
21876 %[ssl_fc_sni]/%sslv/%sslc"
21877
21878
218798.2.6. Custom log format
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020021880------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021881
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010021882When the default log formats are not sufficient, it is possible to define new
21883ones in very fine details. As creating a log-format from scratch is not always
21884a trivial task, it is strongly recommended to first have a look at the existing
21885formats ("option tcplog", "option httplog", "option httpslog"), pick the one
21886looking the closest to the expectation, copy its "log-format" equivalent string
21887and adjust it.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021888
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021889HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021890Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
21891separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
21892prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
21893
21894Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
21895variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010021896("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021897
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010021898If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020021899as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010021900less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
21901the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
21902
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020021903Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
21904"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
21905delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
21906preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021907
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010021908Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
21909'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
21910https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
21911such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
21912
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021913Flags are :
21914 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040021915 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010021916 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
21917 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021918
21919 Example:
21920
21921 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
21922 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
21923
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010021924 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
21925
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021926Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
21927
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021928 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020021929 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021930 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
21931 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
21932 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021933 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
21934 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
21935 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020021936 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000021937 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
Maciej Zdeb21acc332020-11-26 10:45:52 +000021938 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string | string |
Maciej Zdebfcdfd852020-11-30 18:27:47 +000021939 | H | %HPO | HTTP path only (without host nor query string)| string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000021940 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000021941 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
21942 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010021943 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020021944 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020021945 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Christopher Faulet3010e002021-12-03 10:48:36 +010021946 | H | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021947 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020021948 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080021949 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021950 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
21951 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
21952 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
21953 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
21954 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020021955 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021956 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000021957 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021958 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021959 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021960 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
21961 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021962 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
21963 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
21964 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021965 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021966 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
21967 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021968 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021969 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
21970 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
21971 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020021972 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020021973 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020021974 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
21975 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
21976 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
21977 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020021978 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020021979 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020021980 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021981 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010021982 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021983 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021984 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
21985 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
21986 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021987 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020021988 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
21989 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021990 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021991 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
21992 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020021993 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021994 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020021995 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021996 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021997
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020021998 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021999
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010022000
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200220018.3. Advanced logging options
22002-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022003
22004Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
22005just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
22006options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
22007for more information about their usage.
22008
22009
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200220108.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
22011------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022012
22013It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022014HAProxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022015commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
22016monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
22017ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
22018
22019 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
22020 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
22021 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
22022 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
22023
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +020022024 - it is possible to use the "http-request set-log-level silent" action using
22025 a variety of conditions (source networks, paths, user-agents, etc).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022026
22027 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
22028 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
22029 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
22030
22031
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200220328.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
22033----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022034
22035The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
22036what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
22037or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022038"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022039just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
22040log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
22041after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
22042is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
22043with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
22044with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
22045
22046
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200220478.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
22048------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020022049
22050Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
22051for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
22052"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
22053retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
22054raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
22055a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
22056file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
22057you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
22058"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
22059
22060
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200220618.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
22062--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020022063
22064Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
22065multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
22066them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
22067"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
22068logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
22069error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
22070and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
22071too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
22072useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
22073alternative.
22074
22075
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200220768.4. Timing events
22077------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022078
22079Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
22080reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
22081the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
22082frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022083mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
22084addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
22085
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010022086Timings events in HTTP mode:
22087
22088 first request 2nd request
22089 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
22090 t tr t tr ...
22091 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
22092 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
22093 :<---- Tq ---->: :
22094 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000022095 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010022096 :<--------- Ta --------->:
22097
22098Timings events in TCP mode:
22099
22100 TCP session
22101 |<----------------->|
22102 t t
22103 ---|----|----|----|----|---
22104 | Th Tw Tc Td |
22105 |<------ Tt ------->|
22106
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022107 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022108 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022109 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
22110 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
22111 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022112 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020022113 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
22114 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
22115 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
22116 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022117
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022118 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
22119 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
22120 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020022121 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
22122 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
22123 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
22124 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
22125 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
22126 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022127
22128 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
22129 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
22130 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
22131 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
22132 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
22133 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
22134 request typed by hand during a test.
22135
22136 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
22137 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022138 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022139 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
22140 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
22141 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
22142 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022143
22144 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
22145 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
22146 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
22147 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
22148 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
22149
22150 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
22151 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
22152 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
22153 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
22154 connection never established.
22155
22156 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
22157 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
22158 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
22159 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
22160 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
22161 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
22162 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
22163 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
22164 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
22165 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
22166 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
22167
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022168 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
22169 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
22170 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
22171 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
22172 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
22173 by subtracting other timers when valid :
22174
22175 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
22176
22177 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
22178 "Ta" can never be negative.
22179
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022180 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
22181 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022182 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
22183 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030022184 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022185
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022186 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022187
22188 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022189 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
22190 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022191
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000022192 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
22193 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
22194 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
22195 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
22196 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
22197 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
22198 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
22199 prefixed with a '+' sign.
22200
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022201These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
22202protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
22203that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022204due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
22205"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
22206that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022207
22208Most common cases :
22209
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022210 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
22211 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
22212 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
22213 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
22214 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022215 ended, HAProxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022216 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
22217 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
22218 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
22219 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
22220 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020022221 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022222
22223 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
22224 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
22225 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
22226 of ms on remote networks.
22227
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020022228 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
22229 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
22230 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022231
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022232 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
22233 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022234 HAProxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022235 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
22236 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
22237 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
22238 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
22239 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
22240 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022241
22242Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
22243
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022244 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022245 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022246 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022247
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022248 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022249 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
22250 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
22251
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022252 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022253 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
22254 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
22255 flags.
22256
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022257 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
22258 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022259 Check the session termination flags, then check the
22260 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
22261 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
22262 the client connection was maintained open.
22263
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022264 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030022265 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022266 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022267 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
22268
22269
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200222708.5. Session state at disconnection
22271-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022272
22273TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
22274"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
222752-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
22276each of which has a special meaning :
22277
22278 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
22279 session to terminate :
22280
22281 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
22282
22283 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
22284 server explicitly refused it.
22285
22286 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
22287 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
22288 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
22289 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022290 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020022291
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022292 L : the session was locally processed by HAProxy and was not passed to
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020022293 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022294
22295 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
22296 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
22297 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
22298 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
22299 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
22300
22301 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
22302 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
22303 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
22304 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
22305 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
22306
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022307 D : the session was killed by HAProxy because the server was detected
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090022308 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
22309
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022310 U : the session was killed by HAProxy on this backup server because an
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070022311 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
22312 backup connections when going up.
22313
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022314 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020022315
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022316 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
22317 send or receive data.
22318
22319 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
22320 send or receive data.
22321
22322 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
22323 with nothing left in the buffers.
22324
22325 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
22326
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010022327 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022328 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
22329
22330 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
22331 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
22332 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
22333 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
22334 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
22335
22336 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
22337 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
22338
22339 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
22340 server (HTTP only).
22341
22342 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
22343
22344 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
22345 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
22346 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
22347
22348 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
22349 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
22350 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
22351
22352 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
22353
22354 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
22355 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
22356
22357 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
22358 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
22359 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
22360
22361 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
22362 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020022363 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
22364 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022365
22366 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
22367 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
22368 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
22369 another server.
22370
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020022371 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022372 server.
22373
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020022374 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
22375 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
22376 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
22377 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
22378
22379 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
22380 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
22381 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
22382 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
22383
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020022384 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
22385 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
22386 "use-server" rule).
22387
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022388 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
22389
22390 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
22391 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
22392
22393 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
22394
22395 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
22396 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
22397 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
22398
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020022399 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
22400 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030022401 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020022402 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
22403 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
22404
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022405 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
22406
22407 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
22408 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
22409
22410 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
22411
22412 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
22413
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020022414The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
22415was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022416helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
22417starvation, attacks, etc...
22418
22419The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
22420alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
22421easier finding and understanding.
22422
22423 Flags Reason
22424
22425 -- Normal termination.
22426
22427 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022428 server. This can happen when HAProxy tries to connect to a recently
22429 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while HAProxy is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022430 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
22431
22432 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
22433 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022434 client and HAProxy which decided to actively break the connection,
22435 by network routing issues between the client and HAProxy, or by a
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022436 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
22437 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010022438
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022439 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
22440 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020022441 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022442
22443 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
22444 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
22445 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
22446
22447 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
22448 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
22449 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
22450 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
22451 the server takes too long to respond.
22452
22453 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
22454 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
22455 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
22456 long a time to respond.
22457
22458 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
22459 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
22460 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022461 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between HAProxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020022462 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
22463 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022464
22465 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
22466 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
22467 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
22468 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
22469 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020022470 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020022471 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
22472 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
22473 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
22474 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
22475 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
22476 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
22477 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
22478 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022479 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020022480 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
22481 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
22482 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022483
22484 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
22485 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020022486 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
22487 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
22488 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
22489 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022490
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022491 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by HAProxy. Generally
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020022492 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
22493
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022494 SC The server or an equipment between it and HAProxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022495 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
22496 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022497 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022498 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
22499 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
22500
22501 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
22502 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
22503 503 or 504 here.
22504
22505 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022506 transfer. This usually means that HAProxy has received an RST from
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022507 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
22508 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
22509 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
22510
22511 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
22512 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022513 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022514 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022515 between the client and the server expiring first on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022516
22517 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
22518 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
22519 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
22520 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
22521 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
22522 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022523 between HAProxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022524
22525 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
22526 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
22527 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
22528 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
22529 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
22530 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
22531 solution is to fix the application.
22532
22533 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
22534 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
22535 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
22536 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
22537 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
22538 external attacks.
22539
22540 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070022541 process's socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020022542 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022543 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
22544 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
22545
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010022546 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
22547 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
22548 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022549 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020022550 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010022551
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022552 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
22553 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
22554 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
22555 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010022556 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
22557 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
22558 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
22559 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
Christopher Faulet24dda942022-05-05 12:27:07 +020022560 logs. Finally, it may be due to an HTTP header rewrite failure on the
22561 response. In this case, an HTTP 500 error is sent (see
22562 "tune.maxrewrite" and "http-response strict-mode" for more
22563 inforomation).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022564
22565 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
22566 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
22567 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
Christopher Faulet24dda942022-05-05 12:27:07 +020022568 returned an HTTP 403 error. It may also be due to an HTTP header
22569 rewrite failure on the request. In this case, an HTTP 500 error is
22570 sent (see "tune.maxrewrite" and "http-request strict-mode" for more
22571 inforomation).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022572
22573 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
22574 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
22575 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
22576 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
22577
22578 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
22579 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
22580 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
22581 only be solved by proper system tuning.
22582
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020022583The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022584persistence was handled by the client, the server and by HAProxy. This is very
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020022585important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
22586re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
22587
22588 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
22589
22590 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
22591 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
22592 set on a GET request.
22593
22594 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
22595 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040022596 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020022597 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
22598
22599 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
22600 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
22601 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
22602
22603 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
22604 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
22605 already got a cookie.
22606
22607 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
22608 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
22609 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
22610 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
22611 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
22612
22613 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
22614 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
22615 new cookie was inserted in the response.
22616
22617 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
22618 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
22619 new cookie was inserted in the response.
22620
22621 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
22622 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
22623
22624 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
22625 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
22626 then advertised in the response.
22627
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022628
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200226298.6. Non-printable characters
22630-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022631
22632In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
22633consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
22634converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
22635prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
22636being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
22637escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
22638is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
22639'}' when logging headers.
22640
22641Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
22642issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
22643containing spaces is "User-Agent".
22644
22645Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
22646the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
22647performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
22648
22649
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200226508.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
22651---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022652
22653Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
22654achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022655section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022656cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
22657the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
22658the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022659locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022660not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
22661user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
22662a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
22663wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
22664
22665 Examples :
22666 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
22667 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
22668
22669 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
22670 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
22671
22672
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200226738.8. Capturing HTTP headers
22674---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022675
22676Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
22677proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
22678the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
22679server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
22680
22681Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
22682response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022683section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022684
22685It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010022686time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
22687appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022688are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
22689and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
22690follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
22691request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
22692in the logs.
22693
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020022694As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
22695frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
22696an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
22697
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022698 Example :
22699 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
22700 listen proxy-out
22701 mode http
22702 option httplog
22703 option logasap
22704 log global
22705 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
22706
22707 # log the name of the virtual server
22708 capture request header Host len 20
22709
22710 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
22711 capture request header Content-Length len 10
22712
22713 # log the beginning of the referrer
22714 capture request header Referer len 20
22715
22716 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
22717 capture response header Server len 20
22718
22719 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
22720 capture response header Content-Length len 10
22721
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022722 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022723 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
22724
22725 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
22726 capture response header Via len 20
22727
22728 # log the URL location during a redirection
22729 capture response header Location len 20
22730
22731 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
22732 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
22733 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
22734 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
22735 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
22736
22737 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
22738 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
22739 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
22740 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010022741 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022742
22743 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
22744 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
22745 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
22746 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
22747 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010022748 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022749
22750
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200227518.9. Examples of logs
22752---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022753
22754These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
22755them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
22756reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
22757
22758 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
22759 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
22760 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
22761
22762 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
22763 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
22764
22765 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
22766 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
22767 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
22768
22769 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
22770 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
22771
22772 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
22773 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
22774 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
22775
22776 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010022777 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022778 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
22779 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
22780
22781 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
22782 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
22783 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
22784
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020022785 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
22786 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
22787 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
22788 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022789 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was HAProxy who decided to
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020022790 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022791
22792 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010022793 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022794
22795 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
22796 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
22797 Nothing was sent to any server.
22798
22799 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
22800 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
22801
22802 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
22803 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022804 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022805 send a 408 return code to the client.
22806
22807 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
22808 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
22809
22810 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
22811 5 seconds ("c----").
22812
22813 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
22814 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010022815 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022816
22817 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022818 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022819 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
22820 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
22821 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
22822 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
22823 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010022824
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020022825
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200228269. Supported filters
22827--------------------
22828
22829Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
22830accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
22831unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
22832
22833See also : "filter"
22834
228359.1. Trace
22836----------
22837
Christopher Fauletc41d8bd2020-11-17 10:43:26 +010022838filter trace [name <name>] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020022839
22840 Arguments:
22841 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
22842 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
22843
Christopher Faulet96a577a2020-11-17 10:45:05 +010022844 <quiet> inhibits trace messages.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020022845
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022846 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020022847 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
22848 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
22849 amount of the parsed data.
22850
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022851 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010022852
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020022853This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
22854callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
22855information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
22856filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
22857
22858Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
22859tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
22860a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
22861
22862
228639.2. HTTP compression
22864---------------------
22865
22866filter compression
22867
22868The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
22869keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022870when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
22871fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
22872done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
22873explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
22874filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
22875listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
22876order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020022877
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022878See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
22879 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020022880
22881
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200228829.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
22883--------------------------------------------
22884
22885filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
22886
22887 Arguments :
22888
22889 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
22890 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
22891 parsed.
22892
22893 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
22894 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
22895 part must be placed in its own scope.
22896
22897The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
22898external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022899streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020022900exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
22901also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
22902
22903SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
22904the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
22905
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010022906For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020022907"doc/SPOE.txt".
22908
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100229099.4. Cache
22910----------
22911
22912filter cache <name>
22913
22914 Arguments :
22915
22916 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
22917
22918The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
22919"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050022920cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022921other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
22922case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
22923is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
22924filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010022925listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
22926order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010022927
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022928See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
22929 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
22930
22931
229329.5. Fcgi-app
22933-------------
22934
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040022935filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022936
22937 Arguments :
22938
22939 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
22940
22941The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
22942request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
22943reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
22944used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
22945implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
22946used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
22947fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
22948used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
22949order.
22950
22951See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
22952 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
22953
22954
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +0100229559.6. OpenTracing
22956----------------
22957
22958The OpenTracing filter adds native support for using distributed tracing in
22959HAProxy. This is enabled by sending an OpenTracing compliant request to one
22960of the supported tracers such as Datadog, Jaeger, Lightstep and Zipkin tracers.
22961Please note: tracers are not listed by any preference, but alphabetically.
22962
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022963This feature is only enabled when HAProxy was built with USE_OT=1.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010022964
22965The OpenTracing filter activation is done explicitly by specifying it in the
22966HAProxy configuration. If this is not done, the OpenTracing filter in no way
22967participates in the work of HAProxy.
22968
22969filter opentracing [id <id>] config <file>
22970
22971 Arguments :
22972
22973 <id> is the OpenTracing filter id that will be used to find the
22974 right scope in the configuration file. If no filter id is
22975 specified, 'ot-filter' is used as default. If scope is not
22976 specified in the configuration file, it applies to all defined
22977 OpenTracing filters.
22978
22979 <file> is the path of the OpenTracing configuration file. The same
22980 file can contain configurations for multiple OpenTracing
22981 filters simultaneously. In that case we do not need to define
22982 scope so the same configuration applies to all filters or each
22983 filter must have its own scope defined.
22984
22985More detailed documentation related to the operation, configuration and use
Willy Tarreaua63d1a02021-04-02 17:16:46 +020022986of the filter can be found in the addons/ot directory.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010022987
22988
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002298910. FastCGI applications
22990-------------------------
22991
22992HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
22993feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
22994the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
22995FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
22996servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
22997FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
22998backend.
22999
23000HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
23001application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
23002connection.
23003
2300410.1. Setup
23005-----------
23006
2300710.1.1. Fcgi-app section
23008--------------------------
23009
23010fcgi-app <name>
23011 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
23012 document root must be defined.
23013
23014acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
23015 Declare or complete an access list.
23016
23017 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
23018 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
23019 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
23020 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
23021 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
23022
23023docroot <path>
23024 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
23025 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
23026 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
23027
23028index <script-name>
23029 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
23030 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
23031 is an optional setting.
23032
23033 Example :
23034 index index.php
23035
23036log-stderr global
23037log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +010023038 [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020023039 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
23040
23041 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
23042 default STDERR messages are ignored.
23043
23044pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
23045 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
23046 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
23047 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
23048
23049 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
23050 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
23051 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
23052 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
23053
23054 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
23055 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
23056
23057path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010023058 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010023059 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
23060 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
23061 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
23062 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
23063 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
23064 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
23065 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010023066
23067 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050023068 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010023069 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
23070 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
23071 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
23072 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020023073
23074 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010023075 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
23076 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020023077
23078option get-values
23079no option get-values
23080 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
23081
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040023082 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020023083 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
23084
23085 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
23086 application will accept.
23087
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020023088 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
23089 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020023090
23091 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050023092 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020023093 option is disabled.
23094
23095 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
23096 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
23097 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
23098 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
23099 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
23100 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
23101
23102option keep-conn
23103no option keep-conn
23104 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
23105 sending a response.
23106
23107 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
23108 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
23109
23110option max-reqs <reqs>
23111 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
23112 accept.
23113
23114 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
23115 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
23116 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
23117 to 1.
23118
23119option mpxs-conns
23120no option mpxs-conns
23121 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
23122
23123 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
23124 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
23125
23126set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
23127 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
23128 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
23129 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
23130 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
23131
23132 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
23133 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
23134 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
23135
23136 Example :
23137 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
23138 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
23139
23140 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
23141
23142
2314310.1.2. Proxy section
23144---------------------
23145
23146use-fcgi-app <name>
23147 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
23148
23149 Arguments :
23150 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
23151
23152 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
23153 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
23154 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
23155 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
23156 application may be defined at a time per backend.
23157
23158 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
23159 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
23160 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
23161 application are evaluated.
23162
23163
2316410.1.3. Example
23165---------------
23166
23167 frontend front-http
23168 mode http
23169 bind *:80
23170 bind *:
23171
23172 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
23173 default_backend back-static
23174
23175 backend back-static
23176 mode http
23177 server www A.B.C.D:80
23178
23179 backend back-dynamic
23180 mode http
23181 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
23182 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
23183
23184 fcgi-app php-fpm
23185 log-stderr global
23186 option keep-conn
23187
23188 docroot /var/www/my-app
23189 index index.php
23190 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
23191
23192
2319310.2. Default parameters
23194------------------------
23195
23196A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
23197the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050023198script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020023199applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
23200
23201 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23202 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
23203 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
23204 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
23205 | | |
23206 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23207 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
23208 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
23209 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
23210 | | application. |
23211 | | |
23212 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23213 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
23214 | | the request. It may not be set. |
23215 | | |
23216 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23217 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
23218 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
23219 | | the application's configuration. |
23220 | | |
23221 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23222 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
23223 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
23224 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
23225 | | |
23226 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23227 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
23228 | | following the part that identifies the script |
23229 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
23230 | | be defined. |
23231 | | |
23232 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23233 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
23234 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
23235 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
23236 | | is not set too. |
23237 | | |
23238 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23239 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
23240 | | set. |
23241 | | |
23242 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23243 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
23244 | | the request. |
23245 | | |
23246 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23247 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
23248 | | client as part of user authentication. |
23249 | | |
23250 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23251 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
23252 | | script to process the request. |
23253 | | |
23254 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23255 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
23256 | | |
23257 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23258 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
23259 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
23260 | | |
23261 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23262 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
23263 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
23264 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
23265 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
23266 | | |
23267 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23268 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
23269 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
23270 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
23271 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
23272 | | side. |
23273 | | |
23274 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23275 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
23276 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
23277 | | connected to. |
23278 | | |
23279 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23280 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
23281 | | |
23282 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Faulet5cd0e522021-06-11 13:34:42 +020023283 | SERVER_SOFTWARE | Contains the string "HAProxy" followed by the |
23284 | | current HAProxy version. |
23285 | | |
23286 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020023287 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
23288 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
23289 | | |
23290 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23291
23292
2329310.3. Limitations
23294------------------
23295
23296The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
23297way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
23298during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
23299establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
23300application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
23301or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
23302message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
23303these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
23304and HTTP servers under the same backend.
23305
23306Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
23307request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
23308requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
23309
23310About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
23311into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
23312fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
23313"http-request" ones.
23314
23315Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
23316FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
23317processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
23318must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
23319here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010023320
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020023321
2332211. Address formats
23323-------------------
23324
23325Several statements as "bind, "server", "nameserver" and "log" requires an
23326address.
23327
23328This address can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6 address, or '*'.
23329The '*' is equal to the special address "0.0.0.0" and can be used, in the case
23330of "bind" or "dgram-bind" to listen on all IPv4 of the system.The IPv6
23331equivalent is '::'.
23332
23333Depending of the statement, a port or port range follows the IP address. This
23334is mandatory on 'bind' statement, optional on 'server'.
23335
23336This address can also begin with a slash '/'. It is considered as the "unix"
23337family, and '/' and following characters must be present the path.
23338
23339Default socket type or transport method "datagram" or "stream" depends on the
23340configuration statement showing the address. Indeed, 'bind' and 'server' will
23341use a "stream" socket type by default whereas 'log', 'nameserver' or
23342'dgram-bind' will use a "datagram".
23343
23344Optionally, a prefix could be used to force the address family and/or the
23345socket type and the transport method.
23346
23347
2334811.1 Address family prefixes
23349----------------------------
23350
23351'abns@<name>' following <name> is an abstract namespace (Linux only).
23352
23353'fd@<n>' following address is a file descriptor <n> inherited from the
23354 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already be
23355 listening.
23356
23357'ip@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4 or
23358 IPv6 address depending on the syntax. Depending
23359 on the statement using this address, a port or
23360 a port range may or must be specified.
23361
23362'ipv4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
23363 an IPv4 address. Depending on the statement
23364 using this address, a port or a port range
23365 may or must be specified.
23366
23367'ipv6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
23368 an IPv6 address. Depending on the statement
23369 using this address, a port or a port range
23370 may or must be specified.
23371
23372'sockpair@<n>' following address is the file descriptor of a connected unix
23373 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the initiator
23374 creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes one of them
23375 over the FD to the other end. The listener waits to receive
23376 the FD from the unix socket and uses it as if it were the FD
23377 of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
23378
23379'unix@<path>' following string is considered as a UNIX socket <path>. this
23380 prefix is useful to declare an UNIX socket path which don't
23381 start by slash '/'.
23382
23383
2338411.2 Socket type prefixes
23385-------------------------
23386
23387Previous "Address family prefixes" can also be prefixed to force the socket
23388type and the transport method. The default depends of the statement using
23389this address but in some cases the user may force it to a different one.
23390This is the case for "log" statement where the default is syslog over UDP
23391but we could force to use syslog over TCP.
23392
23393Those prefixes were designed for internal purpose and users should
23394instead use aliases of the next section "11.5.3 Protocol prefixes".
23395
23396If users need one those prefixes to perform what they expect because
23397they can not configure the same using the protocol prefixes, they should
23398report this to the maintainers.
23399
23400'stream+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
23401 to "stream"
23402
23403'dgram+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
23404 to "datagram".
23405
23406
2340711.3 Protocol prefixes
23408----------------------
23409
23410'tcp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
23411 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
23412 socket type and transport method is forced to
23413 "stream". Depending on the statement using
23414 this address, a port or a port range can or
23415 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
23416 of 'stream+ip@'.
23417
23418'tcp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
23419 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
23420 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
23421 statement using this address, a port or port
23422 range can or must be specified.
23423 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
23424
23425'tcp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
23426 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
23427 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
23428 statement using this address, a port or port
23429 range can or must be specified.
23430 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
23431
23432'udp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
23433 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
23434 socket type and transport method is forced to
23435 "datagram". Depending on the statement using
23436 this address, a port or a port range can or
23437 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
23438 of 'dgram+ip@'.
23439
23440'udp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
23441 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
23442 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
23443 the statement using this address, a port or
23444 port range can or must be specified.
23445 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
23446
23447'udp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
23448 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
23449 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
23450 the statement using this address, a port or
23451 port range can or must be specified.
23452 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
23453
23454'uxdg@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
23455 transport method is forced to "datagram". It is considered as
23456 an alias of 'dgram+unix@'.
23457
23458'uxst@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
23459 transport method is forced to "stream". It is considered as
23460 an alias of 'stream+unix@'.
23461
23462In future versions, other prefixes could be used to specify protocols like
23463QUIC which proposes stream transport based on socket of type "datagram".
23464
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010023465/*
23466 * Local variables:
23467 * fill-column: 79
23468 * End:
23469 */